Rosemount Tank Radar 05402 Two-Wire Radar Level Transmitter User Manual Book 5400 RevHA
Rosemount Tank Radar AB Two-Wire Radar Level Transmitter Book 5400 RevHA
User Manual
Reference Manual 00809-0100-4026, Rev HA November 2014 Rosemount 5400 Series Superior Performance Two-Wire Non-Contacting Radar Level Transmitter Reference Manual 00809-0100-4026, Rev HA November 2014 Rosemount 5400 Series Read this manual before working with the product. For personal and system safety, and for optimum product performance, make sure you thoroughly understand the contents before installing, using, or maintaining this product. Within the United States, Emerson Process Management has two toll-free assistance numbers. Customer Central: Technical support, quoting, and order-related questions. United States - 1-800-999-9307 (7:00 am to 7:00 pm CST) Asia Pacific- 65 777 8211 Europe / Middle East / Africa - 49 (8153) 9390 North American Response Center: Equipment service needs. 1-800-654-7768 (24 hours a day — includes Canada) For equipment service or support needs outside the United States, contact your local Emerson Process Management representative. There are no health hazards from the Rosemount 5400 Series transmitter. The microwave power density in the tank is only a small fraction of the allowed power density according to international standards. The products described in this document are NOT designed for nuclear-qualified applications. Using non-nuclear qualified products in applications that require nuclear-qualified hardware or products may cause inaccurate readings. For information on Rosemount nuclear-qualified products, contact your local Emerson Process Management Sales Representative. This product is designed to meet FCC and R&TTE requirements. This device complies with part 15 of the FCC rules. Operation is subject to the following two conditions: (1) This device may not cause harmful interference, and (2) this device must accept any interference received, including interference that may cause undesired operation. iii Reference Manual November 2014 iv 00809-0100-4026, Rev HA Reference Manual Contents 00809-0100-4026, Rev HA November 2014 Contents 1Section 1: Introduction 1.1 Manual overview . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1 1.2 Service support. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3 1.3 Product recycling/ disposal . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4 1.4 Safety messages . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4 2Section 2: Transmitter Overview 2.1 Theory of operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7 2.2 Application examples . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8 2.3 System architecture. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .10 2.4 Process characteristics . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .12 2.5 Components of the transmitter . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .14 2.6 Antenna selection guide/measuring range . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .15 3Section 3: Mechanical Installation 3.1 Safety messages . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .19 3.2 Installation procedure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .21 3.3 Mounting considerations . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .22 3.3.1 Mounting location . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .22 3.3.2 Special considerations in solids applications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .24 3.3.3 Mounting in pipes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .25 3.3.4 Installation considerations . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .26 3.3.5 Nozzle considerations . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .27 3.3.6 Nozzle recommendations and requirements . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .30 3.3.7 Service space . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .32 3.3.8 Beamwidth. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .33 3.3.9 Vessel characteristics . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .35 3.3.10Disturbing objects . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .35 3.3.11Valves . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .35 3.4 Mounting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .36 3.4.1 Cone antenna flange connection. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .36 3.4.2 Process seal antenna . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .37 3.4.3 Rod antenna threaded connection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .38 3.4.4 Rod antenna flanged connection. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .39 3.4.5 Tri-Clamp™ tank connection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .40 Contents Reference Manual Contents 00809-0100-4026, Rev HA November 2014 3.4.6 Bracket mounting on wall . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .41 3.4.7 Bracket mounting on pipe. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .42 4Section 4: Electrical Installation 4.1 Safety messages . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .43 4.2 Wiring and power supply requirements. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .44 4.3 Cable/conduit entries . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .45 4.3.1 Conduit electrical connector wiring (using minifast®). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .45 4.4 Grounding . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .46 4.5 Cable selection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .46 4.6 Hazardous areas . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .47 4.7 External circuit breaker . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .47 4.7.1 Connecting the transmitter . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .47 4.8 HART. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .49 4.8.1 Power requirements. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .49 4.8.2 Load limitations. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .49 4.8.3 Non-intrinsically safe power supply. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .51 4.8.4 Intrinsically safe power supply . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .52 4.8.5 Type N approvals: non-sparking / energy-limited power supply . . . . . . . .53 4.8.6 Transient protection terminal block . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .54 4.9 FOUNDATION fieldbus. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .55 4.9.1 Power requirements. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .55 4.9.2 Non-intrinsically safe power supply. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .57 4.9.3 Intrinsically safe power supply . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .58 4.9.4 Type N approvals: non-sparking / energy-limited power supply . . . . . . . .59 4.10HART to Modbus Converter (HMC) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .60 4.10.1Connecting the transmitter . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .60 4.10.2Connection terminals . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .62 4.10.3RS-485 bus. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .63 4.10.4Installation cases . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .63 4.10.5External HART devices (slaves). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .65 4.11Establish HART communication . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .66 4.11.1Connect to the MA/MB terminals . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .66 4.11.2Connect to the HART terminals . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .68 4.12Optional devices . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .69 4.12.1Tri-Loop™ HART to analog converter . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .69 4.12.2751 Field Signal Indicator . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .70 4.12.3Smart Wireless THUM™ Adapter . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .71 vi Contents Reference Manual Contents 00809-0100-4026, Rev HA November 2014 5Section 5: Basic Configuration/Start-up 5.1 Safety messages . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .73 5.2 Overview . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .74 5.2.1 Basic configuration parameters . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .74 5.2.2 Configuration tools . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .74 5.3 Basic configuration parameters. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .75 5.3.1 Measurement units . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .75 5.3.2 Tank geometry . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .75 5.3.3 Process conditions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .77 5.3.4 Volume configuration . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .78 5.3.5 Analog output (HART) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .81 5.3.6 Level and distance calibration . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .82 5.3.7 Echo tuning . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .83 5.3.8 ATC . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .84 5.4 Basic configuration using RRM . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .84 5.4.1 System requirements. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .84 5.4.2 Help in RRM . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .85 5.4.3 Installing the RRM software for HART communication . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .85 5.4.4 Specifying the COM port . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .87 5.4.5 To set the COM port buffers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .88 5.4.6 Specifying measurement units. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .88 5.4.7 Installing the RRM software for FOUNDATION fieldbus . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .88 5.4.8 Specifying measurement units. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .90 5.4.9 Using the Setup functions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .91 5.4.10Guided setup . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .92 5.4.11Using the Setup functions. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 100 5.5 Configuration using a Field Communicator . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 101 5.7 Basic configuration using AMS Suite. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 105 5.8 Configuration using DeltaV . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 106 5.8.1 Advanced configuration . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 111 5.9 FOUNDATION fieldbus overview . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 112 5.9.1 Assigning device tag and node address . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 113 5.9.2 Foundation fieldbus block operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 113 5.10Application examples . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 115 5.10.1Radar level transmitter - level value . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 115 5.10.2Radar level transmitter - level value in percent (%). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 116 5.11Tri-Loop™ HART to Analog Converter . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 117 5.12HART multidrop configuration . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 118 Contents vii Reference Manual Contents 00809-0100-4026, Rev HA November 2014 6Section 6: Operation 6.1 Safety messages . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 119 6.2 Viewing measurement data . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 120 6.2.1 Using the display panel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 120 6.2.2 Specifying display panel variables . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 120 6.2.3 Viewing measurement data in RRM . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 124 6.2.4 Viewing measurement data in AMS Suite and DeltaV . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 125 6.3 LCD display error messages . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 126 6.4 LED error messages . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 127 7Section 7: Service and Troubleshooting 7.1 Safety messages . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 129 7.2 Troubleshooting overview . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 131 7.3 Service overview. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 132 7.3.1 Analyzing the measurement signal . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 132 7.3.2 Surface pulse not found. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 133 7.3.3 Registration of false echoes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 135 7.3.4 Using the Echo Curve Analyzer. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 137 7.3.5 Using the Echo Curve Analyzer with a Field Communicator . . . . . . . . . . 140 7.4 Analog Output calibration . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 142 7.5 Logging measurement data. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 143 7.6 Backing up the transmitter configuration . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 144 7.7 Diagnostics . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 145 7.8 Configuration report . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 147 7.9 Viewing input and holding registers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 148 7.10Reset to factory settings. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 149 7.11Surface search . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 150 7.12Using the Simulation Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 151 7.13Write protecting a transmitter . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 152 7.14Diagnostic messages . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 153 7.14.1Troubleshooting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 153 7.14.2Device status . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 153 7.14.3Errors. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 154 7.14.4Warnings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 155 7.14.5Measurement status . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 155 7.14.6Volume calculation status. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 157 7.14.7Analog Output status. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 158 7.14.8Application errors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 159 viii Contents Reference Manual Contents 00809-0100-4026, Rev HA November 2014 7.15Troubleshooting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 163 7.15.1Resource block . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 164 7.15.2Transducer block . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 165 7.15.3Analog Input (AI) function block . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 165 8Section 8: Safety Instrumented Systems (4-20 mA Only) 8.1 Safety messages . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 167 8.2 Overview . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 168 8.2.1 Applicable models . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 168 8.2.2 Skill level of personnel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 169 8.3 Functional specifications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 169 8.4 Installation. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 169 8.5 Configuration . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 171 8.5.1 Damping. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 171 8.5.2 Alarm and saturation levels. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 171 8.5.3 Amplitude threshold . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 172 8.5.4 Write protection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 172 8.5.5 Site acceptance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 172 8.6 Operation and maintenance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 172 8.6.1 General . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 172 8.6.2 Inspection. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 173 8.7 References. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 174 8.7.1 Specifications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 174 8.7.2 Failure rate data . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 174 8.7.3 Useful lifetime . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 174 8.8 Spare parts. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 174 8.9 Terms and definitions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 174 AAppendix A: Reference Data A.1 Functional specifications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 177 A.1.1 General . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 177 A.1.2 4-20 mA HART® (output option code H) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 178 A.1.3 Foundation™ fieldbus (output option code F) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 181 A.1.4 RS-485 with Modbus communication (output option code M) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 183 A.1.5 Display and configuration . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 185 A.1.6 Diagnostics . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 186 A.1.7 Temperature and pressure limits. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 187 Contents ix Reference Manual Contents 00809-0100-4026, Rev HA November 2014 A.2 Performance specifications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 189 A.2.1 General . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 189 A.2.2 Measuring range . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 190 A.2.3 Beam angle and beam width . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 191 A.2.4 Transition zone and near zone . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 193 A.2.5 Environment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 194 A.3 Physical specifications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 195 A.3.1 Material selection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 195 A.3.2 Housing and closure. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 195 A.3.3 Engineered solutions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 196 A.3.4 Tank connection and antennas . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 196 A.4 Dimensional drawings and mechanical properties . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 200 A.4.1 Rosemount 5402 and 5401 with SST Cone Antenna (Model Code: 2S-8S). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 200 A.4.2 Rosemount 5402 and 5401 with Protective Plate Cone Antenna (Model Code: 2H-8H, 2M-8M, and 2N-8N) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 201 A.4.3 Rosemount 5401 with Rod Antenna (Model Code: 1R-4R). . . . . . . . . . . 202 A.4.4 Rosemount 5402 with Process Seal Antenna (Model Code: 2P-4P) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 203 A.4.5 Bracket mounting (Model Code: BR). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 204 A.4.6 Process connections. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 205 A.5 Ordering information . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 206 BAppendix B: Product Certifications B.1 Safety messages . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 217 B.2 European Directive information . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 219 B.3 FCC and ICC . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 219 B.4 Safety Instrumented Systems (SIS) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 219 B.5 Hazardous locations certifications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 220 B.5.1 North-American certifications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 220 B.5.2 Canadian Standards Association (CSA) Approvals . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 221 B.5.3 European certifications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 222 B.5.4 IECEx Approval. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 224 B.5.5 EAC certifications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 225 B.5.6 Brazilian certifications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 226 B.5.7 Chinese certifications. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 226 B.5.8 Japanese certifications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 227 B.5.9 Other certifications. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 228 B.5.10Canadian Registration Number (CRN) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 229 Contents Reference Manual Contents 00809-0100-4026, Rev HA November 2014 B.6 Approval drawings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 230 CAppendix C: Advanced Configuration C.1 Tank geometry . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 237 C.1.1 Distance offset (G) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 237 C.1.2 Minimum level offset (C) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 238 C.1.3 Hold off distance. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 238 C.1.4 Calibration distance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 238 C.2 Advanced analog output settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 239 C.3 Advanced transmitter settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 239 C.3.1 Antenna type . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 239 C.3.2 Empty tank handling . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 239 C.3.3 Full tank handling . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 241 C.3.4 Double bounce . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 241 C.3.5 Surface echo tracking . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 242 C.3.6 Filter settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 243 C.4 Advanced functions in RRM . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 243 C.4.1 Empty tank handling . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 243 C.4.2 Full tank handling . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 247 C.4.3 Double bounce . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 248 C.4.4 Surface echo tracking . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 249 C.4.5 Hold off setting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 250 DAppendix D: Performing Proof Test D.1 Performing proof test . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 251 D.2 Field communicator. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 251 D.3 RRM. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 253 D.4 AMS Suite. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 255 EAppendix E: Level Transducer Block E.1 Overview . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 257 E.1.1 Definition . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 257 E.1.2 Channel definitions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 257 E.2 Parameters and descriptions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 258 E.3 Supported units . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 263 E.3.1 Unit codes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 263 E.4 Diagnostics device errors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 264 Contents xi Reference Manual Contents 00809-0100-4026, Rev HA November 2014 FAppendix F: Register Transducer Block F.1 Overview . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 265 F.1.1 Register access transducer block parameters . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 265 GAppendix G: Advanced Configuration Transducer Block G.1 Overview . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 269 G.1.1 Advanced configuration transducer block parameters . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 269 HAppendix H: Resource Block H.1 Overview . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 273 H.2 Parameters and descriptions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 273 H.2.1 PlantWeb® alerts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 278 H.2.2 Alarm priority. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 281 H.2.3 Recommended actions for PlantWeb alerts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 282 IAppendix I: Analog-Input Block I.1 Simulation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 288 I.2 Damping . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 289 I.3 Signal conversion . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 289 I.4 Block errors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 290 I.5 Modes. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 290 I.6 Alarm detection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 291 I.6.1 Status handling . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 292 I.7 Configure the AI block. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 293 xii Contents Reference Manual Section 1: Introduction 00809-0100-4026, Rev HA November 2014 Section 1 Introduction Manual overview . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . page 1 Service support . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . page 3 Product recycling/ disposal . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . page 4 Safety messages . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . page 4 1.1 Manual overview The sections in this manual provide installation, configuration, and maintenance information for the Rosemount 5400 Series Radar Level Transmitter. The sections are organized as follows: Section 2: Transmitter Overview Theory of operation Description of the transmitter Process and vessel characteristics Section 3: Mechanical Installation Installation procedure Mounting considerations Mounting Section 4: Electrical Installation Introduction Cable/conduit entries Grounding Cable selection Hazardous areas External circuit breaker Power requirements Connecting the transmitter Non-intrinsically safe power supply Intrinsically safe power supply Optional devices Reference Manual Section 1: Introduction 00809-0100-4026, Rev HA November 2014 Section 5: Basic Configuration/Start-up Configuration instructions Configuration using the Rosemount Radar Master (RRM) software Configuration using a Field Communicator Configuration using AMS® Suite Configuration using DeltaV™ FOUNDATIONTM fieldbus overview Section 6: Operation Viewing measurement data with a display panel Viewing measurement data in RRM Viewing measurement data in AMS Suite and DeltaV Section 7: Service and Troubleshooting Troubleshooting Error and warning codes Communication errors Section 8: Safety Instrumented Systems (4-20 mA Only) Functional specifications Installation Configuration Operation and maintenance Spare parts Appendix A: Reference Data Specifications Dimensional drawings and mechanical properties Process connections Ordering information Appendix B: Product Certifications Examples of labels European ATEX Directive information FM approvals CSA approvals IECEx approvals TIIS approval NEPSI approvals INMETRO approvals Approval drawings Introduction Reference Manual Section 1: Introduction 00809-0100-4026, Rev HA November 2014 Appendix C: Advanced Configuration Advanced tank geometry Advanced transmitter settings Advanced functions in RRM Appendix D: Performing Proof Test Describes the process of performing proof test Appendix E: Level Transducer Block Describes the operation and parameters of the Level Transducer Block Appendix F: Register Transducer Block Describes the operation and parameters of the Register Transducer Block Appendix G: Advanced Configuration Transducer Block Describes the operation and parameters of the Advanced Configurations Transducer Block Appendix H: Resource Block Describes the operation and parameters of the Resource Block Appendix I: Analog-Input Block 1.2 Describes the operation and parameters of the Analog-Input function block Service support To expedite the return process outside of the United States, contact the nearest Emerson Process Management representative. Within the United States, call the Emerson Process Management Instrument and Valves Response Center using the 1-800-654-RSMT (7768) toll-free number. This center, available 24 hours a day, will assist you with any needed information or materials. The center will ask for product model and serial numbers, and will provide a Return Material Authorization (RMA) number. The center will also ask for the process material to which the product was last exposed. Individuals who handle products exposed to a hazardous substance can avoid injury if they are informed of and understand the hazard. If the product being returned was exposed to a hazardous substance as defined by Occupational Safety and Health Administration (OSHA), a copy of the required Material Safety Data Sheet (MSDS) for each hazardous substance identified must be included with the returned goods. Introduction Section 1: Introduction Reference Manual 00809-0100-4026, Rev HA November 2014 Emerson Process Management Instrument and Valves Response Center representatives will explain the additional information and procedures necessary to return goods exposed to hazardous substances. 1.3 Product recycling/ disposal Recycling of equipment and packaging should be taken into consideration and disposed of in accordance with local and national legislation/regulations. 1.4 Safety messages Procedures and instructions in this manual may require special precautions to ensure the safety of the personnel performing the operations. Information that raises potential safety issues is indicated by a warning symbol ( ). Refer to the safety messages listed at the beginning of each section before performing an operation preceded by this symbol. Introduction Reference Manual Section 1: Introduction 00809-0100-4026, Rev HA November 2014 Failure to follow safe installation and service guidelines could result in death or serious injury. Make sure the transmitter is installed by qualified personnel and in accordance with applicable code of practice. Use the equipment only as specified in this manual. Failure to do so may impair the protection provided by the equipment. Do not perform any services other than those contained in this manual unless you are qualified. Any substitution of non-authorized parts or repair, other than exchanging the complete transmitter head or antenna assembly, may jeopardize safety and is prohibited. Unauthorized changes to the product are strictly prohibited as they may unintentionally and unpredictably alter performance and jeopardize safety. Unauthorized changes that interfere with the integrity of the welds or flanges, such as making additional perforations, compromise product integrity and safety. Equipment ratings and certifications are no longer valid on any products that have been damaged or modified without the prior written permission of Emerson Process Management. Any continued use of product that has been damaged or modified without prior written authorization is at the customer's sole risk and expense. Explosions could result in death or serious injury. Verify that the operating environment of the transmitter is consistent with the appropriate hazardous locations specifications. See “Product Certifications” on page 217 in this manual. To prevent ignition of flammable or combustible atmospheres, disconnect power before servicing. In an Explosion-proof/Flameproof installation, do not remove the transmitter cover when power is applied to the unit. Before connecting a HART®, FOUNDATION™ fieldbus, or Modbus® based communicator in an explosive atmosphere, make sure the instruments in the loop are installed in accordance with intrinsically safe or non-incendive field wiring practices. To avoid process leaks, only use O-rings designed to seal with the corresponding flange adapter. Electrical shock can result in death or serious injury. Avoid contact with the leads and terminals. High voltage that may be present on leads can cause electrical shock. Make sure the main power to the Rosemount 5400 Series transmitter is off and the lines to any other external power source are disconnected or not powered while wiring the transmitter. Antennas with non-conducting surfaces. Introduction Antennas with non-conducting surfaces (e.g. Rod antenna and Process Seal antenna) may generate an ignition-capable level of electrostatic charge under extreme conditions. Therefore, when the antenna is used in a potentially explosive atmosphere, appropriate measures must be taken to prevent electrostatic discharge. Section 1: Introduction November 2014 Reference Manual 00809-0100-4026, Rev HA Introduction Reference Manual Section 2: Transmitter Overview 00809-0100-4026, Rev HA November 2014 Section 2 Transmitter Overview Theory of operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . page 7 Application examples . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . page 8 System architecture . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . page 10 Process characteristics . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . page 12 Components of the transmitter . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . page 14 Antenna selection guide/measuring range . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . page 15 2.1 Theory of operation The Rosemount 5400 Series Radar Transmitter is a smart, two-wire continuous level transmitter. A 5400 transmitter is installed at the top of the tank and emits short microwave pulses towards the product surface in the tank. When a pulse reaches the surface, part of the energy is reflected back to the antenna for subsequent processing by the transmitter electronics. The time difference between the transmitted and reflected pulse is detected by a micro-processor and is converted into a distance, which calculates the level. The product level is related to the tank height and the measured distance by the following expression: Level = Tank Height - Distance Figure 2-1. Measurement Principle for the Rosemount 5400 Series Time Transmitter Overview Level Radar Pulse Tank Height Distance Signal Amplitude Reference Manual Section 2: Transmitter Overview 00809-0100-4026, Rev HA November 2014 2.2 Application examples Tanks, vessels, and containers with calm surfaces Non-contacting radar can be used in less challenging applications, such as storage and buffer tanks: It is easy to mount, maintenance-free, and highly accurate Gives precise monitoring and control of the process Overfill and underfill detection The Rosemount 5400 Series can be advantageous in risk reduction systems: Continuous measurement may reduce or simplify proof-tests Multiple 5400s can be used in the same tank Corrosives Radar measurement is ideal for most corrosive products, such as caustics, acids, solvents, and many other chemicals: Does not contact the process product Wide material offering such as PTFE, Alloy C-276 and Alloy 400 Works well in non-metallic tanks also Sticky, viscous, and crystallizing products The best-in-class Rosemount 5400 Series provides an accurate and reliable level reading with difficult products, such as resins and adhesives: Non-contacting is best practice Almost unaffected by coating and build-up because of the uniquely designed condensation resistant antennas Sludges and slurries Applications like mud, pulp-stock, and lime slurries are ideal for non-contacting measurement: Immune to splashing and solids content Unaffected by density changes No re-calibration, no or little maintenance Transmitter Overview Reference Manual Section 2: Transmitter Overview 00809-0100-4026, Rev HA November 2014 Reactor vessels The innovative design of the Rosemount 5400 Series makes it an excellent choice for the most difficult applications, such as reactor vessels: Unique circular polarization provides greater mounting flexibility – no tank wall clearance distance is needed Direct measurement – independent of most variations in process conditions, such as density, dielectric, vapor, temperature, and pressure Can handle turbulent conditions created by agitation, top-filling, or process reaction Mounting flexibility The versatile Rosemount 5400 Series can be used in mounting configurations other than standard nozzles: Fits most existing pipes: 2-8 in. (50-200 mm) Easy to isolate from the process – use a ball-valve Still-pipes reduce the influence of foam, turbulence, and tank obstructions. Ball-valves can be used on both still-pipes and nozzles. Underground tanks The mounting flexibility of the Rosemount 5400 Series makes it an excellent choice for many underground tanks: Transmitter Overview Easy top-mounting Can handle long narrow nozzles up to 6 ft (2 m) as long as they are clean and smooth, and pipes Unaffected by dirty products with solids content Reference Manual Section 2: Transmitter Overview 00809-0100-4026, Rev HA November 2014 2.3 System architecture The Rosemount 5400 Series Radar Transmitter is loop-powered, and uses the same two wires for power supply and output signal. The output is a 4-20 mA analog signal superimposed with a digital HART®, FOUNDATION™ fieldbus or Modbus® signal. By using the optional HART Tri-Loop™, the HART signal can be converted up to three additional 4-20 mA analog signals. With the HART protocol, multidrop configuration is possible. In this case, communication is restricted to digital, since current is fixed to the 4 mA minimum value. The transmitter can be connected to a Rosemount 751 Field Signal Indicator, or it can be equipped with an integral display. The transmitter can easily be configured using a Field Communicator or a PC with the Rosemount Radar Master (RRM) software. Rosemount 5400 Series transmitters can also be configured with the AMS® Suite and DeltaV™ software, and other tools that support Electronic Device Description Language (EDDL) functionality. For HART communication, a minimum load resistance of 250 : within the loop is required. Figure 2-2. HART System Architecture 3 x 4-20 mA Rosemount 5400 Series Radar Transmitter Rosemount 751 Field Signal Indicator DCS Tri-Loop Integral Display HART modem Field Communicator 10 RRM or AMS Suite Transmitter Overview Reference Manual Section 2: Transmitter Overview 00809-0100-4026, Rev HA November 2014 Figure 2-3. FOUNDATION fieldbus System Architecture Host / DCS system (e.g. DeltaV) Maintenance FOUNDATION fieldbus H2 - High Speed Field Bus H1 - Low Speed Field Bus Fieldbus Modem Field Communicator Note Intrinsically safe installations may allow fewer devices per I.S. barrier due to current limitations. Rosemount 5401 Rosemount 5402 6200 ft (1900 m) max (depending upon cable characteristics) Configuration with RRM (hooked up on Fieldbus segment) Rosemount 5601 The RS-485 Modbus version communicates by Modbus RTU, Modbus ASCII, and Level Master Protocols. HART communication is used for configuration via HART terminals, or tunneling via the RS-485. Figure 2-4. RS-485 with Modbus Communication Rosemount 5400 Series Transmitter Power Modbus, Levelmaster Emulation / RS-485 Control System HART Modem RS-232 / RS-485 Converter Field Communicator Transmitter Overview PC 5400 Setup in RRM PC 5400 Setup in RRM through Tunneling 11 Section 2: Transmitter Overview 2.4 Reference Manual 00809-0100-4026, Rev HA November 2014 Process characteristics Dielectric constant A key parameter for measurement performance is reflectivity. A high dielectric constant of the media provides better reflection and enables a longer measuring range. Foam Rosemount 5400 Series Radar Transmitter measurement in foamy applications depends on the foam properties; light and airy or dense and heavy, high or low dielectrics, etc. If the foam is conductive and creamy, the transmitter may measure the surface of the foam. If the foam is less conductive, the microwaves may penetrate the foam and measure the liquid surface. Turbulence A calm surface gives better reflection than a turbulent surface. For turbulent applications, the maximum range of the radar transmitters is reduced. The range depends on the frequency, the antenna size, the dielectric of the material, and the degree of turbulence. Consult Tables 2-2 and 2-3 on page 16 for the expected maximum range with the variables listed. Temperature/pressure/density and vapor Temperature, pressure, product density, and vapor generally have no impact on measurements. Condensation For applications where heavy condensation and vapors may occur, the low frequency version Rosemount 5401 is recommended. Tank characteristics The conditions inside the tank have a significant impact on measurement performance. For more information see “Vessel characteristics” on page 35. Solid surface The surface of solid materials is rarely flat or horizontal. The angle of repose, or surface inclination, will change as the vessel fills and empties. There is often a lot of dust during the fill cycle. The dielectric value of many solids is fairly low. See Table 2-1 on page 2-13 for common solids characteristics. For solids applications, the high frequency version Rosemount 5402 with 4 inch cone antenna is available. 12 Transmitter Overview Reference Manual Section 2: Transmitter Overview 00809-0100-4026, Rev HA November 2014 Table 2-1. Sample Solids Applications(1) Common characteristics Particle size Dust or Powder Small (<1 in.) Larger (>1 in.) Dust Steam or Condensation Wood chip bins Yes Yes Yes Yes Possible Grain silo - small kernel grains Yes Yes No Yes No Grain silo - large kernel grains No Yes No No No Lime stone silo No Yes Yes Possible No Cement - raw mill silo Yes Yes No Yes No Cement - finished product silo Yes Yes No Yes No Coal bin Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes Saw dust Yes Yes No Yes No High consistency pulp stock No No No No Yes Alumina Yes Yes No Yes No Salt No Yes Yes No No Applications (1) Vapor space Air purging might be needed in dusty environments. Transmitter Overview 13 Reference Manual Section 2: Transmitter Overview 00809-0100-4026, Rev HA November 2014 2.5 Components of the transmitter The Rosemount 5400 Series Radar Transmitter is available with a die-cast aluminum or stainless steel (SST) housing containing advanced electronics for signal processing. The radar electronics produces an electromagnetic pulse that is emitted through the antenna. There are different antenna types and sizes available for various applications. The transmitter head has separate compartments for electronics and terminals, and can be removed without opening the tank. The head has two entries for conduit/cable connections. The tank connection consists of a Tank Seal and a flange (ANSI, EN (DIN) or JIS). Figure 2-5. Transmitter Components A. Display Panel B. Cable Entry: ½" NPT. Optional adapters: M20 C. Tank Seal D. Flange E. Terminal side F. Cable Entry: ½" NPT. Optional adapters: M20 G. Transmitter head with Radar electronics H. Antenna 14 Transmitter Overview Reference Manual Section 2: Transmitter Overview 00809-0100-4026, Rev HA 2.6 November 2014 Antenna selection guide/measuring range The measuring range depends on the microwave frequency, antenna size, the dielectric constant (Hr) of the liquid, and process conditions. A higher dielectric constant value produces a stronger reflection. The figures in the tables below are guidelines for optimum performance. Larger measuring ranges may be possible. For more information, contact your local Emerson Process Management representative. A. Oil, gasoline or other hydrocarbons, and petrochemicals (Hr = 1.9-4.0). In pipes or with ideal surface conditions, for some liquefied gases (Hr = 1.4-4.0). B. Alcohols, concentrated acids, organic solvents, oil/water mixtures, and acetone (Hr = 4.0-10.0). C. Conductive liquids, e.g. water based solutions, dilute acids, and alkalis (Hr > 10.0). Table 2-2. Rosemount 5402, Maximum Recommended Measuring Range, ft (m) High frequency antennas Dielectric constant(1) 2-in. Cone/ Process seal 33 (10) 49 (15) 66 (20) 82 (25) 115 (35) 115 (35) 9.8 (3) 20 (6) 33 (10) 3-in. Cone/ Process seal 49 (15) 66 (20) 98 (30) 82 (25) 115 (35) 115 (35) 13 (4) 30 (9) 39 (12) 4-in. Cone/ Process seal 66 (20) 82 (25) 115 (35) 82 (25) 115 (35) 115 (35) 23 (7) 39 (12) 49 (15) (1) A. Oil, gasoline or other hydrocarbons, and petrochemicals (Hr = 1.9-4.0) In pipes or with ideal surface conditions, for some liquefied gases (Hr = 1.4-4.0) B. Alcohols, concentrated acids, organic solvents, oil/water mixtures, and acetone (Hr = 4.0-10.0) C. Conductive liquids, e.g. water based solutions, dilute acids, and alkalis (Hr > 10.0) Transmitter Overview 15 Reference Manual Section 2: Transmitter Overview 00809-0100-4026, Rev HA November 2014 Table 2-3. Rosemount 5401, Maximum Recommended Measuring Range, ft (m) Low Frequency Antennas Dielectric Constant(1) 3-in. Cone(2) NA NA NA 82 (25) 115 (35) 115 (35) NA NA NA 4-in. Cone / Rod(3) 23 (7) 39 (12) 49 (15) 82 (25) 115 (35) 115 (35) 13 (4) 26 (8) 39 (12) 6-in. Cone 43 (13) 66 (20) 82 (25) 82 (25) 115 (35) 115 (35) 20 (6) 33 (10) 46 (14) 8-in. Cone 66 (20) 82 (25) 115 (35) 82 (25) 115 (35) 115 (35) 26 (8) 39 (12) 52 (16) (1) a. Oil, gasoline or other hydrocarbons, and petrochemicals (Hr = 1.9-4.0) In pipes or with ideal surface conditions, for some liquefied gases (Hr = 1.4-4.0) b. Alcohols, concentrated acids, organic solvents, oil/water mixtures, and acetone (Hr = 4.0-10.0) c. Conductive liquids, e.g. water based solutions, dilute acids, and alkalis (Hr > 10.0) (2) Pipe installations only. NA = Not Applicable. (3) Pipe installations are not allowed with rod antennas. 16 Transmitter Overview Reference Manual Section 2: Transmitter Overview 00809-0100-4026, Rev HA November 2014 Table 2-4. Model and Antenna Guide 5402 Model and antenna guide This table gives guidelines on which model and antenna to select, depending on application. 5401 Cone (preferred) Process seal Best choice for a broad range of applications, free propagation and pipe installations. Ideal for small tanks and corrosive applications. Also good for heavy antenna condensation/build-up. Cone (preferred) Rod G = Good AD = Application Dependent (consult your local Emerson Process Management representative) NR = Not Recommended Suitable for some extreme process conditions. Suitable for small process connections, and corrosive environment. Tank considerations Installation close to smooth tank wall Multiple units on the same tank NR NR AD AD Internal obstructions, avoidance NR NR Beam angle 2” 19° 3” 14° 4” 9° 2” 19° 3” 14° 4” 9° 4” 37° 6” 23° 8” 17° 37° Antenna extends below nozzle Internal obstructions, directly in path(1) (1) (2) Antenna recessed in smooth nozzle up to 6 ft (2 m) NR NR(3) Antenna recessed in nozzle with irregularities, such as bad welds AD(4) AD AD(4) NR(3) Stilling well mounting G 2”- 4” pipe G 2”- 4” pipe G 3”- 8” pipe NR Valves NR NR Long ranges (>115’ / 35 m) NR NR NR NR Cleanability of antenna AD AD Vapor (light, medium) Vapor (heavy) NR AD Condensing vapor/product build-up(5) AD AD Boiling/Turbulent surface (low/medium) Boiling/Turbulent surface (heavy) AD AD G(6) NR Process medium characteristics Boiling/Turbulent surface (still-pipe) NR Foam(7) NR NR AD AD Foam (still-pipe)(7) NR Corrosive products (options available) G(8) G(8) G(8) Materials with very low dielectric AD Changing density/dielectric/pH/ pressure/temperature Coating/viscous/crystallizing liquids Solids, granules, powders NR NR NR (1) (2) (3) (4) (5) (6) (7) (8) The obstruction should not be within the radar beam. Preferred choices due to more narrow radar beam: Model 5402, and cone antenna. If tall nozzle, use extended antenna. The active part must protrude beneath the nozzle. An extended cone antenna must be used. Build-up can often be avoided or reduced by using heat-tracing or cleaning arrangements. Use a 6 or 8 in. (150-200 mm) cone antenna. Foam can either reflect, be invisible, or absorb the radar signal. Pipe mounting is advantageous since it reduces the foaming tendency. Other wetted material options include Alloy C-276 and Alloy 400. See the Rosemount 5400 Series Product Data Sheet (Document No. 00813-0100-4026) for details. Transmitter Overview 17 Section 2: Transmitter Overview Reference Manual November 2014 00809-0100-4026, Rev HA 18 Transmitter Overview Reference Manual Section 3: Mechanical Installation 00809-0100-4026, Rev HA Section 3 November 2014 Mechanical Installation Safety messages . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . page 19 Installation procedure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . page 21 Mounting considerations . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . page 22 Mounting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . page 36 3.1 Safety messages Procedures and instructions in this section may require special precautions to ensure the safety of the personnel performing the operations. Information that raises potential safety issues is indicated by a warning symbol ( ). Refer to the following safety messages before performing an operation preceded by this symbol. Mechanical Installation 19 Section 3: Mechanical Installation Reference Manual 00809-0100-4026, Rev HA November 2014 Failure to follow safe installation and service guidelines could result in death or serious injury. Make sure only qualified personnel perform installation or service. Use the equipment only as specified in this manual. Failure to do so may impair the protection provided by the equipment. Any substitution of non-recognized spare parts may jeopardize safety. Repair, e.g. substitution of components etc. may also jeopardize safety and is under no circumstances allowed. Process leaks could result in death or serious injury. Make sure that the transmitter is handled carefully. If the Process Seal is damaged, gas might escape from the tank if the transmitter head is removed from the antenna. Explosions could result in death or serious injury. Verify that the operating environment of the transmitter is consistent with the appropriate hazardous locations specifications. In an Explosion-proof/Flameproof installation, do not remove the transmitter cover when power is applied to the unit. Before connecting a HART®-based communicator in an explosive atmosphere, make sure the instruments in the loop are installed in accordance with intrinsically safe or non-incendive field wiring practices. Electrical shock can result in death or serious injury. Avoid contact with the leads and terminals. High voltage that may be present on leads can cause electrical shock. Make sure the main power to the Rosemount 5400 Series transmitter is off and the lines to any other external power source are disconnected or not powered while wiring the transmitter. Antennas with non-conducting surfaces. 20 Antennas with non-conducting surfaces (e.g. Rod antenna and Process Seal antenna) may generate an ignition-capable level of electrostatic charge under extreme conditions. Therefore, when the antenna is used in a potentially explosive atmosphere, appropriate measures must be taken to prevent electrostatic discharge. Mechanical Installation Reference Manual Section 3: Mechanical Installation 00809-0100-4026, Rev HA 3.2 November 2014 Installation procedure Follow these steps for proper installation: Review installation considerations (see page 22) Mount the transmitter (see page 36) Wire the transmitter (see page 43) Ground the housing (see page 46) Make sure covers and cable/conduit connections are tight Power up the transmitter Configure the transmitter (see page 73) Verify measurements Mechanical Installation 21 Reference Manual Section 3: Mechanical Installation 00809-0100-4026, Rev HA November 2014 3.3 Mounting considerations Before installing a Rosemount 5400 Series transmitter, consider specific mounting requirements, vessel, and process characteristics. 3.3.1 Mounting location For optimal performance, the transmitter should be installed in locations with a clear and unobstructed view of the level surface (A): Filling inlets creating turbulence (B), and stationary metallic objects with horizontal surfaces (C) should be kept outside the signal beam – see page 33 for beamwidth information Agitators with large horizontal blades may reduce the performance of the transmitter, so install the transmitter in a location where this effect is minimized. Vertical or slanted blades are often invisible to radar, but create turbulence (D) Do not install the transmitter in the center of the tank (E) Because of circular polarization, there is no clearance distance requirement from the tank wall if it is flat and free of obstructions such as heating coils and ladders (F). Usually, the optimal location is 1/4 of the diameter from the tank wall Note Proper mounting position is important to consider. Figure 3-1. Proper Mounting Position (D) 22 (A) (E) (B) (F) (C) The antenna is normally aligned vertically Mechanical Installation Reference Manual Section 3: Mechanical Installation 00809-0100-4026, Rev HA November 2014 A metal still-pipe can be used to avoid disturbing objects, turbulence, and foam (G) Figure 3-2. Mounting in Still-Pipe (G) The walls in non-metallic tanks are invisible to the radar signal, so nearby objects outside of the tank may be detected Choose the largest possible antenna diameter for installation. A larger antenna concentrates the radar beam, will be less susceptible to obstruction interference, and assures maximum antenna gain Multiple Rosemount 5400 Series transmitters can be used in the same tank without interfering with each other (H) Figure 3-3. Multiple Rosemount 5400 Series Transmitters in the Same Tank (H) Mechanical Installation 23 Reference Manual Section 3: Mechanical Installation 00809-0100-4026, Rev HA November 2014 3.3.2 Special considerations in solids applications The transmitter should be mounted as close to the center of the tank as possible, but not in the center of the tank. A general practice is to mount the transmitter at 2/3 tank radius from the tank wall, see Figure 3-4. Figure 3-4. Transmitter Location in Solids Applications The radar signal must never be shaded by the inlet nor the injected product, see Figure 3-5. Figure 3-5. Install the Transmitter with a Clear and Unobstructed View 24 Mechanical Installation Reference Manual Section 3: Mechanical Installation 00809-0100-4026, Rev HA 3.3.3 November 2014 Mounting in pipes Still-pipe mounting is recommended for tanks with extremely turbulent surface conditions. All cone antenna sizes for the Rosemount 5400 Series of transmitters can be used for Still-pipe installations. The 3 in. (75 mm) antenna for the 5401 is designed for use in Still-pipes only. Rod antennas are not recommended for Still-pipes. Max. 0.2 in (5 mm) When the transmitter is mounted on a Still-pipe, the inclination should be within 1°. The gap between the antenna and the Still-pipe may be up to 0.2 in. (5 mm). Figure 3-6. Mount the Transmitter Vertically max. 1 ° Recommendations for pipe installations Mechanical Installation The pipe interior must be smooth Not suitable for adhesive products At least one hole is above the product surface The hole diameter Ø should not exceed 10 % of the pipe diameter D Holes should only be drilled on one side 25 Section 3: Mechanical Installation Reference Manual 00809-0100-4026, Rev HA November 2014 Figure 3-7. Recommended Hole Size for Pipe Installations min. 6 in. (150 mm) max. Ø: D/10. 3.3.4 Installation considerations Generally, the radar signal is unaffected by condensation and low pressure steam. If affected, the lower microwave frequencies are less affected. The critical point is the tank penetration, which acts as a cold spot, where the condensation will form. The radar antenna is located at this cold spot. If droplets of water build up on the antenna parts, the microwave signal may get partially or even entirely blocked if the antenna is not designed for easy drip-off. Therefore, here it is beneficial to use as large opening for the microwaves as possible, which is the main reason for the oversized PTFE seal in the Rosemount 5400 Series Cone Antennas. An even better solution is to use a Process Seal Antenna if the process pressure permits that. To reduce the cold spot within the nozzle, it is always recommended to insulate the nozzle. By doing so, the temperature in the nozzle will be the same as in the rest of the vessel and condensation will thus be reduced. If the temperature in the tank is much higher than the ambient temperature (i.e. tank is heated and located in a cold area), it might be necessary to heat trace the nozzle in addition to the insulation. Figure 3-8. Insulate Nozzle to Avoid Condensation 26 Mechanical Installation Reference Manual Section 3: Mechanical Installation 00809-0100-4026, Rev HA 3.3.5 November 2014 Nozzle considerations Special considerations may have to be taken because of the nozzle, depending on the selection of transmitter model and antenna. 5402 with cone antenna The antenna can be recessed in smooth nozzles up to 6 ft (2 m). If the inside of the nozzle contains disturbing objects, use the extended cone (I). Figure 3-9. Nozzle Considerations for 5402 with Cone Antenna (I) Spray nozzle Smooth nozzle Bad weldings 5402 with process seal antenna The antenna can be used on nozzles up to 6 ft (2 m), (J). Disturbing objects inside the nozzle (K) may impact the measurement, and should therefore be avoided. The flange on the tank should have a flat or raised face. Other tank flanges may be possible, please consult your local Emerson Process Management representative for advice. Figure 3-10. Nozzle Considerations for 5402 with Process Seal Antenna (J) (K) Bad welding Mechanical Installation 27 Reference Manual Section 3: Mechanical Installation 00809-0100-4026, Rev HA November 2014 5401 with cone antenna The antenna should extend 0.4 in. (10 mm), or more, below the nozzle (L). If required, use the extended cone solution. Figure 3-11. Nozzle Considerations for 5401 with Cone Antenna (L) 0.4 in. (10 mm) or more 5401 with rod antenna The active part of the rod antenna should protrude below the nozzle (M). Figure 3-12. Nozzle Considerations for 5401 with Rod Antenna (M) Active part starts here Max. 4 or 10 in. (100 or 250 mm) for short and long version respectively Still-pipes in metallic materials If used correctly, pipe measurement can be advantageous in many applications: 28 The 5402 is the preferred choice for smaller pipe diameters Use the 5401 for larger pipe diameters (6-8 in./150-200 mm), pipes with larger holes or slots, or for dirty/sticky media Use cone or process seal antennas - not the rod antenna The gap between the cone antenna and the still-pipe is limited to 0.2 in. (5 mm). If required, order an oversized antenna and cut on location (N). Only applicable to 5401 cone antennas and cone antennas with wetted flange plate (i.e. straight antennas). The inside of the chamber must be of a constant diameter Mechanical Installation Reference Manual Section 3: Mechanical Installation 00809-0100-4026, Rev HA November 2014 Note Match antenna size to the stilling well diameter. Figure 3-13. Nozzle Considerations for Still-Pipes in Metallic Materials (N) Max. 0.2 in. (5 mm) Ball-valve installation The Rosemount 5400 Series transmitter can be isolated from the process by using a valve: Mechanical Installation The 5402 is the preferred choice for long nozzle measurement Use the largest possible antenna Use a full-port ball valve Ensure there is no edge between the ball valve and the nozzle or stilling well, the inside should be smooth Valves can be combined with stilling wells 29 Reference Manual Section 3: Mechanical Installation 00809-0100-4026, Rev HA November 2014 3.3.6 Nozzle recommendations and requirements The Rosemount 5400 Series is mounted on a nozzle by using appropriate flanges. For best performance, it is recommended that the nozzle meets the following recommendations for height (L) and diameter: Figure 3-14. Mounting of the Rosemount 5400 Series Transmitter Process seal antenna Rod antenna Cone antenna Extended cone antenna > 0.4 in. (10 mm) Minimum diameter > 0.4 in. (10 mm) Minimum diameter Minimum diameter Minimum diameter Table 3-1. Minimum Nozzle Diameter and Recommended Maximum Nozzle Height for Cone Antennas Model Antenna / material L max in. (mm) Min. diameter in. (mm) 5402(1) Cone 2 in. (50 mm) SST 6.1 (155) 2.2 (55) Cone 3 in. (75 mm) SST 5.5 (140) 2.8 (72) Cone 4 in. (100 mm) SST 8.5 (215) 3.8 (97) Cone 2 in. (50 mm) Alloy C-276, Alloy 400 5.5 (140) 2.2 (55) Cone 3 in. (75 mm) Alloy C-276, Alloy 400 6.5 (165) 2.8 (72) Cone 4 in. (100 mm) Alloy C-276, Alloy 400 9.6 (240) 3.8 (97) Cone 3 in. (75 mm) SST Pipe installations only Cone 4 in. (100 mm) SST 5.5 (140) 3.8 (97) Cone 6 in. (150 mm) SST 6.9 (175) 5.7 (145) Cone 8 in. (200 mm) SST 10.2 (260) 7.6 (193) Cone 3 in. (75 mm) Alloy C-276, Alloy 400 Pipe installations only Cone 4 in. (100 mm) Alloy C-276, Alloy 400 5.5 (140) 3.8 (97) Cone 6 in. (150 mm) Alloy C-276, Alloy 400 6.9 (175) 5.7 (145) Cone 8 in. (200 mm) Alloy C-276, Alloy 400 10.2 (260) 7.6 (193) 5401 30 Mechanical Installation Reference Manual Section 3: Mechanical Installation 00809-0100-4026, Rev HA November 2014 (1) For Rosemount 5402, the values for maximum nozzle height are recommendations. Note that the Rosemount 5402 with cone antenna can be recessed in smooth nozzles up to 6 ft (2m). Table 3-2. Minimum Nozzle Diameter and Maximum Nozzle Height for Rod Antennas Model 5401 (1) Antenna L max in. (mm) Min. diameter in. (mm) Rod (short) 4.0 (100) 1.5 (38) Rod (long) 10 (250) 1.5 (38) (1) For Rosemount 5401, the values for minimum nozzle diameter and maximum nozzle height are requirements. Table 3-3. Minimum Nozzle Diameter and Recommended Maximum Nozzle Height for Process Seal Antennas Model 5402 (1) Antenna L max in. (mm) Min. diameter in. (mm) Process Seal 2 in. (50 mm) 19.7 (500) 2.0 (51) Process Seal 3 in. (75 mm) 19.7 (500) 3.0 (77) Process Seal 4 in. (100 mm) 19.7 (500) 4.0 (102) (1) For Rosemount 5402, the values for maximum nozzle height are recommendations. Note that the Rosemount 5402 with process seal antenna can be recessed in smooth nozzles up to 6 ft (2m). Table 3-4. Minimum Nozzle Diameter and Maximum Nozzle Height for Extended Cone Antennas L max in. (mm) Min. diameter in. (mm) Model Antenna 5402(1) Extended Cone Antenna, S3(2) 20 in. (500 mm) See Table 3-1 5401 Extended Cone Antenna, S3(2) 20 in. (500 mm) See Table 3-1 (1) For Rosemount 5402, the values for maximum nozzle height are recommendations. (2) The extended cone antennas are available in 5 in. (125 mm) step increments from 10 to 50 in. (250-1250 mm). Consult your local Emerson Process Management representative for more information. Expect long lead times for sizes other than the 20 in. (500 mm) version. Install the transmitter as follows: Align the antenna vertically. Choose the largest antenna diameter possible. A larger receiving area concentrates the radar beam and ensures maximum antenna gain. Increased antenna gain permits greater margin for weak surface echoes. A larger antenna also results in smaller beam angle and thereby, less interference from any internal structures in the tank. For best measurement performance, the antenna should extend below the nozzle 0.4 in. (10 mm) or more. For more information, see “Nozzle considerations” on page 27. Mechanical Installation 31 Reference Manual Section 3: Mechanical Installation 00809-0100-4026, Rev HA November 2014 3.3.7 Service space For easy access to the transmitter, mount it with sufficient service space. There is no requirement on clearance distance from the tank wall, provided it is flat and free of obstructions such as heating coils and ladders. The optimal location is often 1/4 of the tank diameter. Figure 3-15. Service Space Recommendations Rod antenna Cone antenna Process seal antenna Service space Antenna type Distance in. (mm) Cone, rod, process seal 20 (500) Cone, rod 24 (600) Process seal 33 (850) Inclination Antenna type Maximum angle Cone, rod, process seal 3° 32 Mechanical Installation Reference Manual Section 3: Mechanical Installation 00809-0100-4026, Rev HA 3.3.8 November 2014 Beamwidth The following recommendations should be considered when mounting the transmitter: The transmitter should be mounted with as few internal structures as possible within the beam angle The flat tank wall can be located within the antenna beam angle if there is a minimum distance from the transmitter to the tank wall (see Figure 3-15 for preferred installation) Figure 3-16. Beamwidth at Various Distances from the Flange 5401 (low frequency) 5402 (high frequency) Distance 16 ft (5 m) 33 ft (10 m) 49 ft (15 m) 66 ft (20 m) Beamwidth Table 3-5. Beamwidth for the Rosemount 5402 Model (in ft [m]) Antenna Distance Mechanical Installation 2 in. (DN 50) cone/ process seal 3 in. (DN 80) cone/ process seal 4 in. (DN 100) cone/ process seal 16 ft (5 m) 4.9 (1.5) 3.3 (1.0) 3.3 (1.0) 33 ft (10 m) 9.8 (3.0) 6.6 (2.0) 4.9 (1.5) 49 ft (15 m) 14.8 (4.5) 9.8 (3.0) 8.2 (2.5) 66 ft (20 m) 19.7 (6.0) 13.1 (4.0) 9.8 (3.0) 33 Reference Manual Section 3: Mechanical Installation 00809-0100-4026, Rev HA November 2014 Table 3-6. Beamwidth for the Rosemount 5401 Model (in ft [m]) Antenna Distance 4 in. (DN 100) cone /rod 6 in. (DN 150) cone 8 in. (DN 200) cone 16 ft (5 m) 9.8 (3..0) 6.6 (2.0) 4.9 (1.5) 33 ft (10 m) 21.3 (6.5) 13.1 (4.0) 9.8 (3.0) 49 ft (15 m) 32.8 (10) 19.7 (6.0) 14.8 (4.5) 66 ft (20 m) 41 (12.5) 26.2 (8.0) 19.7 (6.0) Figure 3-17. Beam Angle Beam angle Table 3-7. Beam Angle for the Rosemount 5402 Antenna Beam angle 2 in. (50 mm) cone / process seal 19° 3 in. (75 mm) cone / process seal 14° 4 in. (100 mm) cone / process seal, rod 9° Table 3-8. Beam Angle for the Rosemount 5401 34 Antenna Beam angle 3 in. (75 mm) cone Pipe installations only 4 in. (100 mm) cone / rod 37° 6 in. (150 mm) cone 23° 8 in. (200 mm) cone 17° Mechanical Installation Reference Manual Section 3: Mechanical Installation 00809-0100-4026, Rev HA 3.3.9 November 2014 Vessel characteristics Heating coils, agitators and other objects in the tank may lead to disturbing echoes and noise in the measurement signal. Vertical structures cause minimal effect since the radar signal is scattered rather than directed back to the antenna. The shape of the tank bottom affects the measurement signal when the product surface is close to the tank bottom. The Rosemount 5400 Series has built-in functions which optimize measurement performance for various bottom shapes (see “Tank type and tank bottom type” on page 76). 3.3.10 Disturbing objects The Rosemount 5400 Series transmitter should be mounted so that objects such as heating coils, ladders, etc. are not in the radar signal path. These objects may cause false echoes resulting in reduced measurement performance. However, the transmitter has built-in functions designed to reduce the influence from disturbing objects where such objects cannot be totally avoided. The Rosemount 5402 has a narrower radar beam that is particularly suitable in installations with tall or narrow nozzles, or nozzles close to the tank wall. It may also be used to avoid disturbing objects in the tank. 3.3.11 Valves The Rosemount 5400 Series transmitter can be isolated from the process by using a valve: Use a full-port ball valve. The 5402 is the required and the Process Seal Antenna is the preferred choice, since it does not require a spool piece. The cone antenna can also be used. Ensure there is no edge between the ball valve and the nozzle/pipe, the inside should be smooth. Valves can be combined with stilling wells. Mechanical Installation 35 Reference Manual Section 3: Mechanical Installation 00809-0100-4026, Rev HA November 2014 3.4 Mounting Mount the transmitter on a nozzle on top of the tank making sure only qualified personnel perform the installation. The transmitter housing must not be opened. If the transmitter housing must be removed for service, make sure the PTFE sealing is carefully protected against dust and water. 3.4.1 Cone antenna flange connection Figure 3-18. Mounting the Rosemount 5400 with Cone Antenna and Flange A. Transmitter housing B. Nut, 40 Nm (30 Lbft) C. Bolt D. Nut E. Locking screw F. Flange G. Cone antenna H. Gasket I. Tank flange J. Nozzle 36 1. Place a gasket on top of the tank flange. 2. Lower the transmitter with antenna and flange into the tank nozzle. 3. Tighten the bolts and nuts with sufficient torque for the flange and gasket choice. Mechanical Installation Reference Manual Section 3: Mechanical Installation 00809-0100-4026, Rev HA 3.4.2 November 2014 Process seal antenna(1) Figure 3-19. Mounting the Rosemount 5400 with Process Seal and Flange A. Transmitter housing B. Nut, 40 Nm (30 Lbft) C. Nut D. Locking screw (ATEX) E. Bolt F. Flange G. Process Seal antenna H. Tank flange I. Nozzle (1) 1. Place the antenna on top of the nozzle. 2. Mount the flange and tighten the bolts cross-wise. For torque information, see Table 3-9. 3. Mount the transmitter head and tighten the nut to 40 Nm (30 Lbft). 4. Re-tighten the flange bolts after 24 hours. The mounting information applies to the updated Process Seal antenna design, released in February 2012. Antennas manufactured before this date have wetted O-rings and require a different installation procedure. For detailed information on the updated Process Seal antenna, see the Rosemount 5400 Series Reference Manual - Supplementary Information for Process Seal Antennas Manual Supplement (Document No. 00809-0700-4026). Mechanical Installation 37 Reference Manual Section 3: Mechanical Installation 00809-0100-4026, Rev HA November 2014 Table 3-9. Tightening Torque for Process Seal Flanges Flange 3.4.3 Torque (Nm) Torque (Lbft) 2 in. (50 mm), 150 lb. 40 30 2 in. (50 mm), 300 lb. 40 30 3 in. (75 mm), 150 lb. 60 44 3 in. (75 mm), 300 lb. 60 44 4 in. (100 mm), 150 lb. 50 37 4 in. (100 mm), 300 lb. 50 37 DN 50 PN 40 40 30 DN 80 PN 40 60 44 DN 100 PN 16 50 37 DN 100 PN 40 50 37 50A 10K 40 30 80A 10K 60 44 100A 10K 50 37 150A 10K 50 37 Rod antenna threaded connection Figure 3-20. Mounting the Rosemount 5400 with Rod Antenna and Threaded Tank Connection A. Transmitter housing B. Nut, 60 Nm (44 Lbft) C. Locking screw (ATEX) D. Sealant threads E. Rod antenna 1. Lower the transmitter and antenna into the tank. 2. Turn the transmitter until it is properly secured in the process connection. 3. Make sure the cable entries and display face the right direction. Note Tank connections with NPT threads require a sealant for pressure-tight joints. 38 Mechanical Installation Reference Manual Section 3: Mechanical Installation 00809-0100-4026, Rev HA 3.4.4 November 2014 Rod antenna flanged connection Figure 3-21. Mounting the Rosemount 5400 with Rod Antenna and Flange A. Transmitter housing B. Bolt C. Gasket (optional for the All PFA version) D.Nut E. Locking screw (ATEX) F. Flange G. PFA plate (only All PFA version, 1R, 2R) H. Tank flange I. Nozzle J. Rod antenna (1) 1. Place a gasket on top of the tank flange (1). The gasket thickness and material must be suitable for the process. 2. Lower the transmitter with antenna and flange into the tank nozzle. 3. Tighten the bolts and nuts with sufficient torque for the flange and gasket choice. Gasket is optional for the All-PFA version of the rod antenna. Mechanical Installation 39 Reference Manual Section 3: Mechanical Installation 00809-0100-4026, Rev HA November 2014 3.4.5 Tri-Clamp™ tank connection Figure 3-22. Mounting the Rosemount 5400 using a Tri-Clamp A. Nut B. Rod antenna C. Gasket D. Tank connection E. Tri-Clamp F. Clamp 40 1. Place a gasket on top of the tank flange. 2. Lower the transmitter and antenna into the tank. 3. Fasten the Tri-Clamp to the tank with a clamp. 4. To rotate the transmitter housing, loosen the nut. 5. Rotate the transmitter housing so the cable entries / display face the desired direction. 6. Tighten the nut. Mechanical Installation Reference Manual Section 3: Mechanical Installation 00809-0100-4026, Rev HA 3.4.6 November 2014 Bracket mounting on wall Figure 3-23. Bracket Mounting the Rosemount 5400, on Wall A. Transmitter housing B. Antenna C. Bracket Mechanical Installation 1. Mount the bracket directly to the wall with screws suitable for the purpose. 2. Mount the transmitter with antenna to the bracket, then secure the installation with the three supplied screws. 41 Reference Manual Section 3: Mechanical Installation 00809-0100-4026, Rev HA November 2014 3.4.7 Bracket mounting on pipe Figure 3-24. Bracket Mounting the Rosemount 5400, on Pipe A. U-bolts B. Bracket C. Clamping bracket D. Screws E. Transmitter housing F. Screw G. Antenna 42 1. Put the two U-bolts through the holes of the bracket. Holes are available for both vertical and horizontal pipe mounting. 2. Put the clamping brackets on the U-bolts and around the pipe. 3. Fasten the bracket to the pipe with the four supplied nuts. 4. Mount the transmitter with antenna to the bracket, and secure with the three supplied screws. Mechanical Installation Reference Manual Section 4: Electrical Installation 00809-0100-4026, Rev HA Section 4 November 2014 Electrical Installation Safety messages . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Wiring and power supply requirements . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Cable/conduit entries . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Grounding . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Cable selection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Hazardous areas . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . External circuit breaker . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . HART . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . FOUNDATION fieldbus . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . HART to Modbus Converter (HMC) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Establish HART communication . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Optional devices . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4.1 page 43 page 44 page 45 page 46 page 46 page 47 page 47 page 49 page 55 page 60 page 66 page 69 Safety messages Procedures and instructions in this section may require special precautions to ensure the safety of the personnel performing the operations. Information that raises potential safety issues is indicated by a warning symbol ( ). Refer to the following safety messages before performing an operation preceded by this symbol. Electrical Installation 43 Reference Manual Section 4: Electrical Installation 00809-0100-4026, Rev HA November 2014 Failure to follow safe installation and service guidelines could result in death or serious injury. Make sure only qualified personnel perform installation or service. Use the equipment only as specified in this manual. Failure to do so may impair the protection provided by the equipment. Any substitution of non-recognized spare parts may jeopardize safety. Repair, e.g. substitution of components etc. may also jeopardize safety and is under no circumstances allowed. Do not perform any service other than those contained in this manual unless you are qualified. Process leaks could result in death or serious injury. Make sure that the transmitter is handled carefully. If the process seal is damaged, gas might escape from the tank if the transmitter head is removed from the antenna. Explosions could result in death or serious injury. Verify that the operating environment of the transmitter is consistent with the appropriate hazardous locations specifications. In an Explosion-proof/Flameproof installation, do not remove the transmitter cover when power is applied to the unit. Before connecting a HART®-based communicator in an explosive atmosphere, make sure the instruments in the loop are installed in accordance with intrinsically safe or non-incendive field wiring practices. Electrical shock can result in death or serious injury. Avoid contact with the leads and terminals. High voltage that may be present on leads can cause electrical shock. Make sure the main power to the Rosemount 5400 Series transmitter is off and the lines to any other external power source are disconnected or not powered while wiring the transmitter. High voltage that may be present on leads could cause electrical shock. Avoid contact with leads and terminals. Make sure the main power to the Rosemount 5400 transmitter is off and the lines to any other external power source are disconnected or not powered while wiring the gauge. Antennas with non-conducting surfaces. Antennas with non-conducting surfaces (e.g. rod antenna and process seal antenna) may generate an ignition-capable level of electrostatic charge under extreme conditions. Therefore, when the antenna is used in a potentially explosive atmosphere, appropriate measures must be taken to prevent electrostatic discharge. Additional warnings or restrictions may apply depending on type of Hazardous approval. See Appendix B: Product Certifications for details. 4.2 Wiring and power supply requirements Wiring and power supply requirements can be dependent upon the approval certification. As with all FOUNDATION™ fieldbus requirements, a conditioned power supply and terminating resistors are required for proper operation. 44 Electrical Installation Reference Manual Section 4: Electrical Installation 00809-0100-4026, Rev HA 4.3 November 2014 Cable/conduit entries The electronics housing has two entries with ½ - 14 NPT threads. Optional M20×1.5 adapters are also available. The connections shall be according to national, local, and plant electrical codes. Properly seal unused ports to prevent moisture or other contamination from entering the terminal compartment of the electronics housing. Install wiring with a drip loop with the bottom of the loop lower than the cable/conduit entry. Figure 4-1. Cable Entries Cable Entry (see Figure 2-5 on page 14) Cable Entry (see Figure 2-5 on page 14) Remove the orange protective plastic plugs, used for transportation. Seal any unused port with the enclosed metal plug. Note Use the enclosed metal plug to seal the unused port. The temporary orange plastic plugs used at delivery are not sufficient seals! Failure to use the metal plug to seal the unused port invalidates product certification. 4.3.1 Conduit electrical connector wiring (using minifast®) For wiring details, refer to pin-out drawing and the cordset manufacturer’s installation instructions. Figure 4-2. Quick Connect Housing Pin-Out “+” “-” Ground No connection For Rosemount 5400 Series transmitters with conduit electrical connector M, refer to the cordset manufacturer’s installation instructions for wiring details. Electrical Installation 45 Section 4: Electrical Installation 4.4 Reference Manual 00809-0100-4026, Rev HA November 2014 Grounding When wiring the transmitters, the grounding should be completed such that: The loop is grounded at the power supply. When transmitters are installed on metal tanks, ensure there is a metal-to-metal connection between the device and the tank. If the tank is non-metallic, the housing must be grounded to an earth ground that is separate from the power supply. The external ground terminal may be used for this purpose. If the tank is cathodically protected, the housing must be grounded to an earth ground that is outside of the cathodic protection system ground. Use the external terminal for this purpose. When transient protection terminal block is used, the ground wire should be separate from the signal wire. Use the external ground terminal. Make sure grounding is done (including IS ground inside Terminal compartment) according to Hazardous Locations Certifications, national and local electrical codes. The most effective transmitter housing grounding method is a direct connection to earth ground with minimal (< 1 :) impedance. Note Grounding the transmitter housing using the threaded conduit connection may not provide a sufficient ground. The transient protection terminal block will not provide transient protection unless the transmitter housing is properly grounded. Use the above guidelines to ground the transmitter housing. Do not run transient protection ground wire with signal wiring; the ground wire may carry excessive current if a lightning strike occurs. Note After installation and commissioning, make sure that no ground currents exist from high ground potential differences in the installation. 4.5 Cable selection Use shielded twisted pair wiring for the Rosemount 5400 Series. The cables must be suitable for the supply voltage and approved for use in hazardous areas, where applicable. For instance, in the U.S., explosion-proof conduits must be used in the vicinity of the vessel. For the ATEX flameproof approval version of the Rosemount 5400 Series, suitable conduits with sealing device or flameproof cable glands must be used depending on local requirements. Use 18 AWG to 12 AWG wiring to minimize the voltage drop to the transmitter. For Modbus® units (RS-485 bus), the following rules apply: 46 2 cables are used for communication: 24 AWG shielded twisted pair wiring is recommended to get an impedance of 120 : 2 cables are used for power: AWG 16-18 cables must be used Electrical Installation Reference Manual Section 4: Electrical Installation 00809-0100-4026, Rev HA November 2014 Note Avoid running instrument cable next to power cables in cable trays or near heavy electrical equipment. It is important that the instrument cable shield be: - trimmed close and insulated from touching the transmitter housing - continuously connected throughout the segment - connected to a good earth ground at the power supply end 4.6 Hazardous areas When the Rosemount 5400 Series transmitter is installed in a hazardous area, all national and local regulations and specifications in applicable certificates must be observed. 4.7 External circuit breaker For compliance with Low Voltage Directive 2006/95/EC, an external circuit breaker should be installed. 4.7.1 Connecting the transmitter The Rosemount 5400 Series accepts power supplies ranging from 16 Vdc to 42.4 Vdc. It uses 4-20 mA power superimposed with a HART signal. To connect the transmitter: 1. Verify that the power supply is disconnected. 2. Remove the terminal block cover (see Figure 4-3). 3. Pull the cable through the cable gland/conduit. For explosion-proof/ flameproof installations, only use cable glands or conduit entry devices certified explosion-proof or flameproof. Install the wiring with a drip loop where the bottom of the loop must be lower than the cable/conduit entry. 4. To connect the wires, see the illustrations on the following pages. 5. Remove the orange protective plastic plugs used for transportation. Seal any unused port with the enclosed metal plug. 6. Mount the cover and make sure it is fully engaged to meet explosion-proof requirements (adapters are required if M20 glands are used). For ATEX, IECEx, NEPSI, INMETRO, and TIIS installations, lock the cover with the locking screw. 7. Connect the power supply. Note Use PTFE tape or other sealant at the NPT threads in the cable entries. Electrical Installation 47 Reference Manual Section 4: Electrical Installation 00809-0100-4026, Rev HA November 2014 Figure 4-3. Terminal Compartment and External Ground Screw Blind plug Supplied for unused conduit opening. Terminals for signal and power supply External ground screw Cable entry NPT ½ in.-14, or M20 X 1.5 adapter Cable entry NPT ½ in.-14, or M20 X 1.5 adapter Internal ground screw Locking screw Note Remove the orange, protective, plastic plugs, used for transportation. Seal any unused port with the enclosed metal plug. 48 Electrical Installation Reference Manual Section 4: Electrical Installation 00809-0100-4026, Rev HA November 2014 4.8 HART 4.8.1 Power requirements The Rosemount 5400 Series transmitter operates with a power supply ranging from 16 - 42.4 Vdc (16 - 30 Vdc in IS applications, 20 - 42.4 Vdc in explosion-proof / flameproof applications and in non-sparking / energy-limited applications). All configuration tools for HART communication, such as the Field Communicator and Rosemount Radar Master, require a minimum load resistance (RL) of 250 : within the loop in order to function properly. Terminals in the transmitter housing provide connections for signal wiring. The Rosemount 5400 Series operates with the following power supplies: Table 4-1. Minimum Input Voltage (UI) at Different Currents Current Hazardous approval 3.75 mA 21.75 mA Minimum input voltage (UI) Non-Hazardous Installations and Intrinsically Safe Installations Explosion-proof / Flameproof Installations 4.8.2 16 Vdc 11 Vdc 20 Vdc 15.5 Vdc Load limitations Maximum load resistance (R) is determined by the voltage level of the external power supply (UE), as described by: Figure 4-4. Non-Hazardous Installations, and Non-Sparking / Energy-Limited Power Supply Maximum Load Resistance R(W) 1400 1387 1200 1000 800 600 Operating region 586 400 200 24 10 Electrical Installation 16 20 42.4 30 40 50 External Power Supply Voltage UE(V) 49 Reference Manual Section 4: Electrical Installation 00809-0100-4026, Rev HA November 2014 Figure 4-5. Intrinsically Safe Installations Maximum Load Resistance R(W) Operating region External Power Supply Voltage UE(V) Figure 4-6. Explosion-Proof / Flameproof Installations Maximum Load Resistance R(W) 1400 1200 1148 1000 800 600 400 Operating region 348 200 24 10 20 42.4 30 40 50 External Power Supply Voltage UE(V) Note For flameproof/explosion-proof installations, the diagram is only valid if the HART load resistance is at the + side and if the - side is grounded. Otherwise, the load resistance value is limited to 435 :. Note Rosemount 5400 Series Transmitters with flameproof/explosion-proof output have a built-in barrier; no external barrier needed. 50 Electrical Installation Reference Manual Section 4: Electrical Installation 00809-0100-4026, Rev HA 4.8.3 November 2014 Non-intrinsically safe power supply With a non-intrinsically safe power supply in non-hazardous installations or explosion-proof/flameproof installations, wire the transmitter as shown in Figure 4-7. Note Make sure the power supply is off when connecting the transmitter. Figure 4-7. Wiring for Non-Intrinsically Safe Power Supply (HART) Rosemount 5400 Series Radar Level Transmitter Power Supply Load Resistance 250 W HART modem PC Field Communicator The Field Communicator and the HART modem require a minimum load resistance of 250 : within the loop to function properly. Note The diagram is valid only if the HART load resistance is at the + side and if the - side is grounded, otherwise the load resistance value is limited to 435 :. Note For explosion-proof/flameproof installations make sure the transmitter is grounded to the I.S. ground terminal inside the terminal compartment in accordance with national and local electrical codes. Electrical Installation 51 Reference Manual Section 4: Electrical Installation 00809-0100-4026, Rev HA November 2014 4.8.4 Intrinsically safe power supply With an intrinsically safe power supply, wire the transmitter as shown in Figure 4-8. Note Make sure the instruments in the loop are installed according to intrinsically safe field wiring practices. Installation also needs to comply with the applicable installation/control drawing. See “Approval drawings” on page 230. Figure 4-8. Wiring Diagram for Intrinsically Safe Power Supply (HART) Rosemount 5400 Series radar level transmitter Approved IS barrier Power supply RL=250 W HART modem PC Field communicator For IS parameters, see Appendix B: Product Certifications. The Field Communicator and the HART modem require a minimum load resistance within the loop of 250 : to function properly. For maximum load resistance see Figure 4-5. For Safety Instrumented Systems information, see Section 8: Safety Instrumented Systems (4-20 mA Only). 52 Electrical Installation Reference Manual Section 4: Electrical Installation 00809-0100-4026, Rev HA 4.8.5 November 2014 Type N approvals: non-sparking / energy-limited power supply With a non-sparking / energy- limited power supply, wire the transmitter as shown in Figure 4-9. Figure 4-9. Wiring Diagram for Non-Sparking / Energy-Limited Power Supply (HART) Rosemount 5400 Series Radar Level Transmitter Power Supply Load Resistance 250 W HART modem PC Field Communicator HART: Un=42.4 V Electrical Installation 53 Reference Manual Section 4: Electrical Installation 00809-0100-4026, Rev HA November 2014 4.8.6 Transient protection terminal block For a terminal block with transient protection, wire the transmitter as shown in Figure 4-10. Figure 4-10. Wiring Diagram for Transient Protection Terminal Block (HART) Rosemount 5400 Series Radar Level Transmitter Power Supply Load Resistance 250 W HART modem PC Field Communicator 54 Electrical Installation Reference Manual Section 4: Electrical Installation 00809-0100-4026, Rev HA November 2014 4.9 FOUNDATION fieldbus 4.9.1 Power requirements Terminals in the transmitter housing provide connections for signal wiring. The Rosemount 5400 transmitter is powered over FOUNDATION fieldbus with standard fieldbus power supplies. The transmitter operates with the following power supplies: Approval type Power supply (Vdc) IS Explosion-proof/flameproof None 9 - 30 16 - 32 9 - 32 The Rosemount 5400 Series with FOUNDATION fieldbus operates using a power supply ranging from 9-32 Vdc (9-30 Vdc in IS applications, 16-32 Vdc in explosion-proof / flameproof applications, and 9-17.5 Vdc in FISCO, IS applications). Grounding Signal wiring of the fieldbus segment cannot be grounded. Grounding out one of the signal wires will shut down the entire fieldbus segment. Shield wire ground To protect the fieldbus segment from noise, grounding techniques for shield wire usually require a single grounding point for shield wire to avoid creating a ground loop. The ground point is typically at the power supply. Electrical Installation 55 Reference Manual Section 4: Electrical Installation 00809-0100-4026, Rev HA November 2014 Connecting fieldbus devices Figure 4-11. Rosemount 5400 Series Radar Transmitter Field Wiring 6200 ft (1900 m) max (depending upon cable characteristics) Integrated power conditioner and filter Terminators fieldbus segment (Spur) (Spur) (Trunk) Power supply (The power supply, filter, first terminator, and configuration tool are typically located in the control room.) Signal wiring FOUNDATION fieldbus configuration tool Intrinsically safe installations may allow fewer devices per IS barrier due to current limitations. fieldbus devices on segment Configuration with RRM (in a fieldbus system hooked up on a fieldbus segment). 56 Electrical Installation Reference Manual Section 4: Electrical Installation 00809-0100-4026, Rev HA 4.9.2 November 2014 Non-intrinsically safe power supply With non-intrinsically safe power supply in Non-hazardous installations or Explosion-proof/Flameproof installations, wire the transmitter as shown in Figure 4-12. Rosemount 5400 Series Transmitters with Explosion-proof/Flameproof Output have a built-in barrier; no external barrier needed. Note Make sure that the power supply is off when connecting the transmitter. Figure 4-12. Wiring for Non-Intrinsically Safe Power Supply (FOUNDATION fieldbus) Rosemount 5400 Series radar transmitter Power supply Fieldbus modem Field communicator PC Note For explosion-proof/flameproof installations make sure that the transmitter is grounded to the IS ground terminal inside the terminal compartment in accordance with national and local electrical codes. Electrical Installation 57 Reference Manual Section 4: Electrical Installation 00809-0100-4026, Rev HA November 2014 4.9.3 Intrinsically safe power supply When your power supply is intrinsically safe, wire the transmitter as shown in Figure 4-13. Note Make sure that the instruments in the loop are installed in accordance with intrinsically safe field wiring practices. Installation also needs to comply with the applicable installation/control drawing. See “Approval drawings” on page 230. Figure 4-13. Wiring Diagram for Intrinsically Safe Power Supply (FOUNDATION fieldbus) Rosemount 5400 Series Radar Transmitter Power supply Approved IS Barrier Fieldbus modem PC Field Communicator For IS Parameters, see Appendix B: Product Certifications. 58 Electrical Installation Reference Manual Section 4: Electrical Installation 00809-0100-4026, Rev HA 4.9.4 November 2014 Type N approvals: non-sparking / energy-limited power supply With a non-sparking / energy-limited power supply, wire the transmitter as shown in Figure 4-14. Figure 4-14. Wiring Diagram for Non-Sparking / Energy-Limited Power Supply (FOUNDATION fieldbus) Rosemount 5400 Series radar level transmitter Power supply Field communicator Fieldbus modem PC FOUNDATION fieldbus: Un = 32 V Electrical Installation 59 Section 4: Electrical Installation 4.10 Reference Manual 00809-0100-4026, Rev HA November 2014 HART to Modbus Converter (HMC) The Rosemount 5400 Series RS-485 with Modbus communication transmitter version operates using a power supply ranging from 8-30 Vdc (max. rating). See the Rosemount 5300/5400 Series with HART to Modbus Converter Manual Supplement (Document No. 00809-0500-4530) for details. Power consumption: < 0.5 W (with HART address = 1) < 1.2 W (incl. four HART slaves) 4.10.1 Connecting the transmitter 1. Disconnect/shut off the electrical power to transmitter head and then open the instrument cover. Do not remove the cover in an explosive atmosphere with a live circuit. 2. Pull the cable through the cable gland/conduit. For the RS-485 bus, use shielded twisted pair wiring, preferably with an impedance of 120 : (typically 24 AWG) in order to comply with the EIA-485 standard and EMC regulations. The maximum cable length is 4000 ft (1200 m). 3. Make sure that the transmitter housing is grounded, then connect wires according to Figure 4-15 and Table 4-2. Connect the lead that originates from the “A” line from the RS-485 bus to the terminal marked MB, and the lead that originates from the “B” line to the terminal marked MA. 4. If it is the last transmitter on the bus, connect the 120 : termination resistor. 5. Connect the leads from the positive side of the power supply to the terminal marked POWER +, and the leads from the negative side of the power supply to the terminal marked POWER -. The power supply cables must be suitable for the supply voltage and ambient temperature, and approved for use in hazardous areas, where applicable. 6. Attach and tighten the housing cover. Tighten the cable gland, then plug and seal any unused terminals, and connect the power supply. Note Rosemount 5400 Series transmitters with flameproof/explosion-proof output have a built-in barrier; no external barrier needed. 60 Electrical Installation Reference Manual Section 4: Electrical Installation 00809-0100-4026, Rev HA November 2014 Figure 4-15. Field Wiring Connections 120W If it is the last transmitter on the bus, connect the 120 W termination resistor verter HART to Modbus Converter MB MB MODBUS MA (RS-485) HART - HART + MODBUS (RS-485) POWER MA Ambients > 60 ºC HART Use wiring rated for min 90 ºC Power supply 120W 120W RS-485 Bus Electrical Installation 61 Reference Manual Section 4: Electrical Installation 00809-0100-4026, Rev HA November 2014 4.10.2 Connection terminals The connection terminals are described in Table 4-2 below: Table 4-2. Connection Terminals Connector label Description Comment HART + Positive HART connector HART - Negative HART connector Connect to PC with RRM software, Field Communicator, or other HART configurators. MA Modbus RS-485 B connection (RX/TX+)(1) Modbus RS-485 A connection (RX/TX-)(1) Positive Power input terminal Negative Power input terminal MB POWER + POWER - Connect to Remote Terminal Unit (RTU) Apply +8 Vdc to +30 Vdc (max. rating) (1) The designation of the connectors does not follow the EIA-485 standard, which states that RX/TX- should be referred to as 'A' and RX/TX+ as 'B'. Figure 4-16. Connection Terminals for Rosemount 5400 with HART to Modbus Converter HART to Modbus Converter MB MODBUS MA (RS-485) HART - POWER HART Ambients > 60 ºC HART + 62 Use wiring rated for min 90 ºC Electrical Installation Reference Manual Section 4: Electrical Installation 00809-0100-4026, Rev HA 4.10.3 4.10.4 November 2014 RS-485 bus The Rosemount 5400 transmitter does not provide electrical isolation between the RS-485 bus and the transmitter power supply Maintain a bus topology and minimize stub length Figure 4-17 identifies multidrop wiring topology, where up to 32 devices may be wired on one RS-485 bus The RS-485 bus needs to be terminated once at each end, but should not be terminated elsewhere on the bus Installation cases Install the Rosemount 5400 Series Transmitter as shown in Figure 4-17. Use common ground for Modbus Master and Power Supply The Power cables and RS-485 Bus are in the same cable installation A ground cable is installed and shall be used (cable size > 4 mm according to IEC60079-14, or size according to applicable national regulations and standards). A properly installed threaded conduit connection may provide sufficient ground. The cable shielding is grounded at master site (optional) Note The HMC equipped transmitter contains intrinsically safe circuits that require the housing to be grounded in accordance with national and local electrical codes. Failure to do so may impair the protection provided by the equipment. Figure 4-17. Multidrop Connection of Rosemount 5400 Series Transmitters 120 W 120 W RS-485 bus Modbus master Power supply HART to Modbus Converter HART to Modbus Converter MB MODBUS MB MA (RS-485) MODBUS POWER HART Ambients > 60 ºC Electrical Installation POWER HART Ambients > 60 ºC Use wiring rated for min 90 ºC Internal ground screw MA (RS-485) External ground screw Use wiring rated for min 90 ºC Internal ground screw External ground screw 63 Reference Manual Section 4: Electrical Installation 00809-0100-4026, Rev HA November 2014 Alternatively, the Rosemount 5400 Series Transmitter can be installed as shown in Figure 4-18. If this wiring layout is used, there is an increased risk for communication disturbances due to differences in potential between grounding points. By using the same grounding point for Modbus Master and Power Supply, this risk is reduced. Figure 4-18. Alternative Multidrop Connection of Rosemount 5400 Series Transmitters 120 W 120 : RS-485 bus Modbus master HART to Modbus Converter HART to Modbus Converter MB MODBUS MB MA (RS-485) MODBUS POWER HART Ambients > 60 ºC MA (RS-485) POWER HART Ambients > 60 ºC Use wiring rated for min 90 ºC Internal ground screw Use wiring rated for min 90 ºC Internal ground screw External ground screw External ground screw Power supply Star topology For a star topology connection of the Rosemount 5400 Series transmitters, the transmitter with the longest cable run needs to be fitted with a 120 : termination resistor. Figure 4-19. Star Topology Connection of Rosemount 5400 Series Transmitters verter MB HART to Modbus Converter MB MODBUS MA (RS-485) MODBUS POWER Ambients > 60 ºC (RS-485) HART Use wiring rated for min 90 ºC HART to Modbus Converter MB HART to Modbus Converter MODBUS MB MODBUS (RS-485) POWER Use wiring rated for min 90 ºC POWER HART HART Ambients > 60 ºC MA (RS-485) MA Ambients > 60 ºC Use wiring rated for min 90 ºC MA For a star topology connection, connect the 120 : termination resistor to the transmitter with the longest cable run. HART to Modbus Converter MB MODBUS MA (RS-485) POWER Ambients > 60 ºC HART Use wiring rated for min 90 ºC HART to Modbus Converter MB MODBUS MA (RS-485) POWER HART Ambients > 60 ºC 64 Use wiring rated for min 90 ºC Electrical Installation Reference Manual Section 4: Electrical Installation 00809-0100-4026, Rev HA 4.10.5 November 2014 External HART devices (slaves) The HMC supports up to four external HART devices. The external devices are separated by using the HART address. The address must be different between the external devices and only addresses 1 to 5 are allowed for multiple slaves. Connect the devices one at a time and change the short address prior to connecting the next device by using a HART Configuration Tool such as RRM, or a Field Communicator. Note The power supply from the HMC to external HART devices is not intrinsically safe. In a hazardous environment, any external HART device connected to the HMC must have Flameproof/Explosion-proof certification. The HMC cyclically polls the HART devices for measurement values. The update rate depends on the number of connected devices and is shown in Table 4-3. Table 4-3. Approximate Update Rates for Measurement Values No. of devices (slaves) Approx. update rate 2 seconds 3 seconds 4 seconds 5 seconds 5 seconds Figure 4-20. The HMC Module Supports up to Four External Devices (slaves) RS-485 bus Power supply HART to Modbus Converter MB MODBUS MA (RS-485) POWER HART Ambients > 60 ºC Up to four external devices Electrical Installation External HART device 2 Use wiring rated for min 90 ºC External HART device 1 65 Reference Manual Section 4: Electrical Installation 00809-0100-4026, Rev HA November 2014 4.11 Establish HART communication The Rosemount 5400 Series can be configured using the RRM PC software or a Field Communicator. Configuration is done by sending HART commands through the HMC to the Rosemount 5400 transmitter electronics. To establish HART communication, connect to the MA/MB terminals, or to the HART terminals. Both alternatives are described below. 4.11.1 Connect to the MA/MB terminals The Rosemount 5400 level transmitter can be configured with RRM using the MA, MB terminals. An RS-485 Converter is required to connect to the transmitter. The transmitter will try to establish communication using different protocols during 20 second timeslots from time of startup. Figure 4-21. RS-485 Communication after Startup Modbus RTU HART 20 seconds 20 seconds 0s 20 s Configured protocol (Modbus RTU, HART Levelmaster, 20 seconds or Modbus ASCII) 20 seconds 40 s 60 s Configured protocol (Modbus RTU, Levelmaster, or Modbus ASCII) 20 seconds 80 s Time 100 s The transmitter will continue to use a communication protocol once communication has been established. To configure the Rosemount 5400 level transmitter using RRM and the MA, MB terminals, do the following: 66 1. Connect the RS-485 Converter to the MA, MB connectors. 2. Start RRM and open Communication Preferences. Electrical Installation Reference Manual Section 4: Electrical Installation 00809-0100-4026, Rev HA November 2014 3. Enable HART communication and make sure the port for the RS-485 Converter is selected. Use the following settings: 4. Connect the power wires (or cycle power) to the transmitter. 5. Wait 20 seconds and then open the Search Device window in RRM (also see Note on page 68). Make sure HART address 1 is being scanned. 6. Connect to the transmitter and perform the necessary configuration. 7. After completing the configuration, disconnect the RS-485 Converter, connect the Modbus communication wires and cycle power to the transmitter 8. Verify that communication between the transmitter and the RTU is established (can take up to 60 seconds from startup). Electrical Installation 67 Section 4: Electrical Installation Reference Manual 00809-0100-4026, Rev HA November 2014 Note Take the following into consideration if there are multiple Rosemount 5400 Modbus units on the bus: By default, the transmitters have HART address 1. It will not be possible to establish communication on HART address 1 if several transmitters have the same address. In this case, there are alternative solutions to establish communication: 4.11.2 1. Select the Scan by Tag option in the Search Device window in RRM and enter the HART Device Tag of the transmitter. Communication can now be established with an individual transmitter even if several devices have the same HART address. 2. Make sure the Rosemount 5400 transmitter is alone on bus. Disconnect or turn off power from any other dcevies. Connect to the HART terminals To configure the Rosemount 5400 transmitter, connect the communicator or PC to the HART terminals using a HART modem, see Figure 4-16 on page 62. Both the configuration tool and the RS-485 bus can be connected simultaneously. Configuration data is sent with HART commands through the HMC to the Rosemount 5400 transmitter electronics. Note that the power supply must be connected during configuration, see also “Connecting the transmitter” on page 47. Note Measurement data is not updated to the Modbus Master when a configuration tool is connected. 68 Electrical Installation Reference Manual Section 4: Electrical Installation 00809-0100-4026, Rev HA November 2014 4.12 Optional devices 4.12.1 Tri-Loop™ HART to analog converter The Rosemount 5400 Series transmitter outputs a HART signal with four process variables. The Model 333 HART Tri-Loop provides up to three additional analog 4-20 mA outputs. Figure 4-22. Wiring Diagram for HART Tri-Loop DIN rail mounted HART Tri-Loop Ch. 3 Ch. 2 Ch. 1 Burst input to Tri-Loop RL !250: Each Tri-Loop channel receives power from control room Channel 1 must be powered for the Tri-Loop to operate Device receives power from control room HART Burst command 3/ analog output IS barrier Control room Configure Channels 1, 2, and 3 to reflect the units in addition to Upper Range Values and Lower Range Values for secondary, tertiary, and fourth variables (variable assignment is configured in the Rosemount 5400 Series). It is also possible to enable or disable a channel from this menu. Electrical Installation 69 Reference Manual Section 4: Electrical Installation 00809-0100-4026, Rev HA November 2014 4.12.2 751 Field Signal Indicator Figure 4-23. Wiring Diagram for a Rosemount 5400 Series Transmitter with a 751 Field Signal Indicator 751 Field Signal Indicator Rosemount 5400 Series radar transmitter Power supply 70 Electrical Installation Reference Manual Section 4: Electrical Installation 00809-0100-4026, Rev HA 4.12.3 November 2014 Smart Wireless THUM™ Adapter The Rosemount 5400 Series can be combined with the Smart Wireless THUM Adapter. For more information, see the Smart Wireless THUM™ Adapter for Rosemount Process Level Transmitter Applications Technical Note (Document No. 00840-0100-4026) and the Smart Wireless THUM™ Adapter Reference Manual (Document No. 00809-0100-4075). Figure 4-24. Wiring Diagram for a Rosemount 5400 Series with the Smart Wireless THUM Adapter Rosemount Field Communicator RRM/Rosemount Configuration Tool 4-20 mA/HART Rosemount 5400 Series radar transmitter with THUM Adapter DCS/host system Smart wireless gateway Electrical Installation AMS® configurator 71 Section 4: Electrical Installation November 2014 72 Reference Manual 00809-0100-4026, Rev HA Electrical Installation Reference Manual Section 5: Basic Configuration/Start-up 00809-0100-4026, Rev HA November 2014 Section 5 Basic Configuration/Start-up Safety messages . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Overview . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Basic configuration parameters . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Basic configuration using RRM . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Configuration using a Field Communicator . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Basic configuration using AMS Suite . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Configuration using DeltaV . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . FOUNDATION fieldbus overview . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Application examples . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Tri-Loop™ HART to Analog Converter . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . HART multidrop configuration . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5.1 page 73 page 74 page 75 page 84 page 101 page 105 page 106 page 112 page 115 page 117 page 118 Safety messages Procedures and instructions in this section may require special precautions to ensure the safety of the personnel performing the operations. Information that raises potential safety issues is indicated by a warning symbol ( ). Refer to the safety messages listed at the beginning of each section before performing an operation preceded by this symbol. Explosions could result in death or serious injury. Verify that the operating environment of the gauge is consistent with the appropriate hazardous locations certifications. Before connecting a HART®-based communicator in an explosive atmosphere, make sure the instruments in the loop are installed in accordance with intrinsically safe or non-incendive field wiring practices. Do not remove the gauge cover in explosive atmospheres when the circuit is alive. All connection head covers must be fully engaged to meet explosion-proof requirements. Failure to follow safe installation and servicing guidelines could result in death or serious injury. Make sure only qualified personnel perform the installation. Use the equipment only as specified in this manual. Failure to do so may impair the protection provided by the equipment. Do not perform any service other than those contained in this manual unless you are qualified. Basic Configuration/Start-up 73 Section 5: Basic Configuration/Start-up 5.2 Reference Manual 00809-0100-4026, Rev HA November 2014 Overview The configuration of a Rosemount 5400 Series transmitter is normally a simple and straightforward task. If the transmitter is pre-configured at the factory according to ordering specifications in the Configuration Data Sheet, no further basic configuration is required, unless tank conditions have changed. The Rosemount 5400 Series supports a set of advanced configuration options that can be used to handle special tank conditions and applications. For further information on advanced configuration options, see Appendix C: Advanced Configuration. 5.2.1 Basic configuration parameters The basic configuration includes parameters for a standard configuration which is sufficient in most cases. The basic configuration comprises the following items: 5.2.2 Measurement Units Tank Configuration - Tank Geometry - Environment - Volume Analog Output Echo Tuning: see page 83 for more information on the Amplitude Threshold Curve (ATC), and “Echo tuning” on page 83 for more information on False Echo Registration Configuration tools There are several tools available for basic configuration of a Rosemount 5400 Series transmitter: RRM. Note that RRM is required for advanced configuration features. See “Basic configuration using RRM” on page 84 for information on using RRM to configure the Rosemount 5400 Series. Rosemount Field Communicator. See “Configuration using a Field Communicator” on page 101 for the Field Communicator Menu Tree. DTM (compliant with version 1.2 of the FDT®/DTM™ specification) is also available supporting configuration in, for instance, Yokogawa Fieldmate/PRM, E+HTM FieldCare, and PACTwareTM AMS® Suite software (for HART). See “Basic configuration using AMS Suite” on page 105 for information on configuring AMS Suite. DeltaVTM (only for FOUNDATION™ fieldbus). See “Configuration using DeltaV” on page 106 for information on configuring the Rosemount 5400 Series transmitter using DeltaV. Other tools that support EDDL functionality. RRM is a user-friendly, Windows™ based software package that includes waveform plots, offline/online configuration Wizard, logging, and extensive online help. 74 Basic Configuration/Start-up Reference Manual Section 5: Basic Configuration/Start-up 00809-0100-4026, Rev HA November 2014 To communicate with the transmitter using RRM, a HART modem (part number 03300-7004-0001 or 03300-7004-0002) or a FOUNDATION fieldbus modem (part number 03095-5108-0001 for PCMCIA) is required. For FOUNDATION fieldbus communication you will also need the National Instruments Communication Manager software (see “Installing the RRM software for FOUNDATION fieldbus” on page 88). 5.3 Basic configuration parameters This chapter describes the basic parameters that need to be configured for a Rosemount 5400 transmitter. If the transmitter is factory-configured according to the ordering specifications in the Configuration Data Sheet, no further basic configuration is needed unless conditions have changed since the ordering date. Different configuration tools are described at the end of this section. 5.3.1 Measurement units Measurement units can be specified for presentation of Level, Level Rate, Volume and Temperature values. 5.3.2 Tank geometry Tank height The Tank Height is the distance between the Upper Reference Point, at the underside of the transmitter flange or the threaded adapter, and the Lower Reference Point, close to or at the bottom of the tank (see Figure 5-2 for further information on Upper Reference Points for various tank connections). The transmitter measures the distance to the product surface and subtracts this value from the Tank Height to determine the product level. Figure 5-1. Tank Geometry Upper reference point Transition zone Tank height (R) Product level Lower reference point (Level = 0) Basic Configuration/Start-up 75 Reference Manual Section 5: Basic Configuration/Start-up 00809-0100-4026, Rev HA November 2014 Figure 5-2. Upper Reference Point Rod antenna with threaded tank connection Rod antenna with flange Cone antenna Process seal antenna Flange Adapter Upper reference point Tank type and tank bottom type The Rosemount 5400 Series transmitter is optimized according to the Tank Type and Tank Bottom Type configuration by automatically setting some parameters to predefined default values. Select Tank Bottom Type Flat Inclined if the bottom inclination is between 10 and 30 degrees. If the inclination is less than 10 degrees, but there are disturbing objects on the tank floor (like heating coils) within the radar beam, this selection should also be used. If the inclination is greater than 30 degrees, use the Cone Tank Bottom Type. Table 5-1. Tank Type and Tank Bottom Type Tank type Tank bottom type Vertical cylinder Horizontal cylinder Spherical Cubical Flat, dome, cone, flat inclined/obstructed Not used Not used Flat, dome, cone, flat inclined/obstructed Figure 5-3. Transmitter Optimization for Different Tank Types and Bottom Shapes Flat 76 Dome Flat inclined Cone Spherical Basic Configuration/Start-up Reference Manual 00809-0100-4026, Rev HA Section 5: Basic Configuration/Start-up November 2014 Pipe diameter When the transmitter is mounted in a still-pipe, the inner diameter of the pipe must be specified. The pipe diameter is used to compensate for the lower microwave propagation speed inside the pipe. An incorrect value gives a scale factor error. If locally supplied still-pipes are used, make sure the inner diameter is noted before the pipe is installed. Transition zone The measurement accuracy is reduced within the transition zone region 6 in. (150 mm) from the lower end of the antenna. It is recommended that the Upper Range Value (20 mA) be set outside the transition zone. 5.3.3 Process conditions Describe the conditions of the tank according to the tank environment parameters for process conditions listed below. For best performance, choose only if applicable, and no more than two options. Rapid level changes Optimize the transmitter for measurement conditions where the level changes quickly from the filling and emptying of the tank. As a default standard, a Rosemount 5400 Series transmitter is able to track level changes of up to 1.5 in./s (40 mm/s). When the Rapid Level Changes check-box is selected, the transmitter can track level changes of up to 8 in./s (200 mm/s). Turbulent surface This parameter should be used if the tank has a turbulent surface. The reason for the turbulence might be splash loading, agitators, mixers, or boiling product. Normally, the waves in a tank are quite small and cause local rapid level changes. By setting this parameter, the performance of the transmitter will improve when there are small and quickly changing amplitudes and levels. Foam Setting this parameter optimizes the gauge for conditions with weak and varying surface echo amplitudes, such as foam. When the foam is light and airy, the actual product level is measured. For heavy and dense foam, the transmitter measures the level of the foam’s upper surface. Product dielectric range The Dielectric Constant is related to the reflectivity of the product. By setting this parameter, measurement performance can be optimized. However, the transmitter will still be able to perform properly, even if the actual Dielectric Constant differs from the configured value. Solid product Setting this parameter optimizes the device for solid products, for example concrete or grains. For instance, this parameter can be used when the application is a silo with product pile-up. The transmitter will be optimized for weak echoes and a sloping surface which is typical when measuring at solid materials. This option shall only be used for a Rosemount 5402 with a 4” cone antenna. Basic Configuration/Start-up 77 Reference Manual Section 5: Basic Configuration/Start-up 00809-0100-4026, Rev HA November 2014 5.3.4 Volume configuration For volume calculations, choose one of the standard tank shapes or the strapping option. Select None if volume calculation is not used. For the standard tanks, a Volume Offset parameter can be specified which can be used for a non-zero volume that corresponds to the zero level. This may be useful, for example, if the user wants to include the product volume below the zero level. Volume calculation is performed by using a predefined tank shape or a strapping table. One of the following standard tank shapes can be chosen: Sphere Vertical cylinder Horizontal cylinder Vertical bullet Horizontal bullet The following parameters must be entered for a standard tank shape: 78 Tank diameter Tank height (not for spherical tanks) Volume offset Basic Configuration/Start-up Reference Manual Section 5: Basic Configuration/Start-up 00809-0100-4026, Rev HA November 2014 Standard tank shapes Figure 5-4. Standard Tank Shapes Vertical cylinder Diameter Height Vertical cylinder tanks are specified by diameter, height, and volume offset. Horizontal cylinder Diameter Horizontal cylinder tanks are specified by diameter, height, and volume offset. Height Vertical bullet Diameter Height Vertical bullet tanks are specified by diameter, height, and volume offset. The volume calculation model for this tank shape estimates that the radius of the bullet end is equal to the diameter/2. Horizontal bullet Diameter Height Horizontal bullet tanks are specified by diameter, height, and volume offset. The volume calculation model for this tank shape estimates that the radius of the bullet end is equal to the diameter/2. Sphere Diameter Spherical tanks are specified by diameter and volume offset. Basic Configuration/Start-up 79 Section 5: Basic Configuration/Start-up Reference Manual 00809-0100-4026, Rev HA November 2014 Strapping table The Strapping Table option is used when the tank shape deviates significantly from an ideal sphere or cylinder, or when high volume accuracy is required. The Strapping Table divides the tank into segments. Level values and corresponding volumes are entered at the bottom of the tank. These figures can typically be obtained from tank drawings or from a certificate provided by the tank manufacturer. A maximum of 20 strapping points can be entered. For each level value the corresponding total volume up to the specified level is entered. The volume value is interpolated if the product surface is between two level values in the table. Figure 5-5. Strapping Points Actual tank bottom may look like this. Using only 3 strapping points results in a level-to-volume profile that is more angular than the actual shape. Using 10-15 of the points at the bottom of the tank yields a level-to-volume profile that is similar to the actual tank bottom. 80 Basic Configuration/Start-up Reference Manual Section 5: Basic Configuration/Start-up 00809-0100-4026, Rev HA 5.3.5 November 2014 Analog output (HART) For the analog output, the output source (primary value), range values, and alarm mode are specified. Figure 5-6. Standard Range Value Settings Upper reference point Transition zone Product level Range 0-100 % 20 mA Upper Range Value (URV) 4 mA Lower Range Value (LRV) Lower reference point (Level=0) Output source/primary variable Specify the source to control the analog output. Typically, the Primary Value is configured to be the Product Level. Upper/lower range value Enter the range values that correspond to the analog output values 4 and 20 mA. The 20 mA point should be set below the Transition Zone, since the measurement accuracy is reduced in this region. For information on the Transition Zone, see “Performance specifications” on page 189. If a measured value goes beyond the measurement range, the transmitter enters saturation mode (if limit alarm is disabled) or alarm mode, depending on the current configuration. Alarm mode Choose the desired Alarm mode to specify the analog output state when there is a failure or a measurement error. High: the output current is set to the High Alarm Limit. Low: the output current is set to the Low Alarm Limit. Basic Configuration/Start-up 81 Reference Manual Section 5: Basic Configuration/Start-up 00809-0100-4026, Rev HA November 2014 Freeze Current: the output current is set to the last valid value at the time when the error occurs. Default settings for alarm mode: Measurement errors: Output current = High Measured value out of range: transmitter enters saturation mode (if Limit Alarm is disabled) Table 5-2. Analog Output: Standard Alarm Value vs. Saturation Value Level 4–20 mA saturation value 4–20 mA alarm value Low 3.9 mA 3.75 mA High 20.8 mA 21.75 mA In saturation mode, if the primary variable is not in low alarm mode, the minimum output is 3.9 mA. If the primary variable is not in high alarm mode, the maximum output is 20.8 mA. Table 5-3. Analog Output: NAMUR-compliant Alarm Value vs. Saturation Value 5.3.6 Level 4–20 mA saturation value 4–20 mA alarm value High 20.5 mA 22.5 mA Level and distance calibration Level and distance calibration may be necessary when using a nozzle or pipe or if there are disturbances in the near zone caused by a physical object. Non-metallic (e.g. plastic) vessels and installation geometry may introduce an offset for the zero reference point. This offset may be up to ± 25 mm. The offset can be compensated for using Distance Calibration. When calibrating the transmitter, it is important that the product surface is calm and that the tank is not being filled or emptied. A complete calibration is performed in two steps: 82 1. Calibrate the distance measurement by adjusting the Calibration Offset parameter. 2. Calibrate the level measurement by adjusting the Tank Height. Basic Configuration/Start-up Reference Manual Section 5: Basic Configuration/Start-up 00809-0100-4026, Rev HA November 2014 Distance calibration 1. Measure the actual distance between the Upper Reference Point and the product surface. 2. Adjust the Calibration Distance so that the Distance measured by the transmitter corresponds to the actual distance. The Calibration Distance parameter is available via HART command [2, 3, 2, 4, 1], or RRM: a. Select the Tank icon under Device Config/Setup in the RRM workspace. b. In the Tank window, select the Geometry tab. c. Select the Advanced button. d. Enter the desired value in the Calibration Distance field and select the Store button. Level calibration 1. Measure the actual Product Level. 2. Adjust the Tank Height so the product level measured by the transmitter corresponds to the actual product level. Figure 5-7. Distance and Level Calibration Reference point Reference point Distance Tank height Level 5.3.7 Echo tuning When Basic Configuration is performed, the transmitter may need to be tuned to handle disturbing objects in the tank. There are different methods available for handling disturbance echoes with the Rosemount 5400 Series Transmitter: ATC False echo registration, see “Registration of false echoes” on page 135 The Guided Setup in the RRM configuration program includes a Measure and Learn function which automatically registers false echoes and creates an ATC (see “Guided setup” on page 92). The created ATC is based on the present tank spectra and process condition settings. Disturbances below the product surface might not be handled by the Measure and Learn function. Basic Configuration/Start-up 83 Reference Manual Section 5: Basic Configuration/Start-up 00809-0100-4026, Rev HA November 2014 5.3.8 ATC Setting up an ATC makes tracking of the product surface more robust in the presence of noise and weak disturbing echoes. The ATC is normally used for filtering out disturbances with an amplitude smaller than the amplitude of the product surface echo. The ATC is designed as a number of individually adjustable amplitude threshold points. Amplitude, mV Figure 5-8. Weak Disturbing Echoes can be Filtered Out by Creating an Amplitude Threshold Measurement signal ATC Distance, m To create an ATC, the Measure and Learn function is available in the RRM program. 5.4 Basic configuration using RRM The RRM is a user-friendly software tool that allows configuration of the Rosemount 5400 transmitter. Choose either of the following methods to configure a Rosemount 5400 transmitter with RRM: 5.4.1 Guided Setup, if you are unfamiliar with the Rosemount 5400 Series transmitter (see page 92) Setup functions, if you are already familiar with the configuration process, or for changes to the current settings (see page 100) System requirements Hardware COM Port: 1 serial COM port or 1 USB port Graphical Card (minimum/recommended): screen resolution 800 x 600/1024 x 768. Hard drive space: 100 MB 84 Basic Configuration/Start-up Reference Manual Section 5: Basic Configuration/Start-up 00809-0100-4026, Rev HA November 2014 Software Operating Systems supported: 5.4.2 Windows XP Windows 7 Help in RRM From the Help menu, select the Contents option to access help information. Help is also available from a Help button in most windows. 5.4.3 Installing the RRM software for HART communication To install the RRM: 1. Insert the installation CD into the CD-ROM drive. 2. If the installation program is not started automatically, select Run from the Windows Start bar. 3. Enter D:\RRM\Setup.exe where D is the CD-ROM drive. 4. Follow the instructions on the screen. 5. Make sure that HART is chosen as default protocol. 6. Set COM Port Buffers to 1, see page 88. Basic Configuration/Start-up 85 Reference Manual Section 5: Basic Configuration/Start-up 00809-0100-4026, Rev HA November 2014 Getting started 1. From the Start menu, select Programs > Rosemount > Rosemount Radar Master or select the RRM icon in the Windows workspace. 2. If the Search Device window did not appear automatically, select menu option Device > Search. 3. In the Search Device window, select communication protocol HART and select the Start Scan button (select the Advanced button to specify start and stop address). Now RRM searches for the transmitter. 4. The Search Device window presents a list of found transmitters. 5. Select the desired transmitter and press OK to connect. If communication does not work, check that the correct COM port is configured correctly and is connected to the computer. See “Specifying the COM port” on page 87. Verify from the Communication Preferences window that HART communication is enabled. 6. The RRM Status Bar can be used to verify that RRM is communicating with the transmitter: RRM communicates with the transmitter No communication with the transmitter 86 Basic Configuration/Start-up Reference Manual Section 5: Basic Configuration/Start-up 00809-0100-4026, Rev HA 5.4.4 November 2014 Specifying the COM port If communication is not established, open the Communication Preferences window and check that the correct COM Port is selected: 1. From the View menu, select Communication Preferences in RRM. Figure 5-9. Communication Settings 2. Make sure that HART communication is enabled. 3. Check which COM port is connected to the modem. 4. Select the COM port option matching the actual COM port on the PC that is connected to the transmitter. Basic Configuration/Start-up 87 Reference Manual Section 5: Basic Configuration/Start-up 00809-0100-4026, Rev HA November 2014 5.4.5 To set the COM port buffers The COM port Receive Buffer and Transmit Buffer need to be set to 1 by doing the following: 5.4.6 1. In the Microsoft® Windows Control Panel, open the System option. 2. Select the Hardware tab and click the Device Manager button. 3. Expand the Ports node in the tree view. 4. Click the right mouse button on the selected COM port and then select Properties. 5. Select the Port Settings tab and click the Advanced button. 6. Drag the Receive Buffer and Transmit Buffer slides to 1. 7. Click the OK button. 8. Reboot the computer. Specifying measurement units Measurement units for data presentation in RRM can be specified when the RRM program is installed. Units can also be changed as follows: 5.4.7 1. Select the Application Preferences option from the View menu. 2. Select the Measurement Units tab. 3. Select the desired units for Length, Level Rate, Volume, and Temperature. Installing the RRM software for FOUNDATION fieldbus To install the RRM for FOUNDATION fieldbus communication: 88 1. Start by installing the National Instruments Communication Manager software. See National Instruments manual (Getting started with your PCMCIA-FBUS and the NI-FBUS™ software) for more information. 2. Insert the RRM installation CD into your CD-ROM drive. 3. If the installation program is not automatically started, select Run from the Windows Start bar. 4. Type D:\RRM\Setup.exe where D is the CD-ROM drive. 5. Follow the instructions on the screen. 6. Make sure that FOUNDATION fieldbus is selected as default protocol. Basic Configuration/Start-up Reference Manual Section 5: Basic Configuration/Start-up 00809-0100-4026, Rev HA November 2014 Getting started 1. Before starting RRM make sure that appropriate settings are made with the National Instruments Interface Configuration Utility: Use the following settings: Device address = Visitor Device Type = Link Master Device Usage = NI-FBUS 2. Start RRM: from the Start menu click Programs > Rosemount > Rosemount RadarMaster or click the RRM icon in the Microsoft Windows workspace. 3. If the National Instruments Communication Manager server is not running, click Yes when RRM displays a request for starting the server. 4. If the Search Device window did not appear automatically, select menu option Device > Search. 5. In the Search Device window, select communication protocol FOUNDATION fieldbus (if not already selected) and click the Start Scan button (click the Advanced button if you want to specify start and stop dress). Now RRM searches for the transmitter. After a while, RRM shows the transmitters found on the bus: Basic Configuration/Start-up 89 Reference Manual Section 5: Basic Configuration/Start-up 00809-0100-4026, Rev HA November 2014 6. Select the desired transmitter and click OK to connect. In the RRM Status Bar, verify that RRM communicates with the transmitter: RRM communicates with the transmitter No communication with the transmitter 5.4.8 Specifying measurement units Measurement units for data presentation in RRM can be specified when the RRM program is installed. Units can also be changed as follows: 90 1. From the View menu, select the Application Preferences option. 2. Select the Measurement Units tab. 3. Select the desired units for Length, Level Rate, Volume, and Temperature. Basic Configuration/Start-up Reference Manual Section 5: Basic Configuration/Start-up 00809-0100-4026, Rev HA 5.4.9 November 2014 Using the Setup functions Use the Setup function if you are already familiar with the configuration process for the Rosemount 5400 Series transmitter or for changes to the current settings: Figure 5-10. Setup Functions in RRM 1. Start the RRM software. 2. In the RRM workspace, select the appropriate icon for the configuration of transmitter parameters: Wizard: the Wizard is a tool that guides you through the basic configuration procedure of a Rosemount 5400 Series transmitter General: configuration of general settings, such as measurement units and communication parameters. This window also lets you configure which LCD variables to be displayed. Tank: configuration of Tank Geometry, Tank Environment, and Volume Echo Curve: disturbance echo handling Advanced: advanced configuration Wizard General Tank geometry, Environment, Volume Echo Curve Advanced Basic Configuration/Start-up 91 Reference Manual Section 5: Basic Configuration/Start-up 00809-0100-4026, Rev HA November 2014 5.4.10 Guided setup The following description tells how to use the RRM Guided Setup. The corresponding HART commands (Field Communicator Fast Key Sequence) are also shown. The Guided Setup is useful for those unfamiliar with the Rosemount 5400 Series transmitter. Guided Setup and Configuration Wizard Run Wizard 1. Start the RRM program. RRM automatically presents a list of available transmitters. Select the desired transmitter. The transmitter is now connected and the Guided Setup window appears. 2. In the Guided Setup window, select the Run Wizard... button and follow the instructions through a short transmitter installation procedure. Note The Guided Setup is an extended installation guide including more than just the configuration Wizard. It can be disabled by de-selecting the Open Guided Setup dialog after Connect check-box in the Application Preferences window (menu option View > Application Preferences). Device Properties 3. The first window in the Configuration Wizard presents general information that is stored in the transmitter database, such as device model, serial number, antenna type, communication protocol, and device address. Verify that the information matches the ordering information. 92 Basic Configuration/Start-up Reference Manual Section 5: Basic Configuration/Start-up 00809-0100-4026, Rev HA November 2014 Device Information 4. The Tag, Message, Descriptor, and Date information is entered in this window. This information is not required for the operation of the transmitter and may be left out, if desired. HART command: [2, 2, 1]. Digital Units 5. Basic Configuration/Start-up The Length Unit, Level Rate Unit, Volume Unit, and Temperature Unit information is entered in this window. 93 Reference Manual Section 5: Basic Configuration/Start-up 00809-0100-4026, Rev HA November 2014 Tank Geometry 6. Select the Tank Type corresponding to the actual tank. If none of the available options matches the tank, select Unknown. HART command: [2, 1, 2, 1]. FOUNDATION fieldbus parameter: TRANSDUCER_1100 > GEOM_TANK_TYPE. Tank Bottom Type is important for the measurement performance close to the tank bottom. HART command: [2, 1, 2, 2]. FOUNDATION fieldbus parameter: TRANSDUCER_1100 > GEOM_TANK_BOTTOM_TYPE. Enable Still Pipe/Bridle Measurement Tank Height is the distance from the Upper Reference Point to the Lower Reference Point (see “Tank geometry” on page 75). This number needs to be as accurate as possible. HART command: [2, 1, 2, 3]. FOUNDATION fieldbus parameter: TRANSDUCER_1100 > GEOM_TANK_HEIGHT. Select the Enable Still-Pipe/Bridle Measurement check-box and enter the Pipe Inner Diameter if the transmitter is mounted on a Still-Pipe. HART command: [2, 1, 2, 4] / [2, 1, 2, 5]. FOUNDATION fieldbus parameter: TRANSDUCER_1100> SIGNAL_PROC_CONFIG (Enable), ANTENNA_PIPE_DIAM. For more information, see “Tank geometry” on page 75. 94 Basic Configuration/Start-up Reference Manual Section 5: Basic Configuration/Start-up 00809-0100-4026, Rev HA November 2014 Tank Environment 7. In the Process Condition box, select the check-boxes that correspond to the conditions of the tank. Select as few options as possible and no more than two. See “Process conditions” on page 77 for more information. FOUNDATION fieldbus parameter: TRANSDUCER_1100 > ENV_ENVIRONMENT. The Dielectric Chart lists the dielectric constants of a large number of products and can be opened by selecting View > Dielectric Constant Chart menu option. Select the Product Dielectric Range that corresponds to the current product. If the correct range value for this parameter is unknown, or the contents in the tank are continually changing, choose Unknown. HART command: [2, 1, 3, 2]. FOUNDATION fieldbus parameter: TRANSDUCER_1100 > ENV_DIELECTR_CONST. Volume 8. For volume calculation, select a pre-defined calculation method based on a tank shape that corresponds to the actual tank. Select None if volume calculation is not needed. The Strapping Table option is used if the actual tank does not match any of the available options for pre-defined tanks or if higher calculation accuracy is desired. HART command: [2, 1, 4, 1]. FOUNDATION fieldbus parameters: ADV_CONFIG_TB_1300 > VOL_VOLUME_CALC_METHOD/ VOL_IDEAL_DIAMETER/ VOL_IDEAL_LENGTH/ VOL_VOLUME_OFFSET. For more information, see “Volume configuration” on page 78. Basic Configuration/Start-up 95 Reference Manual Section 5: Basic Configuration/Start-up 00809-0100-4026, Rev HA November 2014 Analog output 9. Typically, the Primary Variable (PV) is configured to be Product Level or Volume. Set the analog output range by inputting the Lower Range Value (4 mA) and the Upper Range Value (20 mA) to the desired values. The Alarm Mode specifies the output state when a measurement error occurs. HART command: [2, 1, 5]. See “Analog output (HART)” on page 81 for more information on Analog Output configuration and Alarm Mode settings. Finish Configuration Wizard 10. This is the last window in the Configuration Wizard. The configuration can be changed at any time by using the Setup windows (General, Tank, Output etc., see “Using the Setup functions” on page 100), which contain further options not available in the configuration wizard. Select the Finish button and continue with the next step in the Guided Setup. Echo tuning 11. Step 2 in the Guided Setup allows automatic configuration of the ATC and registration of false echoes by running the Measure and Learn function. See “Echo tuning” on page 83 for more information on amplitude thresholds and false echoes. Click button 2 to start the Measure and Learn function. (If Echo Tuning is not needed, or is done at a later stage, go on to step 3 in the Guided Setup). 96 Basic Configuration/Start-up Reference Manual Section 5: Basic Configuration/Start-up 00809-0100-4026, Rev HA November 2014 Measure and Learn function 12. Select the Yes button to run the Measure and Learn function. If No is selected, this function can be run at a later stage using the Spectrum Analyzer in RRM. Make sure there is no filling or emptying occurring when the Measure and Learn function is used. Tank precondition settings 13. The Measure and Learn function creates an ATC automatically and suggests False Echo Areas. See “Echo tuning” on page 83. (By selecting the Advanced button, one or both of the options can be selected in the corresponding check-box). Verify the Tank Precondition settings. Verify that the Distance to Surface value is correct. If not, it may be due to a disturbing object in the tank). Select Empty Tank if the tank is empty. Spectrum plot 14. The automatically created ATC and False Echo Areas are shown in the Spectrum Plot. False Echo Areas are presented as shaded areas, and represent tank levels where RRM found interfering echoes to be blocked out. False Echo Areas can be moved or removed before storing to the transmitter database. Verify that each False Echo Area is identified as an object in the tank that gives rise to a disturbing echo. See “Echo tuning” on page 83 for more information. Select the Store button to save the ATC and the registered disturbance echoes. Basic Configuration/Start-up 97 Reference Manual Section 5: Basic Configuration/Start-up 00809-0100-4026, Rev HA November 2014 Restart the transmitter 15. Restart the transmitter to activate all of the configuration changes. It may take up to 60 seconds after the restart button is pressed before measurement values are updated. Verify Level 16. Run the Verify Level tool to match the product level reported by the device to a reference measurement (measured by using for example hand gauging). In any difference, the Calibration Distance parameter will be adjusted. A minor adjustment using Calibration Distance is normal. There may, for example be a deviation between the actual tank height and the configured value. Configuration backup 17. When configuration is complete, the configuration should be saved to a backup file. This information is useful for: 98 installing another Rosemount 5400 Series transmitter in a similar tank, since the file can be directly uploaded to a new device. restoring the configuration, if configuration data is lost or accidentally modified, making the device inoperable. Use Archive Device to create a backup file and save additional information, such as an echo curve movie, for future reference to a .zip file. Basic Configuration/Start-up Reference Manual Section 5: Basic Configuration/Start-up 00809-0100-4026, Rev HA November 2014 Guided Setup complete 18. The Guided Setup is now complete. To exit the Guided Setup, select the Close button. Basic Configuration/Start-up 99 Reference Manual Section 5: Basic Configuration/Start-up 00809-0100-4026, Rev HA November 2014 5.4.11 Using the Setup functions Use the Setup function if you are already familiar with the configuration process for the Rosemount 5400 Series transmitter or to change the current settings: Figure 5-11. Setup Functions in RRM 1. Start the RRM software. 2. In the RRM workspace, choose the appropriate icon for configuring transmitter parameters: Guided Setup: this dialog guides you through the most important steps to perform a successful configuration of the device. The guide consists of a few steps. Wizard: guides the user through the basic configuration procedure of the Rosemount 5400 transmitter General: configures general settings, such as measurement units and communication parameters, and which LCD variables to display Tank: configures tank geometry, tank environment, and volume Output: configures Analog Output Echo Curve: disturbance echo handling Advanced: advanced configuration Guided Setup Wizard General Tank geometry, Environment, Volume Analog Output Echo Curve Advanced 100 Basic Configuration/Start-up Reference Manual Section 5: Basic Configuration/Start-up 00809-0100-4026, Rev HA 5.5 November 2014 Configuration using a Field Communicator This section describes the configuration of a Rosemount 5400 Series transmitter with a Field Communicator. The menu tree with the various configuration parameters is shown in Figure 5-14 on page 103. Section “Basic configuration parameters” on page 75 describes the basic configuration parameters. See sections “Echo tuning” on page 83 and Appendix C: Advanced Configuration for information on disturbance echo handling and advanced configuration. For information on all capabilities, refer to the Field Communicator Product Manual (Document No. 00809-0100-4276). Figure 5-12. 375 Field Communicator A. Navigation keys B. Tab key C. On/Off key D. Enter key E. Function key F. Alpha numeric keypad G. Backlight adjustment key Figure 5-13. 475 Field Communicator A. Power key B. Navigation key C. Tab key D. Backlight key E. Enter key F. Function key G. Alphanumeric keypad Basic Configuration/Start-up 101 Section 5: Basic Configuration/Start-up Reference Manual 00809-0100-4026, Rev HA November 2014 To make a basic setup of the transmitter, do the following: 1. Check that the desired Measurement Units are selected. HART command: [2, 1, 1, 5]. 2. Enter configuration parameters for the following: Device info. HART command: [2, 2, 1] Geometry. HART command: [2, 1, 2] Environment. HART command: [2, 1, 3] Volume. HART command: [2, 1, 4] Analog Out. HART command: [2, 1, 5] 3. Run Measure and Learn. HART command: [2, 1, 6, 2]. This function creates an ATC. 4. Restart the transmitter. HART command: [2, 1, 6, 4]. To view the Echo Curve and adjust threshold settings, see “Using the Echo Curve Analyzer” on page 137. 102 Basic Configuration/Start-up Reference Manual Section 5: Basic Configuration/Start-up 00809-0100-4026, Rev HA November 2014 Figure 5-14. Field Communicator Menu Tree Corresponding to Device Revision 3 Process variables 1 Primary Variable 2 2nd 3 3rd 4 4th 5 All variables 6 Identification 1 Variable Mapping 2 Geometry 3 Environment 4 Volume 5 Analog Out 6 Finish 1 Primary Variable 2 2nd 3 3rd 4 4th 5 HART Digital Units 6 Damping Value 7 Device Status 1 Tank Type 2 Tank Bottom Type 3 Tank Height 4 Still-pipe/Bridle Meas 5 Drawing 1 Process Variables 2 Setup 3 Diagnostics 4 Level 5 Analog Out 6 Distance 7 Signal Strength Setup 1 Basic Setup 2 Device 3 Tank 4 Analog output 5 Echo Curve 6 Advanced 7 Calibration Diagnostics 1 Identification 2 Variable Mapping 3 LCD 4 Communication 5 Alarm/Sat. Limits 1 Geometry 2 Environment 3 Volume 4 Antenna 1 Process Condition 2 Product Dielectric Range 1 Volume Calculation Method 2 Drawing 1 Diagnostics 2 Tools 1 Analog Out 2 Alarm/Sat. Limits 1 Echo Peaks 2 Echo Curve 1 Primary Variable 2 Range Values 3 Alarm Mode 4 Sensor Limit 5 Alarm Mode Definition 2 Measure and Learn 4 Restart Device 1 Empty Tank 2 Echo Tracking 3 Double Bounce 4 Bottom Projection 5 Double Surface 6 Filter Settings 7 Full Tank 1 Found Echo Peaks 2 Measurement Output 3 Register False Echoes 4 Add False Echo 5 Remove False Echo 1 Analog Output 1 Measure and Learn 2 Set Threshold 3 Echo Curve Basic Configuration/Start-up 103 Reference Manual Section 5: Basic Configuration/Start-up 00809-0100-4026, Rev HA November 2014 Table 5-4. HART Fast Key Sequences Function Alarm mode Antenna type Device information LCD language LCD variables Length unit Lower Range Value (LRV) (4 mA) Pipe diameter Primary variable Product dielectric constant Range Values (LRV/URV) Tag Tank bottom type Tank height Tank type Temperature unit Hold off distance/upper null zone Upper Range Value (URV) (20 mA) Volume configuration Volume unit 104 HART Fast Key 2, 1, 5, 3 2, 3, 4 2, 2, 1 2, 2, 3 2, 2, 3 2, 1, 1, 5 2, 1, 5, 2 2, 1, 2, 4 2, 1, 1, 1 2, 1, 3, 2 2, 1, 5, 2 2, 2, 1 2, 1, 2, 2 2, 1, 2, 3 2, 1, 2, 1 2, 1, 1, 5 2, 3, 4 2, 1, 5, 2 2, 1, 4, 1 2, 1, 1, 5 Basic Configuration/Start-up Reference Manual Section 5: Basic Configuration/Start-up 00809-0100-4026, Rev HA 5.7 November 2014 Basic configuration using AMS Suite The Rosemount 5400 Series transmitter can be configured using the AMS Suite software: 1. Start the AMS Device Manager making sure the transmitter is connected. The transmitter is displayed in the Device Connection View window (pictures correspond to AMS version 9.0). 2. In the Device Connection View, right click the transmitter icon. 3. Select the Configure option. 4. Select the Guided Setup option. 5. Configure the transmitter by selecting the appropriate buttons. For information on the various configuration parameters, see “Basic configuration parameters” on page 75 . Basic Configuration/Start-up 105 Reference Manual Section 5: Basic Configuration/Start-up 00809-0100-4026, Rev HA November 2014 5.8 Configuration using DeltaV The following description shows how to configure a Rosemount 5400 Series transmitter using DeltaV with the AMS application. The corresponding FOUNDATION fieldbus parameters are also shown. The Rosemount 5400 Series supports DD Methods for DeltaV in order to facilitate transmitter configuration. 1. Select DeltaV > Engineering > DeltaV Explorer from the Start menu. 2. Navigate through the file structure to find the Rosemount 5400 Series transmitter. 3. The Fieldbus Device Properties window lets you enter Device Tag and Description. This information is not required for the operation of the transmitter and can be left out if desired. General information, such as device type (5400), manufacturer, device ID are presented. The Rosemount 5400 Series device ID consists of the following components: Manufacturer ID-Model-Serial Number. Example: 0011515400-EPM-0x81365801. Check that the information complies with the ordering information. 4. Select the desired transmitter in the DeltaV Explorer and choose the Configure option. 106 Basic Configuration/Start-up Reference Manual Section 5: Basic Configuration/Start-up 00809-0100-4026, Rev HA November 2014 5. Select the Level Measurement setup button. 6. Choose the Tank Type which corresponds to the actual tank. If none of the available options matches the actual tank, choose Unknown. FOUNDATION fieldbus parameter: TRANSDUCER_1100 > GEOM_TANK_TYPE. 7. Tank Bottom Type is important for the measurement performance close to the tank bottom. FOUNDATION fieldbus parameter: TRANSDUCER_1100 > GEOM_TANK_BOTTOM_TYPE. 8. Tank Height is the distance from the Upper Reference Point to the tank bottom (see “Tank geometry” on page 75). Make sure that this number is as accurate as possible. FOUNDATION fieldbus parameter: TRANSDUCER_1100 > GEOM_TANK_HEIGHT. 9. If the transmitter is mounted in a Still Pipe or Bridle, select the Enable Still Pipe Measurement check box and enter the Pipe Diameter. FOUNDATION fieldbus parameter: TRANSDUCER_1100 > SIGN_PROC_CONFIG/Pipe Measurement Enable, TRANSDUCER_1100 > ANTENNA_PIPE_DIAM. See “Tank geometry” on page 75 for more information. Basic Configuration/Start-up 107 Section 5: Basic Configuration/Start-up Reference Manual 00809-0100-4026, Rev HA November 2014 10. Select the Environment tab. 11. In the Process Conditions box select the check-boxes that correspond to the conditions in your tank. You should select as few options as possible and not more than two. See “Process conditions” on page 77 for more information. FOUNDATION fieldbus parameter: TRANSDUCER_1100 > ENV_ENVIRONMENT. Choose the Product Dielectric Constant that corresponds to the current product. If you are uncertain about the correct range value for this parameter, or if the content in the tank is changing on a regular basis, choose Unknown. FOUNDATION fieldbus parameter: TRANSDUCER_1100 > ENV_DIELECTR_CONST. 108 Basic Configuration/Start-up Reference Manual Section 5: Basic Configuration/Start-up 00809-0100-4026, Rev HA November 2014 12. To configure volume calculation, select the ADV_CONFIG_TB_1300 block and choose the Volume tab. Basic Configuration/Start-up 109 Section 5: Basic Configuration/Start-up Reference Manual 00809-0100-4026, Rev HA November 2014 13. Choose a pre-defined calculation method based on a tank shape that corresponds to the actual tank. A. Choose None if volume calculation is not desired. B. Use Volume Offset if you do not want zero volume and zero level to match (for example, if you want to include the product volume below the zero level). The Strapping Table option is used if the actual tank does not match any of the available options for pre-defined tanks or if a higher calculation accuracy is desired. Calculation Method: FOUNDATION fieldbus parameter: ADV_CONFIG_TB_1300 > VOL_VOLUME_CALC_METHOD. Diameter: FOUNDATION fieldbus parameter: ADV_CONFIG_TB_1300 > VOL_IDEAL_DIAMETER. Tank Length: FOUNDATION fieldbus parameter: ADV_CONFIG_TB_1300 > VOL_IDEAL_LENGTH. Volume Offset: FOUNDATION fieldbus parameter: ADV_CONFIG_TB_1300 > VOL_VOLUME_OFFSET. See “Volume configuration” on page 78 for more information. 14. Choose Measure and Learn to configure the thresholds. For more information on the Measure and Learn function, see “Echo tuning” on page 83. 15. Restart the device. 110 Basic Configuration/Start-up Reference Manual Section 5: Basic Configuration/Start-up 00809-0100-4026, Rev HA 5.8.1 November 2014 Advanced configuration False echo registration 1. In the AMS/DeltaV Explorer select the desired transmitter icon, click the right mouse button and choose the Configure option. 2. Select Manual Setup and choose the Echo Tuning tab. 3. Click the Register False Echo button and follow the wizard to choose and register echoes which can be identified as disturbing objects in the tank. See “Registration of false echoes” on page 135 for more information. 4. To unregister false echoes, click the Unregister False Echo button and follow the wizard. Basic Configuration/Start-up 111 Reference Manual Section 5: Basic Configuration/Start-up 00809-0100-4026, Rev HA November 2014 5.9 FOUNDATION fieldbus overview The configuration of a Rosemount 5400 Series transmitter is normally a simple and straightforward task. If the transmitter is pre-configured at the factory according to the ordering specifications in the Configuration Data Sheet, no further Basic Configuration is required unless tank conditions have changed. The Rosemount 5400 Series supports a set of advanced configuration options as well, which can be used to handle special tank conditions and applications. Figure 5-15 illustrates how the signals are channeled through the gauge. Figure 5-15. Function Block Diagram for the Rosemount 5400 Series Radar Level Transmitters with FOUNDATION fieldbus Level transducer block FOUNDATION fieldbus compliant communications stack Register transducer block Advanced configuration block Resource block physical device information It is highly recommended that you limit the number of periodic writes to all static or non-volatile parameters, such as HI_HI_LIM, LOW_CUT, SP, TRACK_IN_D, OUT, IO_OPTS, BIAS, STATUS_OPTS, SP_HI_LIM, and so on. Static parameter writes increment the static revision counter, ST_REV, and are written to the device's non-volatile memory. Fieldbus devices have a non-volatile memory write limit. If a static or non-volatile parameter is configured to be written periodically, the device can stop its normal operation after it reaches its limit or fail to accept new values. Each FOUNDATION fieldbus configuration tool or host device has a different way of displaying and performing configurations. Some will use Device Descriptions (DD) and DD Methods to make configuration and displaying of data consistent across host platforms. Since there is no requirement that a configuration tool or host support these features, this section will describe how to reconfigure the device manually. This section covers basic operation, software functionality, and basic configuration procedures for the Rosemount 5400 Series Level Transmitter with FOUNDATION fieldbus (Device Revision 3). For detailed information about FOUNDATION fieldbus technology and function blocks used in the Rosemount 5400 Series, refer to the FOUNDATION fieldbus Blocks Manual (Document No. 00809-0100-4783). 112 Basic Configuration/Start-up Reference Manual Section 5: Basic Configuration/Start-up 00809-0100-4026, Rev HA 5.9.1 November 2014 Assigning device tag and node address A Rosemount 5400 Series transmitter is shipped with a blank tag and a temporary address (unless specifically ordered with both) to allow a host to automatically assign an address and a tag. If the tag or address need to be changed, use the features of the configuration tool. The tool basically does the following: 1. Changes the address to a temporary address (248-251). 2. Changes the tag to a new value. 3. Changes the address to a new address. When the transmitter is at a temporary address, only the tag and address can be changed or written to. The resource, transducer, and function blocks are all disabled. 5.9.2 FOUNDATION fieldbus block operation Function blocks within the fieldbus device perform the various functions required for process control. Function blocks perform process control functions, such as Analog Input (AI) functions, as well as Proportional/Integral/Derivative (PID) functions. The standard function blocks provide a common structure for defining function block inputs, outputs, control parameters, events, alarms, and modes, and combining them into a process that can be implemented within a single device or over the fieldbus network. This simplifies the identification of characteristics that are common to function blocks. In addition to function blocks, fieldbus devices contain two other block types to support the function blocks. These are the Resource block and the Transducer block. Resource blocks contain the hardware-specific characteristics associated with a device; they have no input or output parameters. The algorithm within a resource block monitors and controls the general operation of the physical device hardware. There is only one resource block defined for a device. Transducer blocks connect function blocks to local input/output functions. They read sensor hardware and write to effector (actuator) hardware. Level transducer block The Level Transducer block contains transmitter information including diagnostics and the ability to configure, set to factory defaults and restarting the transmitter. Register transducer block The Register Transducer block allows a service engineer to access all database registers in the device. Advanced configuration transducer block The advanced configuration transducer block contains functions such as amplitude threshold settings for filtering of disturbing echoes and noise, simulation of measurement values and strapping table for volume measurements. Basic Configuration/Start-up 113 Reference Manual Section 5: Basic Configuration/Start-up 00809-0100-4026, Rev HA November 2014 Resource block There are no linkable inputs or outputs to the Resource block. Analog-Input Block Figure 5-16. Analog-Input Block OUT_D AI OUT OUT = The block output value and status OUT_D = Discrete output that signals a selected alarm condition The AI function block processes field device measurements and makes them available to other function blocks. The output value from the AI block is in engineering units and contains a status indicating the quality of the measurement. The measuring device may have several measurements or derived values available in different channels. Use the channel number to define the variable that the AI block processes and passes on to linked blocks. For further information refer to Appendix C: Analog-Input Block. For more information on the different function blocks refer to Appendix C: Level Transducer Block, Appendix C: Register Transducer Block, Appendix C: Advanced Configuration Transducer Block, Appendix C: Resource Block, and Appendix C: Analog-Input Block. Function blocks The following function blocks are available for the Rosemount 5400 Series: Analog Input (AI) Proportional/Integral/Derivative (PID) Control Selector (CSEL) Output Splitter (OSPL) Signal Characterizer (CHAR) Integrator (INTEG) Arithmetic (ARITH) Input Selector (ISEL) For detailed information about FOUNDATION fieldbus technology and function blocks used in the Rosemount 5400 Series, refer to the FOUNDATION fieldbus Blocks Manual (Document No. 00809-0100-4783). 114 Basic Configuration/Start-up Reference Manual Section 5: Basic Configuration/Start-up 00809-0100-4026, Rev HA November 2014 5.10 Application examples 5.10.1 Radar level transmitter - level value Situation A level gauge is measuring the level in a 33 ft (10 m) high tank. Figure 5-17. Situation Diagram 100 % 33 ft (10 m) 0% Solution Table 5-5 lists the appropriate configuration settings, and Figure 5-18 illustrates the correct function block configuration. Table 5-5. Analog-Input Function Block Configuration for a Typical Level Gauge Parameter Configured values L_TYPE XD_SCALE OUT_SCALE CHANNEL Direct Not Used Not Used CH1: Level Figure 5-18. Analog-Input Function Block Diagram for a Typical Level Transmitter Level measurement AI function block Basic Configuration/Start-up OUT_D OUT To another function block 115 Reference Manual Section 5: Basic Configuration/Start-up 00809-0100-4026, Rev HA November 2014 5.10.2 Radar level transmitter - level value in percent (%) Situation The level of a tank is to be measured using the Rosemount 5400 Series mounted on a nozzle on the top of the tank. The maximum level in the tank is 46 ft (14 m). The level value will be displayed in percentage of the full span (see Figure 5-19). Figure 5-19. Situation Diagram 100 % 46 ft (14 m) 0% Solution Table 5-6 lists the appropriate configuration settings, and Figure 5-20 illustrates the correct function block configuration. Table 5-6. Analog-Input Function Block Configuration for a Level Gauge where Level Output is Scaled between 0-100 % Parameter Configured values L_TYPE XD_SCALE OUT_SCALE CHANNEL Indirect 0 to 14 m 0 to 100 % CH1: Level Figure 5-20. Function Block Diagram for a Level Gauge where Level Output is Scaled between 0-100 % Level measurement AI function block 116 OUT_D OUT 0 to 100 % Basic Configuration/Start-up Reference Manual Section 5: Basic Configuration/Start-up 00809-0100-4026, Rev HA 5.11 November 2014 Tri-Loop™ HART to Analog Converter The Rosemount 333 HART Tri-Loop HART-to-Analog Signal Converter is capable of converting a digital HART burst signal into three additional 4-20 mA analog signals. To set the Rosemount 5400 Series transmitter up for the HART Tri-Loop: 1. Make sure the Rosemount 5400 transmitter is properly configured. 2. Assign transmitter variables Primary Variable, Secondary Variable etc. HART command [2, 1, 1]. RRM: Setup > Output/General. Variables Assignment 3. Configure variable units: Length, Level Rate, Volume, and Temperature. HART command [2, 2, 2, 5]. RRM: Setup > General/Units. Variable Units 4. Set the Rosemount 5400 in Burst mode. HART command [2, 2, 4, 2]. RRM: Setup > General/Communication. Basic Configuration/Start-up 117 Reference Manual Section 5: Basic Configuration/Start-up 00809-0100-4026, Rev HA November 2014 5. Select Burst option 3 = Process variables and current (Process vars/crnt). HART command [2, 2, 4, 2, 2]. 6. Install the Tri-Loop. Connect Channel 1 wires, and optionally wires for Channel 2 and Channel 3. 7. Configure Tri-Loop Channel 1: a. Assign variable: Tri-Loop HART command [1, 2, 2, 1, 1]. Make sure that the SV, TV, and QV match the configuration of the Rosemount 5400 Series transmitter. b. Assign units: Tri-Loop HART command [1, 2, 2, 1, 2]. Make sure that the same units are used as for the Rosemount 5400 Series transmitter. c. Set the Upper Range Value and the Lower Range Value: Tri-Loop HART command [1, 2, 2, 1, 3-4]. d. Enable the channel. Tri-Loop HART command [1, 2, 2, 1, 5]. 8. (Optional) Repeat steps a-d for Channels 2 and 3. 9. Connect wires to Tri-Loop Burst Input. 10. Enter the desired tag, descriptor, and message information: Tri-Loop HART command [1,2,3]. 11. (Optional) If necessary, perform an analog output trim for Channel 1 (and Channel 2 and 3 if they are used). Tri-Loop HART command [1, 1, 4]. Figure 5-21. Tri-Loop Wiring DIN Rail Mounted HART Tri-Loop QV TV SV PV HART Burst Command 3/ Analog Output IS Barrier Each Tri-Loop Channel receives power from Control Room Channel 1 must be powered for the Tri-Loop to operate Device receives power from Control Room Control Room See the reference manual for the Rosemount 333 HART Tri-Loop HART-to-Analog Signal Converter (Document No. 00809-0100-4754) for further information on how to install and configure the Tri-Loop. 118 Basic Configuration/Start-up Reference Manual Section 6: Operation 00809-0100-4026, Rev HA Section 6 November 2014 Operation Safety messages . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Viewing measurement data . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . LCD display error messages . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . LED error messages . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6.1 page 119 page 120 page 126 page 127 Safety messages Procedures and instructions in this manual may require special precautions to ensure the safety of the personnel performing the operations. Information that raises potential safety issues is indicated by a warning symbol ( ). Refer to the safety messages listed at the beginning of each section before performing an operation preceded by this symbol. Failure to follow these installation guidelines could result in death or serious injury. Make sure only qualified personnel perform the installation. Use the equipment only as specified in this manual. Failure to do so may impair the protection provided by the equipment. Explosions could result in death or serious injury. Verify that the operating environment of the transmitter is consistent with the appropriate hazardous locations certifications. Before connecting a HART-based communicator in an explosive atmosphere, make sure the instruments in the loop are installed in accordance with intrinsically safe or non-incendive field wiring practices. Electrical shock could cause death or serious injury. Use extreme caution when making contact with the leads and terminals. Antennas with non-conducting surfaces. Antennas with non-conducting surfaces (e.g. Rod antenna and Process Seal antenna) may generate an ignition-capable level of electrostatic charge under extreme conditions. Therefore, when the antenna is used in a potentially explosive atmosphere, appropriate measures must be taken to prevent electrostatic discharge. Any substitution of non-authorized parts or repair, other than exchanging the complete transmitter head or antenna assembly, may jeopardize safety and is prohibited. Unauthorized changes to the product are strictly prohibited as they may unintentionally and unpredictably alter performance and jeopardize safety. Unauthorized changes that interfere with the integrity of the welds or flanges, such as making additional perforations, compromise product integrity and safety. Equipment ratings and certifications are no longer valid on any products that have been damaged or modified without the prior written permission of Emerson Process Management. Any continued use of product that has been damaged or modified without prior written authorization is at the customer's sole risk and expense. Operation 119 Reference Manual Section 6: Operation 00809-0100-4026, Rev HA November 2014 6.2 Viewing measurement data 6.2.1 Using the display panel The Rosemount 5400 Series transmitter uses an optional display panel to present measurement data. When the transmitter is switched on, the display panel presents information, such as transmitter model, measurement frequency, software version, communication type (HART, FF), serial number, HART identification tag, setting of write protection switch, and Analog Output settings. When the transmitter is operating, the display panel presents level, signal amplitude, volume, and other measurement data, depending on the display panel configuration (see “Specifying display panel variables” on page 120). The display has two rows, with the upper row showing the measured value and the bottom row showing the parameter name and measurement unit. The display toggles between the different variables every 2 seconds. Variables can be selected to be presented by using a Field Communicator, the AMS Suite, DeltaV, or the RRM software. Figure 6-1. The Rosemount 5400 Series Display Panel Measurement value Toggling between measurement parameter and measurement unit Error messages are listed in sections “LCD display error messages” on page 126 and “LED error messages” on page 127. 6.2.2 Specifying display panel variables It is possible to specify the variables to be presented on the display panel (LCD display). Using a Field Communicator For a Field Communicator, the LCD display settings are available with HART command [2, 2, 3]. FOUNDATION fieldbus parameters: TRANSDUCER_1100 > LCD_PARAMETERS. 120 Operation Reference Manual Section 6: Operation 00809-0100-4026, Rev HA November 2014 Using RRM The LCD tab in the General window allows variables to be specified for view on the Display Panel screen: 1. Choose the General option from the Setup menu, or click the General icon in the Device Configuration window. Device Config General 2. Select the LCD tab. Figure 6-2. RRM lets you Specify Variables for the Rosemount 5400 Series Display Panel Operation 3. Select the variables to appear on the Display Panel. The LCD will alternate between the selected items. 4. Click the Store button to save the LCD display settings in the transmitter database. 121 Reference Manual Section 6: Operation 00809-0100-4026, Rev HA November 2014 Using AMS and DeltaV The LCD tab in the Configure window specifies which variables will be shown on the Display Panel screen: 1. Select the transmitter icon in the AMS and DeltaV explorer. 2. Click the right mouse button and choose the Configure option. 3. Select Manual Setup and choose the Display tab to set the desired LCD display parameters and LCD display measurement units. The available LCD display parameters are listed in Table 6-1 on page 6-123. 4. Click the Send button to save the configuration. 5. Close the window. Figure 6-3. Configure Parameters to be Presented on the Display Panel 122 Operation Reference Manual Section 6: Operation 00809-0100-4026, Rev HA November 2014 LCD display parameters Table 6-1. LCD Display Parameters and Presentation on Display Operation Parameter Presentation on display Description Level LVL Product level. Distance DST Distance from the upper reference point to the product surface. Level Rate LR The speed of level movement up or down. Signal Strength AMP The signal amplitude of the surface echo. Volume Only measurement unit is shown. Total product volume. Internal Temperature ITEMP Temperature inside the transmitter housing. AOut Current ANOUT Analog Output 4 -20 mA current. Percent of Range % RNG Level value in percent of total measurement range. Comm Quality COM Q Digital communication signal quality. 123 Section 6: Operation 6.2.3 Reference Manual 00809-0100-4026, Rev HA November 2014 Viewing measurement data in RRM To view measurements, such as level, signal strength, etc. in RRM, choose the Tools > Device Display option and select the Level tab: Figure 6-4. Presentation of Measurement Data in RRM To view the Analog Output signal, choose the Tools > Device Display option and select the Analog Out tab: Figure 6-5. Presentation of Analog Output Value in RRM 124 Operation Reference Manual Section 6: Operation 00809-0100-4026, Rev HA 6.2.4 November 2014 Viewing measurement data in AMS Suite and DeltaV To view measurements, such as level, signal strength, etc. in the AMS Suite: 1. Select the transmitter icon in the AMS Suite Device Connection View window. 2. Click the right mouse button and choose the Overview option. Figure 6-6. Presentation of Measurement Data in AMS Suite Operation 125 Reference Manual Section 6: Operation 00809-0100-4026, Rev HA November 2014 6.3 LCD display error messages Figure 6-7. The Rosemount 5400 Series Display Panel Displaying an Error Message Error message Table 6-2. Error Messages Displayed on the Rosemount 5400 Series Display Panel Error message Description RAM FAIL An error in the gauge data memory (RAM) has been detected during the startup tests. NOTE: this resets the gauge automatically. FPROM FAIL An error in the gauge program memory (FPROM) has been detected during the startup tests. NOTE: this resets the gauge automatically. HREG FAIL An error in the transmitter configuration memory (EEPROM) has been detected. The error is either a checksum error that can be solved by loading the default database or a hardware error. NOTE: the default values are used until the problem is solved. OMEM FAIL Other memory failure. MWM FAIL An error in the microwave module. DPLY FAIL An error in the LCD display. MODEM FAIL Modem hardware failure. AOUT FAIL An error in the Analog Out Module. OHW FAIL An unspecified hardware error has been detected. ITEMP FAIL An error in the internal temperature measurement. MEAS FAIL A serious measurement error has been detected. CONFIG FAIL At least one configuration parameter is outside the allowed range. NOTE: the default values are used until the problem is solved. SW FAIL An error has been detected in the transmitter software. For more information on errors, see “Error Messages” on page 154. 126 Operation Reference Manual Section 6: Operation 00809-0100-4026, Rev HA 6.4 November 2014 LED error messages For Rosemount 5400 Series transmitters without a display, a flashing Light Emitting Diode (LED) is used to present error messages. Figure 6-8. Rosemount 5400 Series Transmitters without Display use a LED for the Presentation of Error Messages Flashing LED In normal operation, the LED flashes orange once every other second. When an error occurs, the LED flashes a sequence that corresponds to the Code number followed by a five second pause, and this sequence is continuously repeated. The following errors can be displayed: Table 6-3. LED Error Codes Code Error 11 12 14 15 Ram Failure FPROM HREG Microwave Module Display Modem Analog Out Internal Temperature Hardware Measurement Configuration Software Example Modem error (code 6) is displayed as the following flash sequence: Seconds Operation 127 Section 6: Operation November 2014 128 Reference Manual 00809-0100-4026, Rev HA Operation Reference Manual Section 7: Service and Troubleshooting 00809-0100-4026, Rev HA Section 7 November 2014 Service and Troubleshooting Safety messages . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Troubleshooting overview . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Service overview . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Analog Output calibration . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Logging measurement data . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Backing up the transmitter configuration . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Diagnostics . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Configuration report . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Viewing input and holding registers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Reset to factory settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Surface search . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Using the Simulation Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Write protecting a transmitter . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Diagnostic messages . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Troubleshooting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7.1 page 129 page 131 page 132 page 142 page 143 page 144 page 145 page 147 page 148 page 149 page 150 page 151 page 152 page 153 page 163 Safety messages Procedures and instructions in this manual may require special precautions to ensure the safety of the personnel performing the operations. Information that raises potential safety issues is indicated by a warning symbol ( ). Refer to the safety messages listed at the beginning of each section before performing an operation preceded by this symbol. Note The antenna seal assembly should under no circumstances be disassembled. Service and Troubleshooting 129 Section 7: Service and Troubleshooting Reference Manual 00809-0100-4026, Rev HA November 2014 Failure to follow safe installation and service guidelines could result in death or serious injury. Make sure only qualified personnel perform installation or service. Use the equipment only as specified in this manual. Failure to do so may impair the protection provided by the equipment. Any substitution of non-authorized parts or repair, other than exchanging the complete transmitter head or antenna assembly, may jeopardize safety and is prohibited. Unauthorized changes to the product are strictly prohibited as they may unintentionally and unpredictably alter performance and jeopardize safety. Unauthorized changes that interfere with the integrity of the welds or flanges, such as making additional perforations, compromise product integrity and safety. Equipment ratings and certifications are no longer valid on any products that have been damaged or modified without the prior written permission of Emerson Process Management. Any continued use of product that has been damaged or modified without prior written authorization is at the customer's sole risk and expense. Explosions could result in death or serious injury. Verify that the operating environment of the transmitter is consistent with the appropriate hazardous locations specifications. In an Explosion-proof/Flameproof installation, do not remove the transmitter cover when power is applied to the unit. Before connecting a HART® based communicator in an explosive atmosphere, make sure the instruments in the loop are installed in accordance with intrinsically safe or non-incendive field wiring practices. Electrical shock can result in death or serious injury. Avoid contact with the leads and terminals. High voltage that may be present on leads can cause electrical shock. Make sure the main power to the Rosemount 5400 Series transmitter is off and the lines to any other external power source are disconnected or not powered while wiring the transmitter. Antennas with non-conducting surfaces. 130 Antennas with non-conducting surfaces (e.g. Rod antenna and Process Seal antenna) may generate an ignition-capable level of electrostatic charge under extreme conditions. Therefore, when the antenna is used in a potentially explosive atmosphere, appropriate measures must be taken to prevent electrostatic discharge. Service and Troubleshooting Reference Manual Section 7: Service and Troubleshooting 00809-0100-4026, Rev HA 7.2 November 2014 Troubleshooting overview Table 7-1 below gives information on the possible causes of system malfunctions. It also lists the symptoms and necessary actions to be taken. Table 7-1. Troubleshooting Chart Symptom Possible cause Action No level reading • Power disconnected • Data communication cables disconnected • Check the power supply • Check the cables for serial data communication • Check LED/Display No HART communication • COM Port configuration does not match the connected COM Port • Cables may be disconnected • Wrong HART address is used • Hardware failure • HART resistor • Check that correct COM Port is selected in the HART server (see “Specifying the COM port” on page 87) • Check the COM port buffer, “Specifying the COM port” on page 87 • Check wiring diagram • Verify that the 250 : resistor is in the loop, see Figure 4-23 on page 70 • Check cables • Make sure that correct HART short address is used. Try address =0 • Check the COM Port Buffer setting, see page 88 • Check Analog Output current value to verify that transmitter hardware works Analog Out is set in Alarm • Measurement failure or transmitter failure • Open the Diagnostics window in RRM to check active errors and alarms, see “Diagnostics” on page 145 • See also “Analyzing the measurement signal” on page 132 and “Analog Output status” on page 158 Incorrect level reading • Configuration error • Disturbing objects in the tank • See “Application errors” on page 159 • Check the Tank Height parameter; RRM>Setup>Tank • Check status information and diagnostics information, see “Diagnostics” on page 145 • Check that the transmitter has not locked on an interfering object • See “Analyzing the measurement signal” on page 132 Integral display does not work • Check the display configuration in RRM (open menu Setup > General) • Diagnostics • Contact Emerson Process Management Service Department(1) Temperature measurement failure • Check ambient temperature(2) • Restart gauge • Contact Emerson Process Management Service Department Level measurement failure • Check Power Supply • Check the gauge configuration • Check that the mechanical installation is correct Volume measurement failure • Restart gauge • Check gauge configuration using PC Based configuration tool No surface echo • Check signal strength • Restart transmitter • See “Analyzing the measurement signal” on page 132 (1) A malfunctioning display panel may only be replaced by service personnel at the Emerson Process Management Service Department. (2) If the Rosemount 5400 Series transmitter has been exposed to temperatures outside the specified limits, the device may stop its normal operation. Service and Troubleshooting 131 Reference Manual Section 7: Service and Troubleshooting 00809-0100-4026, Rev HA November 2014 7.3 Service overview The functions mentioned in this section are available in the RRM configuration program. 7.3.1 Analyzing the measurement signal RRM, and other tools using enhanced EDDL, has powerful functions for advanced troubleshooting. By using the Echo Curve plot function, an instant view of the tank signal is displayed. Measurement problems can be resolved by studying the position and amplitude of the different pulses. Figure 7-1. The Echo Curve Presents all Visible Echoes False echo Reference Product surface Hold off distance Tank bottom Unknown Surface threshold / ATC In a typical measurement situation, the following pulses appear in the diagram: Reference. This pulse is caused by the transition between transmitter head and antenna and it is used by the transmitter as a reference at level measurements. A missing reference pulse might be a symptom of a malfunctioning transmitter. Contact your local Emerson Process Management representative for assistance. Product surface. This pulse is caused by a reflection on the product surface. Different amplitude thresholds are used to filter out unwanted signals and pick up different pulses. The transmitter uses certain criteria to decide which type of pulse that is detected. Echoes found above the Surface Threshold might be considered the product surface. Surface threshold. The amplitude threshold used for detecting the product level peak. The amplitude threshold is designed as a number of individually adjustable amplitude threshold points, the ATC. See “ATC” on page 84. The ATC is set during the Measure and Learn function and can be adjusted manually. The ATC is used for filtering out disturbances with an amplitude smaller than the product surface echo. 132 Service and Troubleshooting Reference Manual Section 7: Service and Troubleshooting 00809-0100-4026, Rev HA November 2014 The surface thresholds should be set to approximately 20 % of the measured signal amplitude of the product surface. False echo area. False Echo Areas are set during the Measure and Learn function (see “Guided setup” on page 92), when the disturbing object is larger than the surface echo. The False Echo Area can be adjusted manually. Hold off distance - upper null zone. Measurements are not performed within the hold off distance. By setting the hold off distance to zero, measurements can be performed close to the flange. Consider near zone accuracy. See “Near zone accuracy” on page 193. Tank bottom. Measurements are not performed after the Tank Bottom limit. 7.3.2 Surface pulse not found The amplitude thresholds are adjusted manually or during the Measure and Learn function to appropriate values to filter out noise and other non-valid measurements from the measurement signal. The amplitude of the measurement signal, that is the amplitude of the signal reflected by the product surface, is related to the actual dielectric constant of the product. RRM has a plot function that allows viewing of the reflections in the tank. If the amplitude threshold is too high, the product level will not be detected, as illustrated in Figure 7-2. In a situation like this, the amplitude threshold is lowered so that the Surface peak is not filtered out. Amplitude, mV Figure 7-2. Example 1: Surface Threshold is Too High Reference The surface threshold is above the surface peak Surface threshold = ATC Distance, m If there are disturbing objects in the tank, the threshold must be set carefully to avoid locking on the wrong amplitude peak. In Figure 7-3, the transmitter has locked on a peak above the actual product surface, that is a disturbance was interpreted as the product surface. Service and Troubleshooting 133 Reference Manual Section 7: Service and Troubleshooting 00809-0100-4026, Rev HA November 2014 Figure 7-3. Example 2: Surface Threshold is Too Low Amplitude, mV Reference Actual surface P1 - Disturbing echo misinterpreted as product surface Surface threshold = ATC Distance, m By adjusting the surface threshold, the product surface is properly detected, as illustrated in Figure 7-4: Figure 7-4. Echo Curve after Surface Threshold was Adjusted Reference Amplitude, mV After surface threshold is adjusted, the product surface is correctly detected Surface Threshold = ATC Distance, m To adjust the amplitude thresholds, see “Using the Echo Curve Analyzer” on page 137. In the Echo Curve Analyzer in RRM, the amplitude threshold points can easily be dragged to the desired values. 134 Service and Troubleshooting Reference Manual Section 7: Service and Troubleshooting 00809-0100-4026, Rev HA 7.3.3 November 2014 Registration of false echoes The False Echo function improves the performance of the gauge when the surface is close to a horizontal surface of a static object in the tank. The object causes an echo when it is above the surface. When the echoes from the surface and the object are close to each other, they may interfere and cause a decrease in performance. Figure 7-5. The Rosemount 5400 Series can Handle Disturbing Radar Echoes Disturbing objects False echo Surface echo The False Echo function allows registration of disturbing echoes caused by objects in the tank. When the surface is passing a disturbing object, the transmitter measures with higher reliability if the position of the object is registered. This makes it possible to detect a product surface close to a disturbance echo even if the surface echo is weaker than the disturbing echo. Follow these recommendations before registering new interfering echoes: Make sure a correct ATC is set before registering any disturbance echoes (see “ATC” on page 84). Compare the list of interfering echoes with the tank drawing or visual inspection of the tank. Note any objects like beams, heating coils, agitators, etc. which correspond to the found echoes. Only register echoes above the ATC which can be clearly identified as objects in the tank, keeping the number of registered echoes to a minimum. Make sure the level is stable before registering a disturbance echo. A fluctuating level may indicate a temporary disturbance that is not from an interfering object. Do not register False Echoes located below the product surface. It is recommended that registration be done when the tank is empty. Service and Troubleshooting 135 Reference Manual Section 7: Service and Troubleshooting 00809-0100-4026, Rev HA November 2014 Figure 7-6. Disturbing Echoes can be Filtered Out by Registration as False Echoes Amplitude, mV Registered false echo Distance, m The False Echo Registration function is available in the RRM program, in the AMS Suite, as well as for the Field Communicator. 136 Service and Troubleshooting Reference Manual Section 7: Service and Troubleshooting 00809-0100-4026, Rev HA 7.3.4 November 2014 Using the Echo Curve Analyzer The Echo Curve in RRM shows the measurement signal amplitude in the tank and includes the Echo Tuning functionality (see “Echo tuning” on page 83 for more information on false echo handling). To plot the measurement signal: 1. Start the RRM program. 2. Open Device Config/Tools (or Device Config/Setup). 3. Click the Echo Curve icon (see Figure 7-7). Figure 7-7. The Echo Curve Function is a Useful Tool for Signal Analysis Device Config Setup 4. Service and Troubleshooting The Echo Curve Analyzer window appears with the View/Record Mode tab (or the Configuration Mode tab) selected. 137 Reference Manual Section 7: Service and Troubleshooting 00809-0100-4026, Rev HA November 2014 The Configuration Mode tab The Configuration Mode tab allows for adjustment of the different amplitude thresholds. When clicking the Echo Curve icon under Device Config/Setup, the Echo Curve Analyzer window appears with the Configuration Mode tab selected: Figure 7-8. Echo Curve Analyzer Plot in Configuration Mode Measure and Learn Set Threshold The Measure and Learn function in RRM automatically creates an ATC used by the Rosemount 5400 Series transmitter to find the surface pulse. The ATC is adapted to the shape of the measurement signal as described in “Echo tuning” on page 83. To create an ATC, click the Learn button in the Echo Curve Analyzer/Configuration Mode window. By clicking the Learn button, the Measure and Learn function is activated and creates an ATC that filters out all disturbing echoes. The ATC can also be edited manually if further fine tuning is needed. The Configuration Mode window also allows the changing of the amplitude thresholds manually, simply by dragging the corresponding anchoring points in the plot to the desired positions. Note By changing the amplitude thresholds in the Echo Curve plot manually, the Automatic mode is disabled for the corresponding threshold. The Set Thresholds button sets the ATC to a fixed value based on the configured Dielectric Constant of the product. To register a false echo, right-click and select Register as false echo. 138 Service and Troubleshooting Reference Manual Section 7: Service and Troubleshooting 00809-0100-4026, Rev HA November 2014 The View/Record Mode tab The View/Record Mode tab presents a plot of the current tank conditions where each radar echo is displayed as a peak in the signal plot. When clicking the Echo Curve icon under Device Config/Tools, the Echo Curve Analyzer window appears with the View/Record Mode tab selected: Figure 7-9. A Echo Curve Plot in View/Record Mode Record tank spectra Play (continuously updates the spectrum) Advanced The Advanced button opens a list below the Echo Curve plot with information on all echoes in the tank, such as signal amplitude and position in the tank. Play When the Play button is clicked, the tank is continuously updated without being stored. Record tank spectra This function records tank spectra over time. This can be a useful function if, for example, studying the tank signal when filling or emptying the tank is desired. File mode tab The File Mode tab will open files with saved snapshots/movies to be presented in the spectrum plot. A movie file can be played to view the amplitude plot at the desired update rate. Service and Troubleshooting 139 Section 7: Service and Troubleshooting 7.3.5 Reference Manual 00809-0100-4026, Rev HA November 2014 Using the Echo Curve Analyzer with a Field Communicator The Field Communicator supports the EDDL with enhancements that allows viewing of the Echo Curve, creating an ATC, and specifying amplitude thresholds, such as the Surface Threshold. Viewing the Echo Curve To view the Echo Curve: 1. Select HART command [2, 5, 2, 3]. FOUNDATION fieldbus parameter: TRANSDUCER_1300 > AMPLITUDE_THRESHOLD_CURVE The Echo Curve appears on the display: 2. Use the Hand and Zoom tools to view specific parts of the Echo Curve. The drop down list allows for choosing items, such as the different amplitude thresholds to be displayed in the plot. The Echo Curve plot also shows an ATC if available. See “ATC” on page 84 for more information. 140 Service and Troubleshooting Reference Manual Section 7: Service and Troubleshooting 00809-0100-4026, Rev HA November 2014 Register false echoes To register false echoes: 1. Select HART command [2, 5, 1]. Peaks Found Echo Peaks Measurement Output Registered False Echoes Add False Echo... Remove False Echo... 2. Select option 1 Found Echo Peaks to display found echoes. 3. Select option 2 Add False Echo... to register false echoes based on distance. Threshold settings To adjust the amplitude thresholds: 1. Select HART command [2, 5, 2]. The different echo curve options appear on the display: 2. Select option 1 Measure and Learn to create an ATC, see “ATC” on page 84 for more information. Select option 2 Set Threshold to specify a constant Surface Threshold. 3. Click the SAVE button to store the new settings in the transmitter database. Service and Troubleshooting 141 Section 7: Service and Troubleshooting 7.4 Reference Manual 00809-0100-4026, Rev HA November 2014 Analog Output calibration This function calibrates the Analog Output by comparing the actual output current with the nominal 4 mA and 20 mA currents. Calibration is done at the factory and normally the transmitter does not need to be recalibrated. The Analog Output calibration function is available via the HART command [2, 7, 1]. In RRM, this function is available via Setup > Output. To calibrate the Analog Output current: 142 1. Start RRM and make sure that the transmitter communicates with the PC. 2. Select the Output icon in the Device Config/Setup toolbar. 3. Select the Analog Out tab in the Output window. 4. Select the Calibrate DAC button. 5. Follow the instructions to calibrate the 4 mA and the 20 mA outputs. Service and Troubleshooting Reference Manual Section 7: Service and Troubleshooting 00809-0100-4026, Rev HA 7.5 November 2014 Logging measurement data By using the Log Device Registers function in the RRM software, Input and Holding registers are logged over time. It is possible to choose from different pre-defined sets of registers. This function is useful for verifying that the transmitter is working properly. To log device registers, choose the Tools > Log Device Registers option to open the Log Registers window: Browse Select Register Update rate Start Log To begin logging: 1. Select the Browse button, select a directory to store the log file, and type a log file title. 2. Select the Select Register button and choose the register type to be logged. 3. Select the desired registers to be logged. There are three options available: Standard, Service, and Custom. Standard and Service refer to pre-defined sets of registers. The Custom option allows the user to choose the desired range of registers. 4. Enter the update rate. An update rate of 10 seconds means that the plot will update every 10 seconds. 5. Select the Start Log button. The logging will proceed until the Stop Log button is selected. Service and Troubleshooting 143 Reference Manual Section 7: Service and Troubleshooting 00809-0100-4026, Rev HA November 2014 7.6 Backing up the transmitter configuration Use this RRM option to make a backup copy of the configuration parameters in the transmitter database. The backup file can be used to restore the transmitter configuration. It can also be used for configuration of a transmitter in a similar application. Parameters in the saved file can be uploaded directly to the new device. It is recommended to store the transmitter configuration in a backup file. The backup function is available from the Device menu in RRM. To make a backup copy of the configuration parameters: 1. From the Device menu, choose the Backup Config to File option. 2. Browse to the desired directory. 3. Enter a name for the backup file and select the Save button, so the transmitter configuration is stored. The backup file can be used at a later stage to restore an accidentally changed configuration. The backup file can also be used to quickly configure transmitters installed on similar tanks. To upload a backup configuration, choose the Upload Config to Device option from the Device menu. The backup file can be viewed using the Backup File Reader installed with the RRM software: Backup File Reader 4. The backup file can also be viewed as a text file in a word processing program such as Notepad: See “Configuration report” on page 147 for further information on viewing backup files. 144 Service and Troubleshooting Reference Manual Section 7: Service and Troubleshooting 00809-0100-4026, Rev HA 7.7 November 2014 Diagnostics The following information about the device can be retrieved: “Device status” on page 153 “Errors” on page 154 “Warnings” on page 155 “Measurement status” on page 155 “Volume calculation status” on page 157 “Analog Output status” on page 158 RRM To open the Diagnostics window in RRM, choose the Diagnostics option from the Tools menu. Service and Troubleshooting 145 Section 7: Service and Troubleshooting Reference Manual 00809-0100-4026, Rev HA November 2014 AMS and DeltaV To view the Diagnostics window in AMS Suite, click the right mouse button on the desired transmitter and choose the Configure option. Select Service Tools and the tab Active Alerts. Detailed Status is found in Details/Device: Device 146 Service and Troubleshooting Reference Manual 00809-0100-4026, Rev HA 7.8 Section 7: Service and Troubleshooting November 2014 Configuration report This RRM function shows the configuration changes made to the transmitter compared to the factory configuration. The report compares a specified backup file with the default transmitter configuration. To open the Configuration Report, choose the Tools > Configuration Report menu option: Information is presented on antenna type, software versions, software and hardware configuration, and unit code. Service and Troubleshooting 147 Section 7: Service and Troubleshooting 7.9 Reference Manual 00809-0100-4026, Rev HA November 2014 Viewing input and holding registers Measured data is continuously stored in the Input Registers and by viewing the contents, advanced users can check if the transmitter is working properly. The Holding Registers store various transmitter parameters, such as configuration data, used to control the measurement performance. By using the RRM program, most Holding Registers can be edited by typing a new value in the appropriate Value input field. Some Holding Registers can be edited in a separate window and the individual data bits can be changed. To view the Input/Holding registers in RRM, the Service Mode must be activated: 1. Choose the Enter Service Mode option from the Service menu. 2. Type the password (default password is “admin”). 3. The View Input / Holding Registers option is now available. 4. Choose the View Input / Holding Registers option from the Service menu. 5. Select the Read button. To change a Holding register value, enter a new value in the corresponding Value field. Select the Store button to save the new value. Figure 7-10. Holding and Input Registers 148 Service and Troubleshooting Reference Manual Section 7: Service and Troubleshooting 00809-0100-4026, Rev HA 7.10 November 2014 Reset to factory settings This function resets all, or a specific part, of the holding registers to the factory settings. It is recommended that a backup of the configuration be made before resetting, so the old transmitter configuration can be loaded, if necessary. RRM: choose menu option Tools > Factory Settings. AMS Suite: Tools / Service > Factory Settings. HART Command: [1, 2, 8]. AMS and DeltaV 1. In the AMS/DeltaV explorer, select Configure/Service Tools, and choose Reset to Factory Settings. Reset to Factory Settings 2. Service and Troubleshooting Choose the Factory Settings option. 149 Section 7: Service and Troubleshooting 7.11 Reference Manual 00809-0100-4026, Rev HA November 2014 Surface search The Surface Search command triggers a search for the product surface and can be used, for example, if the measured level is locked onto a disturbing object in the tank (see “Configuration report” on page 147). AMS and DeltaV 1. In the AMS and DeltaV explorer select Configure/Manual setup, choose the Echo Tuning tab, and select Search for Surface. Search for Surface 2. 150 Choose the Surface Search option. Service and Troubleshooting Reference Manual Section 7: Service and Troubleshooting 00809-0100-4026, Rev HA 7.12 November 2014 Using the Simulation Mode This function can be used to simulate measurements and alarms. RRM: choose menu option Tools > Simulation Mode: AMS Suite: Tools > Service > Simulation Mode. HART Command: [3, 2, 1, 3]. AMS and DeltaV 1. In the AMS/DeltaV explorer select Configure/Service Tools, choose Simulate to setup simulation mode: Simulate Service and Troubleshooting 151 Section 7: Service and Troubleshooting 7.13 Reference Manual 00809-0100-4026, Rev HA November 2014 Write protecting a transmitter A Rosemount 5400 Series transmitter can be password protected from unintentional configuration changes. The default password is 12345 and it is recommended that this password not be changed to facilitate service and maintenance of the transmitter. RRM: Tools > Lock / Unlock Configuration Area. AMS Suite: Tools > Service > Lock / Unlock Device. HART Command [3, 2, 1, 2]. AMS and DeltaV 1. In the AMS/DeltaV explorer select Configure/Manual setup, choose the Device tab and select Lock/Unlock Device. Lock/Unlock Device 2. 152 Choose the Unlock/Lock Device option. Service and Troubleshooting Reference Manual Section 7: Service and Troubleshooting 00809-0100-4026, Rev HA November 2014 7.14 Diagnostic messages 7.14.1 Troubleshooting If there is a malfunction, despite no diagnostic messages, see Table 7-1 on page 131 for information on possible causes. Note If the transmitter housing needs to be removed for service, make sure the antenna PTFE sealing is carefully protected against dust and water. 7.14.2 Device status Device Status messages that may appear on the Integral Display, on the Field Communicator, or in the RRM program are shown in Table 7-2: Table 7-2. Device Status Message Description Action Running Boot Software The application software could not be started. Device Warning A device warning is active. Device Error A device error is active. Simulation Mode The simulation mode is active. Advanced Simulation Mode The advanced simulation mode is active. Invalid Measurement The level measurement is invalid. Software Write Protected The configuration registers are write protected. Hardware Write Protected The Write Protection switch is enabled. Factory Settings Used The factory default configuration is used. User Area Write Protected The configuration area is write protected. Contact Emerson Process Management Service Department. See “Warning Messages” on page 155 for details. See “Error Messages” on page 154 for details. Turn off the simulation mode. To turn off the Advanced Simulation mode, set Holding Register 3600 = 0 (see “Analog Output calibration” on page 142). Check “Error Messages” on page 154, “Warning Messages” on page 155 and “Measurement Status” on page 155 for details. Use the Lock/Unlock function to turn off the write protection (see “Write protecting a transmitter” on page 152). Set the Write Protection switch to Off. Contact Emerson Process Management Service Department for information. The transmitter calibration is lost. Contact Emerson Process Management Service Department. See “Write protecting a transmitter” on page 152 for details. Service and Troubleshooting 153 Reference Manual Section 7: Service and Troubleshooting 00809-0100-4026, Rev HA November 2014 7.14.3 Errors Error messages that may be displayed on the Integral Display, on a Field Communicator, in AMS, or in the RRM program, are shown in Table 7-3. Errors normally result in an Analog Output alarm. Errors are indicated in RRM in the Diagnostics window. Table 7-3. Error Messages Message RAM Error FPROM Error HREG Error MWM Error Display Error Modem Error Analog Out Error Internal Temp Error Other HW Error Meas Error Config Error SW Error 154 Description An error in the gauge data memory (RAM) has been detected during the startup tests. NOTE: this resets the gauge automatically. An error in the gauge program memory (FPROM) has been detected during the startup tests. NOTE: this resets the gauge automatically. An error in the transmitter configuration memory (EEPROM) has been detected. The error is either a checksum error that can be solved by loading the default database or a hardware error. NOTE: the default values are used until the problem is solved. Action Contact Emerson Process Management Service Department. Contact Emerson Process Management Service Department. Load default database and restart the transmitter. Contact Emerson Process Management Service Department if the problem persists. Contact Emerson Process Management Service Department. Contact Emerson Process An error in the LCD. Management Service Department. Contact Emerson Process Modem hardware failure. Management Service Department. Emerson Process An error in the Analog Out Module. Contact Management Service Department. An error in internal temperature Contact Emerson Process measurement. Management Service Department. An unspecified hardware error has Contact Emerson Process been detected. Management Service Department. A serious measurement error has Contact Emerson Process been detected. Management Service Department. Load the default database and restart the transmitter (see “Reset to factory settings” on page 149) At least one configuration Configure the transmitter or parameter is outside the allowed upload a backup configuration file range. (see “Backing up the transmitter NOTE: the default values are used configuration” on page 144) until the problem is solved. Contact Emerson Process Management Service Department if the problem persists An error has been detected in the Contact Emerson Process transmitter software. Management Service Department. An error in the microwave module. Service and Troubleshooting Reference Manual Section 7: Service and Troubleshooting 00809-0100-4026, Rev HA 7.14.4 November 2014 Warnings Table 7-4 is a list of diagnostic messages that may be displayed on the Integral Display, on the Field Communicator, or in the RRM program. Warnings are less serious than errors, and in most cases, do not result in Analog Output alarms. Warnings are indicated in RRM in the Diagnostics window. Table 7-4. Warning Messages 7.14.5 Message Description Action RAM warning FPROM warning Hreg warning MWM warning LCD warning Modem warning Analog out warning Internal temperature warning Other hardware warning Measurement warning Config warning SW warning See Diagnostics (RRM: Tools > Diagnostics) for further information on a warning message. See also “Diagnostics” on page 145. Measurement status Measurement Status messages that may appear on the Integral Display, on the Field Communicator, or in the RRM program are shown in Table 7-5. Table 7-5. Measurement Status Message Description Action Full tank The level measurement is in Full Tank state. The transmitter waits for the surface echo to be detected at the top of the tank. Empty tank The level measurement is in Empty Tank state. The transmitter waits for the surface echo to be detected at the bottom of the tank. Reference pulse invalid An error in the reference pulse in the last sampled tank signal. Sweep linearization warning The sweep is not correctly linearized. The transmitter leaves the Full Tank state when the product surface gets below the Full Tank Detection Area, see “Full tank handling” on page 241 and “Full tank handling” on page 247. The transmitter leaves the Empty Tank state when the product surface gets above the Empty Tank Detection Area, see “Empty tank handling” on page 239 and “Empty tank handling” on page 243. Check Warning messages. If MicroWave Module (MWM) Warning is active, this might indicate a transmitter error. Contact Emerson Process Management Service Department. Check Warning messages. If MWM Warning is active, this might indicate a transmitter error. Contact Emerson Process Management Service Department. Service and Troubleshooting 155 Reference Manual Section 7: Service and Troubleshooting 00809-0100-4026, Rev HA November 2014 Message Description Action Tank signal clip warning The last Tank Signal was clipped. No surface echo The Surface Echo Pulse cannot be detected. Predicted level The presented level is predicted. The surface echo could not be detected. The sampling of the last tank signal failed. The given volume value is invalid. The simulation mode is active. The presented measurement values are simulated. The advanced simulation mode is active. The given measurements are simulated. Check Warning Messages. If MWM Warning is active, this might indicate a transmitter error. Contact Emerson Process Management Service Department. Check if the configuration can be changed so that the surface echo can be tracked in this current region. See No surface echo above. Sampling failed Invalid volume value Simulation Mode Advanced Simulation Mode Tracking Extra Echo Bottom Projection Using pipe measurement Surface close to registered false echo. Sudden level jump detected. 156 The transmitter is in the empty tank state tracking an extra echo. The bottom projection function is active. Pipe Measurement is active. Close to a registered false echo measurement accuracy may be slightly reduced. This may result from various measurement problems. Check Warning Messages. Check Volume Status for details. No action needed. To turn off the Advanced Simulation mode, set Holding Register 3600 = 0 (see “Analog Output calibration” on page 142). See “Extra echo” on page 240 and page 245. See “Tank bottom projection” on page 240. No action needed. By using the Register False Echo function, the transmitter can track the product surface in the vicinity of disturbing objects (see “Echo tuning” on page 83). Check the tank to find out what causes problem tracking the surface. Service and Troubleshooting Reference Manual Section 7: Service and Troubleshooting 00809-0100-4026, Rev HA 7.14.6 November 2014 Volume calculation status Volume calculation status messages that may appear on the integral display, on the Field Communicator, or in the RRM program are shown in Table 7-6. Table 7-6. Volume Status Message Description Action Level is below lowest strapping point. The measured level is below the lowest point in the given strapping table. The measured level is above the highest point in the given strapping table. For a correct volume calculation in this region, change the strapping table. For a correct volume calculation in this region, change the strapping table. Check if the correct tank type is chosen, and check the configured Tank Height. Change the strapping table size to a valid number of strapping points. A maximum number of 20 strapping points can be entered. Check that both level and volume values in the strapping table are increasing with strapping table index. Check “Measurement Status” on page 155, “Warning Messages” on page 155, and “Error Messages” on page 154. Level is above highest strapping point. Level out of range. The measured level is outside the given tank shape. Strap table length not valid. The configured strap table length is too small or too large. Strap table not valid. The strapping table is not correctly configured. Level not valid. The measured level is not valid. No volume value can be calculated. Volume configuration missing. No volume calculation method is chosen. Configure Volume. Volume not valid. The calculated volume is not valid. Check the other volume status messages for the reason. Service and Troubleshooting 157 Reference Manual Section 7: Service and Troubleshooting 00809-0100-4026, Rev HA November 2014 7.14.7 Analog Output status Analog Output status messages that may appear on the integral display, on the Field Communicator or in the RRM program are shown in Table 7-7. Table 7-7. Analog Output Status Message Description Action Not connected Analog output hardware is not connected. Alarm mode The analog output is in Alarm Mode. Contact Emerson Process Management Service Department. Check “Error Messages” on page 154 and “Warning Messages” on page 155 to find the reason for the Alarm. Saturated Multidrop Fixed current mode Invalid limits 158 The analog output signal value is saturated, that is equal to the saturation value. The transmitter is in Multidrop Mode. The analog output is fixed at 4 mA. The analog output is in fixed current mode. The given Upper and Lower Range Values are invalid. No action needed. This is the normal setting when a device is used in Multidrop configuration. This mode is used when calibrating the Analog Output channel. Check that the difference between the Upper and Lower Range Value is greater than the Minimum Span. Service and Troubleshooting Reference Manual Section 7: Service and Troubleshooting 00809-0100-4026, Rev HA 7.14.8 November 2014 Application errors When product surface is near the tank bottom, the transmitter enters alarm mode (see “Alarm mode” on page 81). May be caused by reduction of projected surface area close to sloping tank bottom. Action: • Increase parameter Empty Tank Detection Area if measurement in this region is not crucial, see “Empty tank detection area” on page 240 and 244 Alarm • Make sure that the Bottom Echo Visible parameter is not set, see “Bottom echo visible” on page 240 and 243 Incorrect level. Action: • Check Tank Height configuration • For rapid level changes, check the Damping Value. (See “Damping value” on page 243) Incorrect level. May be caused by wrong Range Value settings. Action: • Check that the Upper Range Value matches the 100 % level in the tank Incorrect level when using a pipe. May be caused by an incorrectly configured Pipe Inner Diameter. Action: • Check that the actual Pipe Inner Diameter matches the configured Inner Diameter Service and Troubleshooting 159 Reference Manual Section 7: Service and Troubleshooting 00809-0100-4026, Rev HA November 2014 Measured value is locked. May be caused by a disturbing object in the tank Action: • Remove the disturbing object • Move the transmitter to another position • Use the Echo Tuning function in RRM to register the false echo causing the transmitter to lock at the wrong level, see “Echo tuning” on page 83 • Put an inclined metal plate on top of the disturbing object Measured value drops to zero level. May be caused by strong echoes from the tank bottom when the product is slightly transparent. Action: • Check the Tank Height • Make sure that the Bottom Echo Visible parameter is enabled, see “Bottom echo visible” on page 240 and 243 • Try using the Tank Bottom Projection function if the following conditions are met: - The product is transparent - The tank bottom echo is visible Measured value drops to zero level. (You can verify Empty Tank state by opening the Tank Display window in RRM). If the transmitter loses track of the surface within the Empty Tank Detection Area, the tank is considered empty. See section “Empty tank detection area” on page 240 and 244. Action: If possible, try another mounting position. Measured level jumps to a lower value. May be caused by: • Two products layered in the tank Action: • Enable the Double Surface function, see “Surface echo tracking” on page 242 RRM: Setup > Advanced 160 Service and Troubleshooting Reference Manual Section 7: Service and Troubleshooting 00809-0100-4026, Rev HA November 2014 Incorrect measurement level when the product surface is above the 50 % level. May be caused by: • Radar echo bouncing from the product surface to the tank roof then back to the surface • Strong echoes from a very high reflectivity product Action: • Move the transmitter from the center of the tank roof • Enable the Double Bounce function, see “Double bounce” on page 241 and 248 RRM: Setup > Advanced Measured level jumps to a higher value. May be caused by: • Foam on the product surface • Turbulent product surface Action: • Enable the Tank Environment Foam parameter RRM: Setup > Tank > Environment HART: [2, 3, 2] • Enable the Tank Environment Turbulent Surface parameter RRM: Setup > Tank > Environment HART: [2, 3, 2] Measured level gets locked near the top of the tank. May be caused by: • Antenna tip ends inside the tank nozzle • Disturbing objects near the antenna • Product built up on the antenna Action: • Mount the transmitter on another nozzle, if possible • Increase the Hold Off distance RRM: Setup > Advanced HART: [2, 3, 4] The level value drops to a lower value when the product surface is close to the antenna. May be caused by: • Product level within the Hold Off region, that is outside the approved measuring range, and the transmitter is picking up secondary signal reflections Action: • Avoid filling the tank to levels close to the antenna • Move the transmitter to increase the distance between maximum product level and antenna, if possible • Activate the Full Tank Handling function if measurements up to the antenna are required, see “Full tank handling” on page 241 and 247 Service and Troubleshooting 161 Reference Manual Section 7: Service and Troubleshooting 00809-0100-4026, Rev HA November 2014 Alarm The transmitter displays “measurement error” and activates Measurement Alarm when the product level is close to the antenna. May be caused by: The measured level is unstable. May be caused by: • Product level within the Hold Off region, that is outside the approved measuring range Action: • Avoid filling the tank to levels very close to the antenna • Move the transmitter to increase the distance between maximum product level and antenna, if possible • Activate the Full Tank Handling function if measurements up to the antenna are required, see “Full tank handling” on page 241 and 247 • An empty tank with the Amplitude Threshold too low • Product surface is close to a registered False Echo Action: • Create a new ATC, see “Echo tuning” on page 83 162 Service and Troubleshooting Reference Manual Section 7: Service and Troubleshooting 00809-0100-4026, Rev HA 7.15 November 2014 Troubleshooting If there is a malfunction despite the absence of diagnostic messages, see Table 7-8 for information on the possible causes. Note If the transmitter housing must be removed for service, make sure that the PTFE seal is carefully protected against dust and water. Table 7-8. Troubleshooting Chart Symptom No level reading Incorrect level reading Possible cause Action • Power disconnected • Data communication cables disconnected • Check the power supply. • Check the cables for serial data communication. • Configuration error • Disturbing objects in the tank • See “Application errors” on page 159 • Check the Tank Height parameter; RRM > Setup > Tank. • Check status information and diagnostics information, see “Diagnostics” on page 145. • Check that the transmitter has not locked on an interfering object. Integral display does not work • Check the display configuration; RRM > Setup > General. • Diagnostics. • Contact Emerson Process Management Service Department(1) FOUNDATION fieldbus Card to Transmitter Communication Fault • Verify Device Mode setting, should be FOUNDATION fieldbus (Parameter: ENV_DEVICE_MODE) • Restart method from Resource Block • Reboot gauge: cycle power to the device. If error persists, replace the transmitter head. Level Measurement Failure • Analyze the echo curve for possible reasons • Check device configuration • Check physical installation of device (for example, antenna contamination) • Load default database to the device • Reconfigure the device. If error persists, replace the transmitter head. Internal Temperature Critical • Replace the transmitter head Volume Measurement Failure • If Level Measurement Failure is active, clear that alert first • Check volume configuration • Load default database to the device • Reconfigure the device. If error persists, replace the transmitter head. No surface echo • Check signal strength • Restart transmitter Tank Signal Clip Warning Empty Tank/ Full Tank Service and Troubleshooting Restart transmitter Information of tank status 163 Reference Manual Section 7: Service and Troubleshooting 00809-0100-4026, Rev HA November 2014 Symptom Possible cause Configuration Reg Password Enabled Action Information, Ready Write Data DB Error/ Microwave Unit Error/ Configuration Error/ Other Error • Restart transmitter • Download Application Software • Set database to default; load default Database • Call Service Center SW Error/ Display Error/ Analog Out Error • Restart transmitter • Call Service Center (1) A malfunctioning display panel may only be replaced by service personnel at the Emerson Process Management Service Department. A display must not be replaced when the transmitter is in operation. 7.15.1 Resource block This section describes error conditions found in the Resource block. Read Table 7-9 through Table 7-11 to determine the appropriate corrective action. Block errors Table 7-9 lists conditions reported in the BLOCK_ERR parameter. Table 7-9. Resource Block BLOCK_ERR Messages Condition name and description Other Simulate active: This indicates that the simulation switch is in place. This is not an indication that the I/O blocks are using simulated data. Device fault state set Device needs maintenance soon Memory failure: A memory failure has occurred in the FLASH, RAM, or EEPROM memory Lost static data: Static data that is stored in non-volatile memory has been lost Lost NV data: Non-volatile data that is stored in non-volatile memory has been lost Device needs maintenance now Out of service: The actual mode is out of service Table 7-10. Resource Block SUMMARY_STATUS Messages Condition name Uninitialized No repair needed Repairable Call Service Center 164 Service and Troubleshooting Reference Manual Section 7: Service and Troubleshooting 00809-0100-4026, Rev HA November 2014 Table 7-11. Resource Block DETAILED_STATUS with Recommended Action Messages Condition name LOI transducer block error Sensor transducer block error Mfg. block integrity error Non-volatile memory integrity error ROM integrity error 7.15.2 Recommended action 1. Restart processor 2. Check display connection 3. Call service center 1. Restart processor 2. Check Rosemount 5400 cable 3. Call service center 1. Restart processor 2. Call service center 1. Restart processor 2. Call service center 1. Restart processor 2. Call service center Transducer block This section describes error conditions found in the sensor transducer block. Table 7-12. Transducer Block BLOCK_ERR Messages Condition name and description Other Out of Service: The actual mode is out of service Table 7-13. Transducer Block XD_ERR Messages Condition name and description Electronics failure: An electrical component failed I/O failure: An I/O failure occurred Data integrity error: Data stored in the device is no longer valid due to a non-volatile memory checksum failure, a data verify after write failure, etc. Algorithm error: The algorithm used in the transducer block produced an error due to overflow, data reasonableness failure, etc. 7.15.3 Analog Input (AI) function block This section describes error conditions that are supported by the AI Block. Read Table 7-15 to determine the appropriate corrective action. Table 7-14. AI BLOCK_ERR Conditions Condition number Condition name and description Other Block configuration error: the selected channel carries a measurement that is incompatible with the engineering units selected in XD_SCALE, the L_TYPE parameter is not configured, or CHANNEL = zero Simulate active: Simulation is enabled and the block is using a simulated value in its execution Service and Troubleshooting 165 Reference Manual Section 7: Service and Troubleshooting 00809-0100-4026, Rev HA November 2014 Condition number Condition name and description Input failure/process variable has bad status: The hardware is bad, or a bad status is being simulated Power up Out of service: The actual mode is out of service 14 15 Table 7-15. Troubleshooting the AI Block Symptom Possible causes Recommended actions Bad or no level readings (Read the AI “BLOCK_ERR” parameter) BLOCK_ERR reads OUT OF SERVICE (OOS) BLOCK_ERR reads CONFIGURATION ERROR 1. AI Block target mode target mode set to OOS. 2. Resource Block OUT OF SERVICE. 1. Check CHANNEL parameter (see “CHANNEL” on page 293). 2. Check L_TYPE parameter (see “L_TYPE” on page 293) 3. Check XD_SCALE engineering units. (see “XD_SCALE and OUT_SCALE” on page 294 Download Schedule into block. Refer to host for downloading procedure. 1. Sensor Transducer Block Out Of Service (OOS) 2. Resource Block Out of Service (OOS) 1. Check XD_SCALE parameter. 2. Check OUT_SCALE parameter. (see “XD_SCALE and OUT_SCALE” on page 294) BLOCK_ERR reads POWERUP BLOCK_ERR reads BAD INPUT OUT parameter status reads UNCERTAIN and substatus reads EngUnitRangViolation Mode will not leave OOS No BLOCK_ERR but readings are not correct. If using Indirect mode, scaling could be wrong Out_ScaleEU_0 and EU_100 settings are incorrect. Target mode not set Configuration error Resource block Schedule Process and/or block alarms will not work Features Notification Status Options Value of output does not make sense Linearization Type Scaling Cannot set HI_LIMIT, HI_HI_LIMIT, LO_LIMIT, or LO_LO_LIMIT Values 166 Scaling See “XD_SCALE and OUT_SCALE” on page 294. Set target mode to something other than OOS. BLOCK_ERR will show the configuration error bit set. The following are parameters that must be set before the block is allowed out of OOS: CHANNEL must be set to a valid value and cannot be left at initial value of 0. XD_SCALE.UNITS_INDX must match the units in the transducer block channel value. L_TYPE must be set to Direct, Indirect, or Indirect Square Root and cannot be left at initial value of 0. The actual mode of the Resource block is OOS. See Resource Block Diagnostics for corrective action. Block is not scheduled and therefore cannot execute to go to Target Mode. Schedule the block to execute. FEATURES_SEL does not have Alerts enabled. Enable the Alerts bit. LIM_NOTIFY is not high enough. Set equal to MAX_NOTIFY. STATUS_OPTS has Propagate Fault Forward bit set. This should be cleared to cause an alarm to occur. L_TYPE must be set to Direct, Indirect, or Indirect Square Root and cannot be left at the initial value of 0. Scaling parameters are set incorrectly: XD_SCALE.EU0 and EU100 should match that of the transducer block channel value. OUT_SCALE.EU0 and EU100 are not set properly. Limit values are outside the OUT_SCALE.EU0 and OUT_SCALE.EU100 values. Change OUT_SCALE or set values within range. Service and Troubleshooting Reference Manual Section 8: Safety Instrumented Systems (4-20 mA Only) 00809-0100-4026, Rev HA Section 8 November 2014 Safety Instrumented Systems (4-20 mA Only) Safety messages . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Overview . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Functional specifications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Configuration . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Operation and maintenance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . References . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Spare parts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Terms and definitions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8.1 page 167 page 168 page 169 page 169 page 171 page 172 page 174 page 174 page 174 Safety messages Procedures and instructions in this section may require special precautions to ensure the safety of the personnel performing the operations. Information that raises potential safety issues is indicated by a warning symbol ( ). Refer to the following safety messages before performing an operation preceded by this symbol. Failure to follow these installation guidelines could result in death or serious injury. Make sure only qualified personnel perform the installation. Use the equipment only as specified in this manual. Failure to do so may impair the protection provided by the equipment. Explosions could result in death or serious injury. Verify that the operating environment of the transmitter is consistent with the appropriate hazardous locations specifications. Before connecting a HART®-based communicator in an explosive atmosphere, make sure the instruments in the loop are installed in accordance with intrinsically safe or non-incendive field wiring practices. Electrical shock can result in death or serious injury. Use extreme caution when making contact with the leads and terminals. Antennas with non-conducting surfaces. Antennas with non-conducting surfaces (e.g. rod antenna and process seal antenna) may generate an ignition-capable level of electrostatic charge under extreme conditions. Therefore, when the antenna is used in a potentially explosive atmosphere, appropriate measures must be taken to prevent electrostatic discharge. Safety Instrumented Systems (4-20 mA Only) 167 Reference Manual Section 8: Safety Instrumented Systems (4-20 mA Only) 00809-0100-4026, Rev HA November 2014 Any substitution of non-authorized parts or repair, other than exchanging the complete transmitter head or antenna assembly, may jeopardize safety and is prohibited. Unauthorized changes to the product are strictly prohibited as they may unintentionally and unpredictably alter performance and jeopardize safety. Unauthorized changes that interfere with the integrity of the welds or flanges, such as making additional perforations, compromise product integrity and safety. Equipment ratings and certifications are no longer valid on any products that have been damaged or modified without the prior written permission of Emerson Process Management. Any continued use of product that has been damaged or modified without the written authorization is at the customer’s sole risk and expense. 8.2 Overview The following section applies to the 4-20 mA Rosemount 5400 Series with QS Prior-Use Certificate of FMEDA data transmitter used in Safety Instrumented Systems (SIS) applications. The 5400 QS Prior Use option with analog output provides overfill and empty tank protection to improve the system safety. The transmitter is classified as a Type B device. It contains self-diagnostics and is programmed to send its output to either a high or low failure state upon internal detection of a failure. An independent third party approval of the FMEDA (detailed performance assessment) was conducted by SP (Technical Research Institute of Sweden) according to IEC 61508:2010. The FMEDA is performed to determine failure rates, calculate the Safe Failure Fraction (SFF), and the average Probability of Failure on Demand (PFDAVG). The hardware assessment is one of the steps taken to achieve functional safety per IEC 61508 / IEC 61511. It provides the failure rate data suitable for prior-use assessment. Note Refer to the Rosemount 5400 Series FMEDA(1) report for failure rate data, additional details, and assumptions regarding the failure rate analysis. 8.2.1 Applicable models Table 8-1 lists the versions of the Rosemount 5400 Series transmitter that have been considered for the hardware assessment, to which this section applies. Table 8-1. Rosemount 5400 Series QS Option Model Codes QS option model codes Model 5401xHxxxxxxxxxxxxQS(1) Model 5402xHxxxxxxxxxxxxQS(1) (1) Not available with option code C4 or C8. To identify a 5400 QS Prior Use transmitter, verify the option code QS in the model code, on the label affixed to the outside of the transmitter head. (1) 168 The Rosemount 5400 Series FMEDA report is accessible at www.emersonprocess.com/rosemount/safety/PriorUse.htm. Safety Instrumented Systems (4-20 mA Only) Reference Manual Section 8: Safety Instrumented Systems (4-20 mA Only) 00809-0100-4026, Rev HA 8.2.2 November 2014 Skill level of personnel It is assumed that the personnel installing, configuring, and operating the system have the knowledge equal or greater than that of a qualified Instrument Technician familiar with safety-related systems, process control applications, and general instrument use. Note The Rosemount 5400 Series transmitter is not safety-rated during maintenance work, configuration changes, multidrop, loop test, or other activity that affects the Safety Function. Alternative means should be used to ensure process safety during such activities. 8.3 Functional specifications The Safety Function is based on the analog output 4-20 mA, used as the safety variable. It is configured to activate the alarm function if an error occurs or if the measured value goes beyond the measurement range set by the user. In the case of the Rosemount 5400 Series, the definition of the Safe State Safety Function is: The distance measurement is performed as intended inside the safety accuracy limits, that is with a deviation of < ±2 % of the measuring range. The safety analog output signal is set outside the normal 4-20 mA range (Low or High Alarm). The Rosemount standard alarm setting is: < 3.75 mA or > 21.75 mA. Only the 4-20 mA output can be used in the Safety Function. The HART protocol can only be used for setup, calibration, and diagnostic purposes, not for safety critical operation. The measurement signal used by the logic solver must be the analog 4-20 mA signal proportional to the level generated. 8.4 Installation The device should be installed and configured as a level sensing device per manufacturer’s instructions. The materials must be compatible with process conditions and process fluids. No special installation is required in addition to what is described in this section, the standard installation practices outlined in Section 3: Mechanical Installation, and the Rosemount 5400 Series Quick Start Guide (Document No. 00825-0100-4026). Environmental limits are available in Appendix A: Reference Data. Note False echoes within the radar beam from obstructions may lead to a situation where the Rosemount 5400 Series can no longer be used for safety related functions with the listed failure rates, SFF, and PFDAVG. However, reduced proof test intervals can help to detect such unwanted causes. The loop must be designed so the terminal voltage does not drop below the minimum input voltage, see values in Table 8-2, when the transmitter output is 21.75 mA. The input voltage Ui for HART is 16-42.4 Vdc (16-30 Vdc in IS applications, and 20-42.4 Vdc in Explosion-proof / Flameproof applications). Safety Instrumented Systems (4-20 mA Only) 169 Reference Manual Section 8: Safety Instrumented Systems (4-20 mA Only) 00809-0100-4026, Rev HA November 2014 The HART loop must be referenced to ground in one point located between the power supply and the load resistor. Either the negative or the positive pole of the power supply can be ground referenced, depending on the placement of the load resistor. See Figure 8-1 as an example. Figure 8-1. Reference Ground when the Load Resistor is Inserted in the Negative Line Rosemount 5400 Series transmitter Power supply Load resistor Single point loop ground reference Transmitter housing ground Table 8-2. Minimum Input Voltage (Ui) at Different Currents Current Hazardous approval 3.75 mA 21.75 mA Minimum input voltage (Ui) Non-hazardous Installations and intrinsically safe installations Explosion-proof / flameproof installations 170 16 Vdc 11 Vdc 20 Vdc 15.5 Vdc Safety Instrumented Systems (4-20 mA Only) Reference Manual Section 8: Safety Instrumented Systems (4-20 mA Only) 00809-0100-4026, Rev HA 8.5 November 2014 Configuration Use a HART-compliant master, such as RRM or a Field Communicator, to communicate with and verify configuration of the Rosemount 5400 Series. A full review of configuration methods is available in Section 5: Basic Configuration/Start-up. These instructions are applicable to the 5400 QS option with any differences noted. It is not recommended to use any advanced configuration that is described in Appendix C: Advanced Configuration. If advanced configuration is required, consult your local Emerson Process Management representative for guidance. 8.5.1 Damping User adjusted damping will affect the transmitter’s ability to respond to process changes. Therefore, the damping values + response time should not exceed the Safety loop requirements. 8.5.2 Alarm and saturation levels DCS or safety logic solver should be configured to handle both High alarm and Low alarm. It is also required that the transmitter is configured for High or Low alarm. Table 8-3 identifies the alarm levels available and their operation values(1). Table 8-3. Alarm Levels Rosemount alarm level Normal operation 3.75 mA(1) 4 mA 20 mA 3.9 mA low saturation 21.75 mA(2) 20.8 mA high saturation (1) Transmitter Failure, hardware or software alarm in Low position. (2) Transmitter Failure, hardware or software alarm in High position. For instructions on alarm level settings, see “Analog output (HART)” on page 81. Note Only the High or Low Alarm Mode can be used for the Safety Function. Do not choose Freeze Current as an error will not be announced in the current loop. Note Alarm Limits should be set with a sufficient margin to Near Zone and Hold Off, or both. See “Near zone distance” on page 193 and “Hold off setting” on page 250 for more information. (1) In certain cases, the transmitter does not go into the user defined alarm state. For example, in case of a short circuit, the transmitter goes into High Alarm state even if Low Alarm has been configured. Safety Instrumented Systems (4-20 mA Only) 171 Reference Manual Section 8: Safety Instrumented Systems (4-20 mA Only) 00809-0100-4026, Rev HA November 2014 8.5.3 Amplitude threshold For amplitude thresholds, verify that: the Amplitude Threshold is at least 50 % greater than the amplitude of disturbances. For example, if the amplitude of disturbance is 1000 mV, the Amplitude Threshold should be at least 1500 mV. the Amplitude Threshold has an amplitude of at least 100 mV the Amplitude Threshold is set to 20-50 % of the signal amplitude of the product surface Amplitude Thresholds should be verified with the measured product in the tank. It is not recommended to register any false echo areas. For more information on Amplitude Thresholds, see “Echo tuning” on page 83, “ATC” on page 84, and “Analyzing the measurement signal” on page 132. 8.5.4 Write protection A Rosemount 5400 Series transmitter can be protected from unintentional configuration changes by a password protected function. It is recommended to use write protection described in “Write protecting a transmitter” on page 152. 8.5.5 Site acceptance After the installation and configuration, proper operation of the transmitter should be verified. A site acceptance test is therefore recommended. The proof test outlined in this section can be used for this. Note that re-verification of the transmitter operation is recommended if the configuration is changed. 8.6 Operation and maintenance 8.6.1 General The Rosemount 5400 Series QS option must be tested at regular intervals to confirm that the overfill and empty tank protection function result in the desired system response. The required proof test intervals are dependent on the configuration of the transmitter and the process environment. It is the responsibility of the operator/owner of the system to determine the sufficient time interval and verify it is followed. See the FMEDA(1) report for additional details or references. If the overfill and empty tank protection function cannot be tested by a controlled filling to the response height, suitable simulation of the level must be used to make the level sensor respond. The following proof test is recommended. If an error is found in the safety functionality, the measuring system must be switched out of service and the process held in a safe state by means of other measures. Proof test results and corrective actions taken must be documented at www.emersonprocess.com/rosemount/safety. (1) 172 The Rosemount 5400 Series FMEDA report is accessible at www.emersonprocess.com/rosemount/safety/PriorUse.htm. Safety Instrumented Systems (4-20 mA Only) Reference Manual Section 8: Safety Instrumented Systems (4-20 mA Only) 00809-0100-4026, Rev HA November 2014 Proof test This test detects approximately 95 % of the possible Dangerous Undetected (DU) failures of the transmitter. Note that prior to conducting the test, the echo curve should be inspected to ensure that no disturbing echoes affecting the measurement performance are present in the tank. Required Tools: HART host/communicator and mA meter. 1. Bypass the logic solver or take other appropriate actions to avoid false trip. 2. Disable write protection if the function is enabled. 3. Using Loop Test, enter the mA value representing a high alarm current output and verify that the analog current reaches that value using the mA meter. This step tests for compliance voltage problems, such as low loop power supply voltage or increased wiring resistance. 4. Using Loop Test, enter the mA value representing a low alarm current output and verify that the analog current reaches that value using the reference meter. This step tests for possible quiescent current related failures. 5. Perform a two-point calibration check of the transmitter by adjusting the product level in two points in the measuring range(1). Verify that the current output corresponds to the level input values using a known reference measurement. This step verifies that the analog output is correct in the operating range and that the Primary Variable is properly configured. 6. Enable write protection. 7. Restore the loop to full operation. 8. Remove the bypass from the safety logic solver or otherwise restore normal operation. 9. Document the test result for future reference. For troubleshooting the transmitter, see Section 7: Service and Troubleshooting. 8.6.2 Inspection Visual inspection It is recommended to inspect the antenna for possible build up or clogging. Special tools Not required. Product repair The Rosemount 5400 Series is repairable by major component replacement. All failures detected by the transmitter diagnostics or by the proof test must be reported. Feedback can be submitted electronically at www.emersonprocess.com/rosemount/safety (Contact Us). (1) For best performance, use the 4-20 mA range points as calibration points. Safety Instrumented Systems (4-20 mA Only) 173 Reference Manual Section 8: Safety Instrumented Systems (4-20 mA Only) 00809-0100-4026, Rev HA November 2014 8.7 References 8.7.1 Specifications The Rosemount 5400 Series must be operated in accordance with the functional and performance specifications provided in Appendix A: Reference Data. 8.7.2 Failure rate data The FMEDA report includes failure rates and common cause Beta factor estimates. The full report is accessible at www.emersonprocess.com/rosemount/safety/PriorUse.htm. 8.7.3 Useful lifetime The established failure rates of electrical components apply within the useful lifetime, which should be based on experience. According to IEC 61508-2, 7.4.7.4, note 3, the useful lifetime often lies within a range of 8 to 12 years for transmitters. 8.8 Spare parts Additional spare parts are available in Appendix A: Reference Data. 8.9 Terms and definitions FMEDA Failure Modes, Effects and Diagnostic Analysis HART Highway Addressable Remote Transducer PFDAVG Average Probability of Failure on Demand SFF Safe Failure Fraction SIF Safety Instrumented Function SIL Safety Integrity Level, discrete level (one out of a possible four) for specifying the safety integrity requirements of the safety functions to be allocated to the E/E/PE safety-related systems, where Safety Integrity Level 4 has the highest level of safety integrity, and Safety Integrity Level 1 has the lowest. 174 Safety Instrumented Systems (4-20 mA Only) Reference Manual Section 8: Safety Instrumented Systems (4-20 mA Only) 00809-0100-4026, Rev HA November 2014 SIS Safety Instrumented System – Implementation of one or more Safety Instrumented Functions. A SIS is composed of any combination of sensor(s), logic solver(s), and final element(s). Type B device Complex device (using microcontrollers or programmable logic) Safety Instrumented Systems (4-20 mA Only) 175 Section 8: Safety Instrumented Systems (4-20 mA Only) November 2014 176 Reference Manual 00809-0100-4026, Rev HA Safety Instrumented Systems (4-20 mA Only) Reference Manual Appendix A: Reference data 00809-0100-4026, Rev HA November 2014 Appendix A Reference Data Functional specifications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Performance specifications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Physical specifications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Dimensional drawings and mechanical properties . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Ordering information . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . A.1 Functional specifications A.1.1 General page 177 page 189 page 195 page 200 page 206 Field of liquid application Ideal for liquids and slurries in tanks, vessels, containers, reactor vessels, and underground tanks. Applications with sticky, viscous, corrosive, condensing, and crystallizing product. Model 5402, best choice for a broad range of applications and suitable for mounting in valves and bridles/stilling wells Model 5401, suitable for some extreme process conditions such as condensing vapors, product build-up, and heavy turbulence Field of solids application Model 5402 with 4 inch cone antenna for a broad range of solids applications. Measurement principle Pulsed, free propagating radar. Low frequency (model 5401, 6 GHz) and high frequency (model 5402, 26 GHz). (see “Theory of operation” on page 7 for details) Microwave output power < 1 mW Internal power consumption < 50 mW in normal operation Humidity 0 - 100% relative humidity, non-condensing Start-up time < 40 s Reference Data 177 Reference Manual Appendix A: Reference data 00809-0100-4026, Rev HA November 2014 A.1.2 4-20 mA HART® (output option code H) Output Two-wire 4–20 mA, HART Revision 5. Digital process variable is superimposed on 4–20 mA signal, and available to any host that conforms to the HART protocol. The HART signal can be used in a multidrop mode. Figure A-1. 4-20 mA HART 3 x 4-20 mA Display (option) Rosemount 5400 Series transmitter Rosemount 333 HART Tri-Loop™ 4-20 mA with HART HART modem Host / DCS system (e.g. DeltaV™) PC with Rosemount Radar Master or AMS Suite Field Communicator Signal wiring Recommended output cabling is twisted shielded pairs, 18-12 AWG HART Tri-Loop By sending the digital HART signal to the optional HART Tri-Loop, it is possible to have up to three additional 4–20 mA analog signals. See the Rosemount 333 HART Tri-Loop Product Data Sheet (document number 00813-0100-4754) for additional information. Figure A-2. Rosemount 333 HART Tri-Loop 178 Reference Data Reference Manual Appendix A: Reference data 00809-0100-4026, Rev HA November 2014 Smart Wireless THUM™ Adapter The optional Smart Wireless THUM adapter can be mounted directly on the transmitter or by using a remote mounting kit. IEC 62591 (WirelessHART®) enables access to multi-variable data and diagnostics, and adds wireless to almost any measurement point. See the Rosemount Smart Wireless THUM Adapter Product Data Sheet (document number 00813-0100-4075) and Smart Wireless THUM Adapter for Rosemount Process Level Transmitter Applications (document number 00840-0100-4026). Figure A-3. Smart Wireless THUM Adapter External power supply The input voltage UI for HART is 16-42.4 Vdc (16-30 Vdc in IS applications, and 20-42.4 Vdc in Explosion-proof / flameproof applications). Figure A-4. External Power Supply UE R = Load Resistance (:) UE = External Power Supply Voltage (Vdc) UI = Input Voltage (Vdc) UI IS Electrical parameters See “Product Certifications” on page 217. Signal on alarm (configurable) Reference Data High = 21.75 mA (standard Rosemount setting) Low = 3.75 mA (option code C8) Namur NE43: High = 22.5 mA (option code C4) 179 Reference Manual Appendix A: Reference data 00809-0100-4026, Rev HA November 2014 Saturation levels Standard: Low=3.9 mA, High=20.8 mA Namur NE43: Low = 3.8 mA, High = 20.5 mA Figure A-5. Alarm Levels Rosemount alarm level Normal operation 3.75 mA(1) 4 mA 20 mA 3.9 mA low saturation 21.75 mA(2) 20.8 mA high saturation (1) Transmitter Failure, hardware or software alarm in Low position. (2) Transmitter Failure, hardware or software alarm in High position. Load limitations Maximum load resistance (R) is determined by the voltage level of the external power supply (UE), as described by Figure A-6 to Figure A-8: Figure A-6. Non-Hazardous Installations Maximum Load Resistance R(:) 1400 1387 1200 1000 800 600 Operating region 586 400 200 24 10 16 20 42.4 30 40 50 External Power Supply Voltage UE(V) Figure A-7. Intrinsically Safe Installations Maximum Load Resistance R(:) 1400 1200 1000 800 847 600 586 Operating region 400 200 24 10 180 16 20 30 40 50 External Power Supply Voltage UE(V) Reference Data Reference Manual Appendix A: Reference data 00809-0100-4026, Rev HA November 2014 Figure A-8. Explosion-Proof/Flameproof Installations Maximum Load Resistance R(:) 1400 1200 1148 1000 800 600 400 Operating region 348 200 24 10 20 42.4 40 30 50 External Power Supply Voltage UE(V) Note The diagram is only valid if the HART load resistance is at the + side and if the - side is grounded, otherwise the load resistance value is limited to 435 :. A.1.3 FOUNDATION™ fieldbus (output option code F) Output Figure A-9. FOUNDATION fieldbus System Architecture Host / DCS system (e.g. DeltaV) Maintenance H2 - High Speed Field Bus H1 - Low Speed Field Bus 6200 ft (1900 m) max (depending upon cable characteristics) Field Communicator Rosemount 752 Field Signal Indicator Rosemount 5401 Fieldbus modem Rosemount 5601 Rosemount 5301 PC with Rosemount Radar Master Signal wiring Recommended output cabling is twisted shielded pairs, 18-12 AWG Reference Data 181 Reference Manual Appendix A: Reference data 00809-0100-4026, Rev HA November 2014 External power supply The input voltage UI for FOUNDATION fieldbus is 9-32 Vdc (9-30 Vdc in IS applications, 9-17.5 Vdc in FISCO applications, and 16-32 Vdc in Explosion-proof / flameproof applications). Quiescent current draw 21 mA FOUNDATION fieldbus blocks Resource block, 3 transducer blocks, 6 Analog Input (AI) blocks, Proportional /Integral/Derivate (PID) block, Input Selector (ISEL) block, Signal Characterizer (SGCR) block, Arithmetic (ARTH) block, and Output Splitter (OS) block FOUNDATION fieldbus class (Basic or Link Master) Link Master (LAS) FOUNDATION fieldbus block execution time AI-block: 30 ms PID-block: 40 ms ARTH-, ISEL-, OSPL-block: 65 ms CHAR-block: 75 ms Conforming FOUNDATION fieldbus ITK 4.6.1 FOUNDATION fieldbus PlantWeb® Alert Support Yes Rosemount 2410 Tank Hub connectivity (output option code U) Output The 5400 Level Transmitter communicates with the 2410 Tank Hub via a daisy-chain connection. The 2410 Tank Hub supports auto-configuration of the FOUNDATION fieldbus based Tankbus. The hub identifies and auto-addresses the different field devices in the network, manages communication, and supervises the status of all connected devices. 182 Primary fieldbus: Rosemount 2410 communicates with a host or a field communication unit via TRL2 Modbus®, RS485 Modbus, Enraf or HART Secondary fieldbus: TRL2 Modbus, Enraf, IEC 62591 (WirelessHART) Reference Data Reference Manual Appendix A: Reference data 00809-0100-4026, Rev HA November 2014 Figure A-10. Rosemount 2410 Tank Hub Connectivity Rosemount 5400 Level Transmitter TankMaster Rosemount 2410 Tank Hub Field Communication Unit Rosemount 2230 Display Primary bus Tankbus Secondary bus (IS) Secondary bus (Non-IS) Relay Outputs Rosemount 644 Temperature Transmitter with sensor Rosemount 2180 Field Bus Modem Signal wiring Recommended output cabling is twisted shielded pairs, 18-12 AWG (cable characteristics specified for FISCO according to IEC 60079-27). Power supply The 5400 Level Transmitter and other connected devices are powered by the 2410 Tank Hub. A.1.4 RS-485 with Modbus communication (output option code M) Output The RS-485 Modbus version communicates by Modbus RTU, Modbus ASCII, and Level Master Protocols. Data Bits: 8 data bits, 1 start bit, 1 or 2 stop bits, and software configured parity Baud Rate: 1200, 2400, 4800, 9600 (default), and 19200 bits/s Address range: 1 to 255 (default device address is 246) HART communication is used for configuration via HART terminals, or tunneling via the RS-485. Reference Data 183 Reference Manual Appendix A: Reference data 00809-0100-4026, Rev HA November 2014 Figure A-11. RS-485 with Modbus Communication Rosemount 5400 Series Transmitter Power Modbus, Levelmaster Emulation / RS-485 Control system HART modem RS-232 / RS-485 converter 475 Field Communicator PC 5400 Setup in Rosemount Radar Master via Tunneling PC 5400 Setup in Rosemount Radar Master External power supply The input voltage Ui for Modbus is 8-30 Vdc (max. rating). Power consumption: < 0.5 W (with HART address = 1) < 1.2 W (incl. four HART slaves) Figure A-12. Field Wiring Connections 120: If it is the last transmitter on the bus, connect the 120 :termination resistor verter HART to Modbus Converter MB MB MODBUS (RS-485) HART HART + MODBUS MA (RS-485) POWER MA Ambients > 60 ºC HART Use wiring rated for min 90 ºC Power supply 120: 120: RS-485 Bus 184 Reference Data Reference Manual 00809-0100-4026, Rev HA Appendix A: Reference data November 2014 Signal wiring Two-wire half duplex RS-485 Modbus. Use shielded twisted pair wiring, preferably with an impedance of 120 : (typically 24 AWG), in order to comply with EIA-485 standard and EMC regulations. Ground (common mode) voltage limit ±7V Bus termination Standard RS-485 bus termination per EIA-485 A.1.5 Display and configuration Integral display (option code M1) 5-digit integral display. The process variables listed in “Output variables” on page 186 can be presented. If more than one variable is chosen, carousel toggling of data is used. The display also shows diagnostics and error information. Remote display Data can be read remotely by using the Rosemount 751 Field Signal Indicator (see Product Data Sheet, document number 00813-0100-4378) for 4-20 mA / HART, or Rosemount 752 Remote Indicator for FOUNDATION fieldbus (see Product Data Sheet, document number 00813-0100-4377). Configuration tools Emerson Field Communicator (e.g. 375/475 Field Communicator), Rosemount Radar Master (RRM) software package (included with delivery of transmitter), Emerson AMS® Device Manager or any other EDDL or enhanced-EDDL host, or DeltaV™ or any other DD (Device Description) compatible host systems. Certificates are available from all major host system vendors. Note DTM (compliant with version 1.2 of the FDT®/DTM™ specification) supporting configuration in for instance Yokogawa Fieldmate/PRM, E+H™ FieldCare, and PACTware™. Note To communicate using RRM or AMS Device Manager, a HART modem is required. The HART modem is available as an RS232 or USB version (see Table A-12 on page 215). Note The transmitter can be pre-configured by selecting option code C1 (see page 209), and sending a complete Configuration Data Sheet (CDS). The CDS is available from www.rosemount.com. Reference Data 185 Appendix A: Reference data Reference Manual 00809-0100-4026, Rev HA November 2014 Output units Level and distance: ft, in., m, cm, or mm Volume: ft3, in.3, US gals, Imp gals, barrels, yd3, m3, or liters Level rate: ft/s, m/s Temperature: °F, °C Output variables Level, distance, volume, level rate, signal strength, surface/noise margin, internal temperature, analog output current (not applicable for FOUNDATION fieldbus) and % of range (not applicable for FOUNDATION fieldbus) Damping 0-60 s (2 s, default value) A.1.6 Diagnostics General Invalid measurement alerts, configuration error alerts, advanced full/empty tank diagnostics, hardware/software failures, electronic temperature, online status report (advisory/warnings/errors), signal quality and signal strength monitoring Diagnostics Suite (option code D01 or DA1) Signal Quality Metrics - Diagnostics package that monitors the relations between surface, noise and threshold. The function can be used to detect abnormal conditions in the process such as antenna contamination or sudden loss of signal strength. Signal Quality Metrics parameters are available as Output Variables in Rosemount Radar Master, and can be sent to Distributed Control System (DCS) to trigger an alarm. 186 Reference Data Reference Manual Appendix A: Reference data 00809-0100-4026, Rev HA A.1.7 November 2014 Temperature and pressure limits Ambient temperature Verify that the operating atmosphere of the transmitter is consistent with the appropriate hazardous locations certifications, see Table A-1. Table A-1. Ambient Temperature Ambient temperature IS/Ex ia XP/Ex d Non-hazardous HART communication -58 °F to 158 °F (-50 °C to 70 °C) -40 °F to 158 °F (-40 °C to 70 °C) -40 °F to 176 °F (-40 °C to 80 °C) FOUNDATION fieldbus -58 °F to 140 °F (-50 °C to 60 °C) -40 °F to 140 °F (-40 °C to 60 °C) -40 °F to 176 °F (-40 °C to 80 °C) FISCO -58 °F to 140 °F (-50 °C to 60 °C) N/A -40 °F to 176 °F (-40 °C to 80 °C) N/A -40 °F to 158 °F (-40 °C to 70 °C) -40 °F to 176 °F (-40 °C to 80 °C) Modbus communication LCD display readable in: -4 °F to 158 °F (-20 °C to 70 °C) Storage temperature -58 °F to 194 °F (-50 °C to 90 °C) LCD display: -40 °F to 185 °F (-40 °C to 85 °C) Process temperature and pressure The final rating depends on the antenna, the tank seal, and O-rings (if applicable). See Table A-2 on page 189. Figure A-13. Rosemount 5402 and 5401 with SST Cone Antenna (Model Code: 2S-8S), Rosemount 5402 and 5401 with Protective Plate Cone Antenna (Model Code: 2H-8H, 2M-8M, and 2N-8N) Pressure psig (bar) 232 (16) Cone Antennas Operating range The final rating may be limited by flange and O-ring selection. -14 (-1) -40 (-40) Reference Data 302 (150) Flange temperature °F (°C) 187 Reference Manual Appendix A: Reference data 00809-0100-4026, Rev HA November 2014 Figure A-14. Rosemount 5401 with Rod Antenna (Model Code: 1R-4R) Pressure psig (bar) Rod Antennas 145 (10) Operating range The final rating may be limited by flange and O-ring selection. -14 (-1) -40 (-40) 302 (150) Flange temperature °F (°C) Figure A-15. Rosemount 5402 with Process Seal Antenna (Model Code: 2P-4P) Pressure psig (bar) 120 (8.2) Process Seal Antennas 90 (6.2) Operating range The final rating may be limited by flange and O-ring selection. 10 (0.69) -14 (-1) -4 (-20) 104 (40) 212 (100) 302 (150) Flange temperature °F (°C) ASME/ANSI Flange rating 316L SST flanges according to ASME B16.5 Table 2-2.3 EN Flange rating 1.4404 according to EN 1092-1 material group 13E0 JIS Flange rating 316L SST according to JIS B2220 material group 2.3 188 Reference Data Reference Manual Appendix A: Reference data 00809-0100-4026, Rev HA November 2014 Flange connection rating See Table A-3 for the conditions used for flange strength calculations. Table A-2. Temperature Restrictions due to O-ring Selection (Not Applicable for 1R-2R or 2P-4P Where no Process O-ring is Present) Tank seal with different O-ring materials(1) Min. temperature °F (°C) in air Max. temperature °F (°C) in air Viton® Fluoroelastomer -4 (-20) 302 (150) Ethylene Propylene (EPDM) -40 (-40) 302 (150) Kalrez® 6375 Perfluoroelastomer 5 (-15) 302 (150) Nitrile Butadiene (NBR) -40 (-40) 230 (110) (1) Always check the chemical compatibility of the O-ring material with your application. Table A-3. Conditions Used for Flange Strength Calculations Bolting material Gasket Flange material ASME / ANSI SST SA193 B8M Class 2 Soft (1a) with min. thickness 1.6 mm SA/A182 316L EN, JIS EN 1515-1/-2 group 13E0, A4-70 Soft (EN 1514-1) with min. thickness 1.6 mm EN 10222-5-1.4404 A.2 Performance specifications A.2.1 General Reference conditions Ideal metal plate with no disturbing objects. Temperature: + 68 °F (20 °C) Pressure: 14-15 psi (960-1060 mbar) Humidity: 25-75% RH Instrument accuracy at reference conditions 5402: ± 0.1 in. (± 3 mm) 5401: ± 0.4 in. (± 10 mm Repeatability ± 0.04 in. (± 1 mm) at 16.4 ft (5 m) distance Resolution 0.04 in. (1 mm) Reference Data 189 Reference Manual Appendix A: Reference data 00809-0100-4026, Rev HA November 2014 Ambient temperature effect 0.05%/10 K in temperature range -40 °F to 176 °F (-40 °C to 80 °C) Update interval 1 second A.2.2 Measuring range Measuring range and minimum dielectric constant Maximum measuring range from flange: 115 ft (35 m) The measuring range depends on: Microwave frequency Antenna size The dielectric constant (Hr) of the liquid (min. Hr=1.4) Process conditions See Table A-4 and Table A-5 for measuring range and minimum dielectric constant. Due to the measuring range depending on the application and factors described below, the values are a guideline for clean liquids. For more information, ask your local Emerson Process Management representative. Table A-4. Rosemount 5402, Maximum Recommended Measuring Range, ft (m) High frequency antennas Dielectric constant(1) 2-in. Cone / Process Seal 33 (10) 49 (15) 66 (20) 82 (25) 115 (35) 115 (35) 9.8 (3) 20 (6) 33 (10) 3-in. Cone / Process Seal 49 (15) 66 (20) 98 (30) 82 (25) 115 (35) 115 (35) 13 (4) 30 (9) 39 (12) 4-in. Cone / Process Seal 66 (20) 82 (25) 115 (35) 82 (25) 115 (35) 115 (35) 23 (7) 39 (12) 49 (15) (1) A. Oil, gasoline or other hydrocarbons, and petrochemicals (Hr=1.9-4.0) In pipes or with ideal surface conditions, for some liquefied gases (Hr=1.4-4.0) B. Alcohols, concentrated acids, organic solvents, oil/water mixtures, and acetone (Hr=4.0-10.0) C. Conductive liquids, e.g. water based solutions, dilute acids, and alkalis (Hr>10.0) 190 Reference Data Reference Manual Appendix A: Reference data 00809-0100-4026, Rev HA November 2014 Table A-5. Rosemount 5401, Maximum Recommended Measuring Range, ft (m) Low frequency antennas Dielectric constant(1) N/A N/A N/A 82 (25) 115 (35) 115 (35) N/A N/A N/A 4-in. cone / rod(3) 23 (7) 39 (12) 49 (15) 82 (25) 115 (35) 115 (35) 13 (4) 26 (8) 39 (12) 6-in. Cone 43 (13) 66 (20) 82 (25) 82 (25) 115 (35) 115 (35) 20 (6) 33 (10) 46 (14) 8-in. Cone 66 (20) 82 (25) 115 (35) 82 (25) 115 (35) 115 (35) 26 (8) 39 (12) 52 (16) 3-in. Cone(2) (1) A. Oil, gasoline or other hydrocarbons, and petrochemicals (Hr=1.9-4.0) In pipes or with ideal surface conditions, for some liquefied gases (Hr=1.4-4.0) B. Alcohols, concentrated acids, organic solvents, oil/water mixtures, and acetone (Hr=4.0-10.0) C. Conductive liquids, e.g. water based solutions, dilute acids, and alkalis (Hr>10.0) (2) Pipe installations only. N/A=not applicable. (3) Pipe installations are not allowed with rod antennas. A.2.3 Beam angle and beam width Figure A-16. Beam Angle and Beam Width 5402 (high frequency) 5401 (low frequency) Distance 16 ft (5 m) Beam angle Beam angle 33 ft (10 m) 49 ft (15 m) 66 ft (20 m) Beam width For a comparison between the beam angle and beam width for the Rosemount 5401 (~6 GHz) and 5402 (~26 GHz) transmitters with antennas of the same size and type, see Table A-6, Table A-7, and Table A-8. Reference Data 191 Reference Manual Appendix A: Reference data 00809-0100-4026, Rev HA November 2014 Table A-6. Beam Angle for the Rosemount 5400 Series Antenna size Beam angle 5402 Beam angle 5401 2-in. Cone / Process Seal(1) 19° N/A 14° (pipe only) 4-in. Cone / Process Seal , Rod 9° 37° 6-in. Cone N/A 23° 8-in. Cone N/A 17° 3-in. Cone / Process Seal(1) (1) (2) (1) Only with Rosemount 5402. (2) Only with Rosemount 5401. Table A-7. Beam Width at Different Distances from Flange for 5402 Distance Antenna 2-in. Cone/Process seal 3-in. Cone/Process seal 4-in. Cone/Process seal 16 ft (5 m) 4.9 ft (1.5 m) 3.3 ft (1.0 m) 3.3 ft (1.0 m) 33 ft (10 m) 9.8 ft (3.0 m) 6.6 ft (2.0 m) 4.9 ft (1.5 m) 49 ft (15 m) 14.8 ft (4.5 m) 9.8 ft (3.0 m) 8.2 ft (2.5 m) 66 ft (20 m) 19.7 ft (6.0 m) 13.1 ft (4.0 m) 9.8 ft (3.0 m) Table A-8. Beam Width at Different Distances from Flange for 5401 Distance Antenna 4-in. Cone/Rod 6-in. Cone 8-in. Cone 16 ft (5 m) 11.5 ft (3.5 m) 6.6 ft (2.0 m) 4.9 ft (1.5 m) 33 ft (10 m) 23.0 ft (7.0 m) 13.1 ft (4.0 m) 9.8 ft (3.0 m) 49 ft (15 m) 32.8 ft (10 m) 19.7 ft (6.0 m) 14.8 ft (4.5 m) 66 ft (20 m) 42.7 ft (13 m) 26.2 ft (8.0 m) 19.7 ft (6.0 m) Max level rate 1.6 in./s (40 mm/s) as default, adjustable to 7.1 in./s (180 mm/s) 192 Reference Data Reference Manual Appendix A: Reference data 00809-0100-4026, Rev HA A.2.4 November 2014 Transition zone and near zone Transition zones are areas where measurements are not recommended. Near zones are areas where the accuracy is reduced. Figure A-17. Transition Zone and Near Zone Transition zone Near zone Transition zone 6 in. (150 mm) from lower end of the antenna Near zone distance 1.3 ft (0.4 m) from lower end of the antenna Near zone accuracy Reference Data 5402: ± 0.6 in. (± 15 mm) 5401: ± 1.2 in. (± 30 mm) 193 Appendix A: Reference data A.2.5 Reference Manual 00809-0100-4026, Rev HA November 2014 Environment Vibration resistance(1) Aluminum housing: IEC 60770-1 Level 1 SST housing: IACS E10 Electromagnetic compatibility(1) Emission and immunity: EMC directive 204/108/EC. EN 61326-1:2006(2). NAMUR recommendations NE21(2). Transient / built-in lightning protection IEC 61000-4-5:2001 T1 option: C62.41.2-2002 (IEEE), C37.90.1 (IEEE) Pressure Equipment Directive (PED) Complies with 97/23/EC article 3.3 Radio approvals(3)(4) FCC part 15C (1998)(5), R&TTE (EU directive 99/5/EC), and IC (RSS210-5) (1) (2) (3) (4) (5) 194 The device may also comply with other standards. Consult your local Emerson Process Management representative. Additional deviations at strong electromagnetic fields (NAMUR NE21) at specific frequencies are less than ± 1.6 in. (40 mm). Only a limited selection is presented. Contact your local Emerson Process Management representative for more information. For Japan: “Install device on tanks or pipes made of metal”. For 5402: “This device is authorized for use in tank-mounted applications, including metal tanks as well as concrete, plastic, glass, and other non-conductive tanks.” No specific restrictions are stated for the 5401. Reference Data Reference Manual Appendix A: Reference data 00809-0100-4026, Rev HA November 2014 A.3 Physical specifications A.3.1 Material selection Emerson provides a variety of Rosemount product with various product options and configurations including materials of construction that can be expected to perform well in a wide range of applications. The Rosemount product information presented is intended as a guide for the purchaser to make an appropriate selection for the application. It is the purchaser’s sole responsibility to make a careful analysis of all process parameters (such as all chemical components, temperature, pressure, flow rate, abrasives, contaminants, etc.), when specifying product, materials, options and components for the particular application. Emerson Process Management is not in a position to evaluate or guarantee the compatibility of the process fluid or other process parameters with the product, options, configuration or materials of construction selected. A.3.2 Housing and closure Product Rosemount 5400 Series, Non-Contacting Radar Type Dual compartment (terminal compartment and the electronics are completely separated). Two entries for conduit or cable connections. The transmitter housing can be rotated in any direction. Electrical connection ½ - 14 NPT for cable glands or conduit entries. Optional: M20 x 1.5 conduit / cable adapter, M12 4-pin male eurofast® connector or A size Mini 4-pin male minifast® connector. Recommended output cabling is twisted shielded pairs, 18-12 AWG. Housing material Polyurethane-covered Aluminum, or Stainless Steel Grade CF8M (ASTM A743) Ingress protection Type 4X, IP66, IP67 Factory sealed Yes Weight Reference Data Aluminum transmitter head: 4.4 lb (2 kg) Stainless steel transmitter head: 10.8 lb (4.9 kg) 195 Reference Manual Appendix A: Reference data 00809-0100-4026, Rev HA November 2014 A.3.3 Engineered solutions When standard model codes are not sufficient to fulfill requirements, please consult the factory to explore possible Engineered Solutions. This is typically, but not exclusively, related to the choice of wetted materials or the design of a process connection. These Engineered Solutions are part of the expanded offerings and may be subject to additional delivery lead time. For ordering, factory will supply a special R-labeled numeric option code that should be added at the end of the standard model string. See example model string below. Example Model String: 5402-A-H-1-E5-45-PV-CA-M1C1-R1234 A.3.4 Tank connection and antennas Tank connection The tank connection consists of a tank seal, a flange, Tri-Clamp™, or NPT thread. Certain models of tank connections have a tank connection design with a protective plate of the same material as the antenna. This is to prevent the 316L / EN1.4404 stainless steel flange from being exposed to the tank atmosphere. See “Dimensional drawings and mechanical properties” on page 200. Flange dimensions Follows ASME B16.5, JIS B2220, and EN 1092-1 standards. For more information, see “Standard flanges” on page 205. Antennas Cone, Process Seal, and Rod Antenna. Cone antennas can be ordered in different materials. Extended cone antennas are available in SST 316L. 5402 Cone Antenna Suitable for stilling-well/bridle installation Can be recessed in smooth nozzles Cone extensions are available Suitable for solids applications (only 4 inch cone antenna) 5402 Process Seal Antenna Ideal for small tanks and corrosive applications Suitable for applications with heavy condensation/build-up 5401 Cone Antenna Suitable for applications with heavy condensation/build-up Cone extensions are available 5401 Rod Antenna 196 Suitable for small process connections and corrosive environments Two versions: all PFA and PFA+SST Reference Data Reference Manual Appendix A: Reference data 00809-0100-4026, Rev HA November 2014 Antenna dimensions Cone antenna: See “Rosemount 5402 and 5401 with SST Cone Antenna (Model Code: 2S-8S)” on page 200 and “Rosemount 5402 and 5401 with Protective Plate Cone Antenna (Model Code: 2H-8H, 2M-8M, and 2N-8N)” on page 201. Rod antenna: See “Rosemount 5401 with Rod Antenna (Model Code: 1R-4R)” on page 202. Process Seal Antenna: See “Rosemount 5402 with Process Seal Antenna (Model Code: 2P-4P)” on page 203. Material exposed to tank atmosphere Cone Antenna 316 / 316 L SST (EN 1.4404) or Alloy 400 (UNS NO4400) or Alloy C-276 (UNS N10276). Alloy 400 and Alloy C-276 antennas have a protective plate design PTFE fluoropolymer O-ring material Rod Antenna, two versions All-PFA(1) fluoropolymer PFA(1) fluoropolymer, 316 / 316 L SST (EN 1.4404) and O-ring material Process Seal Antenna (1) PTFE fluoropolymer PFA is a fluoropolymer with properties similar to PTFE. Reference Data 197 Appendix A: Reference data Reference Manual 00809-0100-4026, Rev HA November 2014 Weight Antennas Cone Antenna (Model Code 2S-8S, 2H-8H, 2M-8M, 2N-8N): 2.2 lb (1.0 kg) Process Seal Antenna (Model Code 2P-4P): 4.4 lb (2.0 kg) Rod Antenna (Model Code 1R-4R): 2.2 lb (1.0 kg) Process connections(1) ANSI Flange, 2 in. 150 lb SST (AA): 6.6 lb (3.0 kg) EN (DIN) Flange, DN50 PN40 SST (HB): 8.8 lb (4.0 kg) JIS Flange 50A 10K SST (UA): 6.6 lb (3.0 kg) Bracket mounting (BR): 4.4 lb (2.0 kg) Thread adapter (RA): 1.1 lb (0.5 kg) Minimum clearance No clearance distance needed. (1) 198 Approximate weights for other 5400 Series process connection sizes than those in this table can be estimated: First of all, find out the weight of the SST blind flange (slip-on for Process Seal Antennas) that corresponds to the type and size shown in this table. Find out the weight for the SST blind flange that corresponds to the specific Rosemount 5400 Series flange size which is not represented in this table. The Rosemount 5400 Series flange weight can be estimated by adding the relative weight difference of these SST blind flanges. Reference Data Reference Manual Appendix A: Reference data 00809-0100-4026, Rev HA November 2014 Solids applications Rosemount 5402 Non Contacting Radar level transmitter provides industry leading measurement capabilities and reliability on solids. Characteristics include: 4 inch cone antenna (4S, 4H, 4M or 4N) Measurement accuracy: Application dependent Measurement independent of dust (may need air purging(1)) Figure A-18. Transition Zone Transition zone Note Transition zones are areas where measurements are not recommended. The transition zone for Rosemount 5402 in solids mode is 3 ft (1 m). Table A-9. Measuring Range and Dielectric Constant(2) Minimum Maximum Transition zone dielectric constant measuring range 1.5 33 ft (10 m) 2.0 66 ft (20 m) 3 ft (1 m) (1) (2) An air purging connection can prevent clogging of the antenna in extremely dusty applications, consult factory if unclear. Measuring range may be reduced by steep inclining surfaces and a combination of dust and condensation. For low dielectric constants and /or long ranges consider the Rosemount 5303 guided wave radar or the Rosemount 5708 3D solids scanner. Reference Data 199 Reference Manual Appendix A: Reference data 00809-0100-4026, Rev HA November 2014 A.4 Dimensional drawings and mechanical properties A.4.1 Rosemount 5402 and 5401 with SST Cone Antenna (Model Code: 2S-8S) All dimensions are in inches (mm). 7.1 (180) 3.5 (88) 5.2 (133) 3.6 (92) Process connection availability ● Available as standard 7.3 (185) 9.4 (240) ❍ Available as special, consult factory – Not available Antenna code s60 2S 3S, 4S, 6S, 8S 2 in./DN 50/50A ● ❍ 3 in./DN 80/80A ● ● 4 in./DN 100/100A ● ● 6 in./DN 150/150A ● ● 8 in./DN 200/200A ● ● Threaded connection Bracket mounting ● ● Process connection V° V° Optional antenna extension 5402 and 5401 Extended SST Cone(1) 5402 Standard SST Cone Cone size (in.) Antenna code Max. nozzle height Option code 6.5 (165) 2.0 (50) 2S 20 (500) 20.4 (518) S3 5.9 (150) 2.6 (67) 3S 8.8 (225) 3.6 (92) 4S 5401 Standard SST Cone (1) The extended cone antennas are available in 5-inch step increments from 10 to 50 inches. Consult your local Emerson Process Management representative for more information. Expect long lead times for other sizes than the 20 in. (500 mm) version. 5402 Extended SST Cone Cone size (in.) Antenna code Cone size (inches) V° 3.3 (84) 2.6 (67) 3S 90° 5.9 (150) 3.6 (92) 4S 90° 7.3 (185) 5.5 (140) 6S 90° 10.6 (270) 7.4 (188) 8S 5401 Extended SST Cone Cone size (inches) 200 V° 90° 135° 135° 90° Reference Data Reference Manual Appendix A: Reference data 00809-0100-4026, Rev HA A.4.2 November 2014 Rosemount 5402 and 5401 with Protective Plate Cone Antenna (Model Code: 2H-8H, 2M-8M, and 2N-8N) All dimensions are in inches (mm). 7.1 (180) 3.5 (88) 5.2 (133) 3.6 (92) 7.3 (185) 9.4 (240) s60 Protective plate 5402 Cone Antenna with Protective Plate Cone size (in.) Antenna code 5.9 (150) 2.0 (50) 2H, 2M, 2N 6.9 (175) 2.6 (67) 3H, 3M, 3N 9.8 (250) 3.6 (92) 4H, 4M, 4N 5401 Cone Antenna with Protective Plate Cone size (in.) Antenna code 3.3 (84) 2.6 (67) 3H, 3M, 3N 5.9 (150) 3.6 (92) 4H, 4M, 4N 7.3 (185) 5.5 (140) 6H, 6M, 6N 10.6 (270) 7.4 (188) 8H, 8M, 8N Process connection availability ● Available as standard ❍ Available as special, consult factory – Not available Antenna code 2H, 2M, 2N 3H, 3M, 3N 4H, 4M, 4N 6H, 6M, 6N 8H, 8M, 8N 2 in. / DN 50 / 50A ● ❍ ❍ ❍ ❍ 3 in. / DN 80 / 80A ❍ ● ❍ ❍ ❍ 4 in. / DN 100 / 100A ❍ ❍ ● ❍ ❍ 6 in. / DN 150 / 150A ❍ ❍ ❍ ● ❍ 8 in. / DN 200 / 200A ❍ ❍ ❍ ❍ ● Threaded connection Bracket Mounting Process connection Reference Data 201 Reference Manual Appendix A: Reference data 00809-0100-4026, Rev HA November 2014 A.4.3 Rosemount 5401 with Rod Antenna (Model Code: 1R-4R) 3.5 (88) All dimensions are in inches (mm). 5.2 (133) 7.1 (180) 3.6 (92) 7.3 (185) 9.4 (240) s60 Rod Antenna with protective plate (1R, 2R) Rod Antenna without protective plate (3R, 4R) Process connection availability ● Available as standard ❍ Available as special, consult factory – Not available 1.5 (38) Rod B(1) Antenna code Short 14.4 (365) 4 (100) 1R, 3R Long 20.3 (515) 10 (250) 2R, 4R (1) The active part of the antenna must protrude into the tank. B is the maximum nozzle height. Threaded connection (RA) is available for rod antennas without protective plate (3R, 4R) 202 Tri-Clamp connections (AT, BT, CT) are available for rod antennas without protective plate (3R, 4R) Antenna code Process connection 1R, 2R 3R, 4R 2 in. / DN 50 / 50A ● ● 3 in. / DN 80 / 80A ● ● 4 in. / DN 100 / 100A ● ● 6 in. / DN 150 / 150A ❍ ● 8 in. / DN 200 / 200A ❍ ● 2 in. Tri-Clamp ❍ ● 3 in. Tri-Clamp ❍ ● 4 in. Tri-Clamp ❍ ● Threaded connection ● Bracket mounting ● Reference Data Reference Manual Appendix A: Reference data 00809-0100-4026, Rev HA A.4.4 November 2014 Rosemount 5402 with Process Seal Antenna (Model Code: 2P-4P) All dimensions are in inches (mm). 7.1 (180) 3.5 (88) 5.2 (133) 3.6 (92) 7.3 (185) s60 1.1 (27) Process seal size (in.) Antenna code 1.8 (46) 14.2 (360) 0.9 (22) 2P 2.8 (72) 17.3 (440) 1.4 (35) 3P 3.8 (97) 18.9 (480) 1.9 (48) 4P Process connection availability ● Available as standard ❍ Available as special, consult factory – Not available Antenna code Process connection 2P 3P 4P 2 in. / DN 50 / 50A 3 in. / DN 80 / 80A ● ● 4 in. / DN 100 / 100A ● 6 in. / DN 150 / 150A 8 in. / DN 200 / 200A Threaded connection Bracket mounting Reference Data 203 Reference Manual Appendix A: Reference data 00809-0100-4026, Rev HA November 2014 A.4.5 Bracket mounting (Model Code: BR) Bracket mounting is available for the Rosemount 5401 and 5402 with SST Cone Antenna (2S-8S) and Rosemount 5401 with Rod Antenna (3R-4R). All dimensions are in inches (mm). Pipe diameter max 2.5 inches (64 mm) 5.2 (133) Pipe mounting (vertical pipe) Pipe mounting (horizontal pipe) 2.2 (57) 0.3 (7) 2.8 (20) 0.8 (20) Wall mounting 204 Hole pattern wall mounting Reference Data Reference Manual Appendix A: Reference data 00809-0100-4026, Rev HA A.4.6 November 2014 Process connections Standard flanges Figure A-19. Cone and Rod Antennas (Model Code: 2S-8S and 1R-4R) Designation Mating standard Face style(1) Face surface finish Material ANSI ASME B16.5 0.06 in. raised face Ra = 125-250 ì in 316 / 316L EN (DIN) EN 1092-1 2 mm raised face (Type B1) Ra = 3.2-12.5 ì m EN 1.4404 JIS JIS B2220 2 mm raised face Ra = 3.2-6.3 ì m EN 1.4404 (1) Face gasket surface is serrated per mating standard. Figure A-20. Cone Antennas with Protective Plate (Model Code: 2H-8H, 2M-8M, and 2N-8N) Designation Mating standard Face style(1) Face surface finish Material ANSI ASME B16.5 0.06 in. raised face Ra = 125-250 ì in 316 / 316L EN (DIN) EN 1092-1 Flat face (Type A) Ra = 3.2-12.5 ì m EN 1.4404 JIS JIS B2220 2 mm raised face Ra = 3.2-6.3 ì m EN 1.4404 (1) Face gasket surface is serrated per mating standard. Figure A-21. Process Seal Antennas Reference Data Designation Standard Style Material ANSI ASME B16.5 Slip-on 316 / 316L EN (DIN) EN 1092-1 Slip-on (Type 01) EN 1.4404 JIS JIS B2220 Slip-on plate (SOP) EN 1.4404 205 Reference Manual Appendix A: Reference data 00809-0100-4026, Rev HA November 2014 A.5 Ordering information Specification and selection of product materials, options, or components must be made by the purchaser of the equipment. See page 195 for more information on Material Selection. Table A-10. 5402 High Frequency Radar Level Transmitter Ordering Information The starred options (★) represent the most common options and should be selected for best delivery. The non-starred offerings are subject to additional delivery lead time. Model Product description 5402 High frequency version (~26 GHz) ★ Housing material ★ Polyurethane-covered Aluminum Stainless Steel (SST), Grade CF8M (ASTM A743) Signal output 4-20 mA with HART communication (HART Revision 5, see page 178 for details) ★ FOUNDATION fieldbus (see page 181 for details) ★ RS-485 with Modbus communication (see page 183 for details) ★ Rosemount 2410 tank hub connectivity (consult factory for details) Conduit/cable threads ½ in. - 14 NPT M20 x 1.5 adapter (1) ★ ★ ® M12, 4-pin, male connector (eurofast ) ★ M(1) A size Mini, 4-pin, male connector (minifast®) ★ 2 pcs M20 x 1.5 adapters (consult factory for details) G(2)(3) 2 pcs metal cable glands (½-14 NPT), (consult factory for details) Product certifications NA No product certificates ★ E1(1) ATEX Flameproof ★ I1 ATEX Intrinsic safety ★ IA ATEX FISCO Intrinsic safety ★ E5(1) FM Explosion-proof ★ I5 FM Intrinsic safety and non-incendive ★ IE(4) FM FISCO Intrinsic safety ★ E6(1) CSA Explosion-proof ★ I6 CSA Intrinsic safety ★ IF CSA FISCO Intrinsic safety ★ E7(1) IECEx Flameproof ★ I7 IECEx Intrinsic safety ★ (4) (4) 206 Reference Data Reference Manual Appendix A: Reference data 00809-0100-4026, Rev HA November 2014 Table A-10. 5402 High Frequency Radar Level Transmitter Ordering Information The starred options (★) represent the most common options and should be selected for best delivery. The non-starred offerings are subject to additional delivery lead time. IG(4) IECEx FISCO Intrinsic safety E2 INMETRO Flameproof EM Technical Regulations Customs Union (EAC) Flameproof (consult factory for details) I2 INMETRO Intrinsic safety IB INMETRO FISCO Intrinsic safety E3(1) NEPSI Flameproof I3 NEPSI Intrinsic safety IC NEPSI FISCO Intrinsic safety IM ★ Technical Regulations Customs Union (EAC) Intrinsic Safety (consult factory for details) (5) TIIS Flameproof (1) N1 ATEX Type n (consult factory for details) N7(1) IECEx Type n (consult factory for details) E4 Antenna - size and material (for process connection availability, reference to “Dimensional drawings and mechanical properties” on page 200) Cone antennas 2S 2 in. DN 50, 316L SST (EN 1.4404) ★ 3S 3 in. DN 80, 316L SST (EN 1.4404) ★ 4S 4 in. DN 100, 316L SST (EN 1.4404) ★ 2H 2 in. DN 50, Alloy C-276 (UNS N10276) with protective plate 3H 3 in. DN 80, Alloy C-276 (UNS N10276) with protective plate 4H 4 in. DN 100, Alloy C-276 (UNS N10276) with protective plate 2M 2 in. DN 50, Alloy 400 (UNS N04400) with protective plate 3M 3 in. DN 80, Alloy 400 (UNS N04400) with protective plate 4M 4 in. DN 100, Alloy 400 (UNS N04400) with protective plate 2N 2 in. DN 50, 316L SST (EN 1.4404), with protective plate. Complies with guidelines in NACE® MR0175/ISO 15156 and NACE MR0103. 3N 3 in. DN 80, 316L SST (EN 1.4404), with protective plate. Complies with guidelines in NACE MR0175/ISO 15156 and NACE MR0103. 4N 4 in. DN 100, 316L SST (EN 1.4404), with protective plate. Complies with guidelines in NACE MR0175/ISO 15156 and NACE MR0103. Process seal antennas 2P 2 in. (DN50), PTFE (requires tank sealing code NA) 3P 3 in. (DN80), PTFE (requires tank sealing code NA) 4P 4 in. (DN100), PTFE (requires tank sealing code NA) Other antennas XX Customer specific Reference Data 207 Appendix A: Reference data November 2014 Reference Manual 00809-0100-4026, Rev HA Table A-10. 5402 High Frequency Radar Level Transmitter Ordering Information The starred options (★) represent the most common options and should be selected for best delivery. The non-starred offerings are subject to additional delivery lead time. Tank sealing, o-ring material PV Viton Fluoroelastomer ★ PK Kalrez 6375 Perfluoroelastomer ★ PE Ethylene Propylene (EPDM) ★ PB Nitrile Butadiene (NBR) ★ NA None(6) ★ Process connection and material (for antenna availability, reference to “Dimensional drawings and mechanical properties” on page 200) ASME/ANSI flanges (316/316L SST)(7) AA 2 inch, 150 lb ★ AB 2 inch, 300 lb ★ BA 3 inch, 150 lb ★ BB 3 inch, 300 lb ★ CA 4 inch, 150 lb ★ CB 4 inch, 300 lb ★ DA 6 inch, 150 lb ★ EA 8 inch, 150 lb ★ EN (DIN) flanges (EN 1.4404 SST)(7) HB DN 50 PN 40 ★ IB DN 80 PN 40 ★ JA DN 100 PN 16 ★ JB DN 100 PN 40 ★ KA DN 150 PN 16 ★ LA DN 200 PN 16 ★ JIS flanges (EN 1.4404 SST)(7) UA 50A 10K ★ VA 80A 10K ★ XA 100A 10K ★ YA 150A 10K ★ ZA 200A 10K ★ Other BR(8) Bracket mounting, 316L / EN 1.4404 SST XX Customer specific Options M1 208 Integral digital display ★ Reference Data Reference Manual Appendix A: Reference data 00809-0100-4026, Rev HA November 2014 Table A-10. 5402 High Frequency Radar Level Transmitter Ordering Information The starred options (★) represent the most common options and should be selected for best delivery. The non-starred offerings are subject to additional delivery lead time. GC Transparent meter glass protection cover made of PTFE / FEP ★ T1 Transient protection terminal block (standard with FISCO options) ★ Factory configuration C1 Factory configuration (Configuration Data Sheet required with order, available at www.rosemount.com) ★ Alarm limit configuration C4 NAMUR alarm and saturation levels, high alarm ★ C8(9) Low alarm (standard Rosemount alarm and saturation levels) ★ WHG Overfill approval ★ Overfill U1(10) Special certifications Q4 Calibration Data Certificate ★ Q8(11) Material Traceability Certification per EN 10204 3.1 ★ (12) N2 Certificate of compliance with guidelines in NACE MR0175/ISO 15156 and NACE MR0103 QG GOST Primary Verification Certificate Safety certifications QS(10) Prior use certificate of FMEDA data Shipboard approvals(13) SBS American Bureau of Shipping Type Approval (consult factory for details) SDN Det Norske Veritas (DNV) Type Approval (consult factory for details) SLL Lloyd's Register Type Approval (consult factory for details) SBV Bureau Veritas Type Approval (consult factory for details) SRS Russian Maritime Register of Shipping Type Approval (consult factory for details) SGL Germanischer Lloyd Type Approval (consult factory for details) Special procedures P1(8) Hydrostatic testing ★ Antenna extension S3(14) Cone Antenna extension in 316 / 316L / EN 1.4404 SST. To be used if there are irregularities in the nozzle. Fits nozzles up to 20 in. (500 mm). Diagnostics functionality (see page 186 for more information) D01 FOUNDATION fieldbus Diagnostics Suite (includes Signal Quality Metrics diagnostics) (consult factory for details) DA1 HART Diagnostics Suite (includes Signal Quality Metrics diagnostics) (consult factory for details) Reference Data 209 Appendix A: Reference data November 2014 Reference Manual 00809-0100-4026, Rev HA Table A-10. 5402 High Frequency Radar Level Transmitter Ordering Information The starred options (★) represent the most common options and should be selected for best delivery. The non-starred offerings are subject to additional delivery lead time. Solids applications SM1 Solids Measurement mode (see page 199) ★ Engineered solutions (see page 196) Rxxxx Engineered Solutions beyond standard model codes (consult factory for details) Typical model number: 5402 A H 1 E5 4S PV CA - M1 C1 (1) (2) (3) (4) (5) (6) (7) (8) (9) (10) (11) (12) (13) Options E (eurofast) and M (minifast) are not available with explosion-proof, flameproof, or type n approvals. Min temperature -20 °C (-4 °F). Not available with explosion-proof, flameproof, or type n approvals. Requires FOUNDATION fieldbus signal output (Ui parameter listed in “Product Certifications” on page 217). G ½ in. SST cable gland is included in delivery. Requires Process Seal Antenna (2P-4P). O-rings are not wetted. See “Process connections” on page 205 for Face style. Bracket mounting (BR) is not available with hydrostatic testing (P1). The standard alarm setting is high. Only available with 4-20 mA HART signal output. Certificate includes all pressure retaining wetted parts. Requires Protective Plate Cone Antennas (2H-4H, 2M-4M, 2N-4N) or Process Seal Antennas (2P-4P). Only for stainless steel housing material (code S). Not available with Modbus signal output (code M). Contact an Emerson Process Management representative for additional information. (14) Requires a SST Cone Antenna (2S-4S). 210 Reference Data Reference Manual 00809-0100-4026, Rev HA Appendix A: Reference data November 2014 Table A-11. 5401 Low Frequency Radar Level Transmitter Ordering Information The starred options (★) represent the most common options and should be selected for best delivery. The non-starred offerings are subject to additional delivery lead time. Model Product description 5401 Low frequency version (~6 GHz) ★ Housing material Polyurethane-covered Aluminum Stainless Steel (SST), Grade CF8M (ASTM A743) ★ Signal output 4-20 mA with HART communication (HART Revision 5, see page 178 for details) ★ FOUNDATION fieldbus (see page 181 for details) ★ RS-485 with Modbus communication (see page 183 for details) ★ Rosemount 2410 tank hub connectivity (consult factory for details) Conduit/cable threads ½ in. - 14 NPT ★ M20 x 1.5 adapter ★ E(1) (1) M12, 4-pin, male connector (eurofast) A size Mini, 4-pin, male connector (minifast) Product certifications NA No product certificates ★ E1(1) ATEX Flameproof ★ I1 ATEX Intrinsic safety ★ IA(2) ATEX FISCO Intrinsic safety ★ E5(1) FM Explosion-proof ★ I5 FM Intrinsic safety and non-incendive ★ IE(2) FM FISCO Intrinsic safety ★ E6(1) CSA Explosion-proof ★ I6 CSA Intrinsic safety ★ IF(2) CSA FISCO Intrinsic safety ★ E7(1) IECEx Flameproof ★ I7 IECEx Intrinsic safety ★ IG(2) IECEx FISCO Intrinsic safety ★ E2 INMETRO Flameproof I2 INMETRO Intrinsic safety IB INMETRO FISCO Intrinsic safety E3(1) NEPSI Flameproof Reference Data 211 Appendix A: Reference data November 2014 Reference Manual 00809-0100-4026, Rev HA Table A-11. 5401 Low Frequency Radar Level Transmitter Ordering Information The starred options (★) represent the most common options and should be selected for best delivery. The non-starred offerings are subject to additional delivery lead time. EM Technical Regulations Customs Union (EAC) Flameproof (consult factory for details) I3 NEPSI Intrinsic safety IC NEPSI FISCO Intrinsic safety IM Technical Regulations Customs Union (EAC) Intrinsic Safety (consult factory for details) (3) E4 TIIS Flameproof N1(1) ATEX Type n (consult factory for details) N7(1) IECEx Type n (consult factory for details) Antenna - size and material (for process connection availability, reference to “Dimensional drawings and mechanical properties” on page 200) Cone antennas 3S 3 in. DN 80, 316L SST (EN 1.4404) ★ 4S 4 in. DN 100, 316L SST (EN 1.4404) ★ 6S 6 in. DN 150, 316L SST (EN 1.4404) ★ 8S 8 in. DN 200, 316L SST (EN 1.4404) ★ 3H 3 in. DN 80, Alloy C-276 (UNS N10276) with protective plate, pipe installations only 4H 4 in. DN 100, Alloy C-276 (UNS N10276) with protective plate 6H 6 in. DN 150, Alloy C-276 (UNS N10276) with protective plate 8H 8 in. DN 200, Alloy C-276 (UNS N10276) with protective plate 3M 3 in. DN 80, Alloy 400 (UNS N04400) with protective plate, pipe installations only 4M 4 in. DN 100, Alloy 400 (UNS N04400) with protective plate 6M 6 in. DN 150, Alloy 400 (UNS N04400) with protective plate 8M 8 in. DN 200, Alloy 400 (UNS N04400) with protective plate 3N 3 in. DN 80, 316L SST (EN 1.4404), with protective plate, pipe installations only. Complies with guidelines in NACE MR0175/ISO 15156 and NACE MR0103. 4N 4 in. DN 100, 316L SST (EN 1.4404), with protective plate. Complies with guidelines in NACE MR0175/ISO 15156 and NACE MR0103. 6N 6 in. DN 150, 316L SST (EN 1.4404), with protective plate. Complies with guidelines in NACE MR0175/ISO 15156 and NACE MR0103. 8N 8 in. DN 200, 316L SST (EN 1.4404), with protective plate. Complies with guidelines in NACE MR0175/ISO 15156 and NACE MR0103. Rod antennas 1R(4)(5) (4)(5) Short version, all-PFA, with protective plate, max. nozzle height 4 in. (100 mm), free propagation only 2R Long version, all-PFA, with protective plate, max. nozzle height 10 in. (250 mm), free propagation only 3R(4) Short version, SST+PFA, max. nozzle height 4 in. (100 mm), free propagation only (4) 4R Long version, SST+PFA, max. nozzle height 10 in. (250 mm), free propagation only Other antennas XX 212 Customer specific Reference Data Reference Manual 00809-0100-4026, Rev HA Appendix A: Reference data November 2014 Table A-11. 5401 Low Frequency Radar Level Transmitter Ordering Information The starred options (★) represent the most common options and should be selected for best delivery. The non-starred offerings are subject to additional delivery lead time. Tank sealing, o-ring material PV Viton Fluoroelastomer ★ PK Kalrez 6375 Perfluoroelastomer ★ PE Ethylene Propylene (EPDM) ★ PB Nitrile Butadiene (NBR) ★ PD(4) All-PFA Rod Antennas (O-rings are not wetted) ★ Process connection and material (for antenna availability, reference to “Dimensional drawings and mechanical properties” on page 200) ASME/ANSI flanges (316/316L SST)(6) AA 2 in. 150 lb ★ AB 2 in. 300 lb ★ BA 3 in. 150 lb ★ BB 3 in. 300 lb ★ CA 4 in. 150 lb ★ CB 4 in. 300 lb ★ DA 6 in. 150 lb ★ EA 8 in. 150 lb ★ EN (DIN) flanges (EN 1.4404 SST)(6) HB DN 50 PN 40 ★ IB DN 80 PN 40 ★ JA DN 100 PN 16 ★ JB DN 100 PN 40 ★ KA DN 150 PN 16 ★ LA DN 200 PN 16 ★ JIS flanges (EN 1.4404 SST)(6) UA 50A 10K ★ VA 80A 10K ★ XA 100A 10K ★ YA 150A 10K ★ ZA 200A 10K ★ Tri-Clamp connection (316/316L) AT(7) 2 in. Tri-Clamp (7) 3 in. Tri-Clamp (7) 4 in. Tri-Clamp BT CT Threaded (316L / EN 1.4404 SST) Reference Data 213 Appendix A: Reference data November 2014 Reference Manual 00809-0100-4026, Rev HA Table A-11. 5401 Low Frequency Radar Level Transmitter Ordering Information The starred options (★) represent the most common options and should be selected for best delivery. The non-starred offerings are subject to additional delivery lead time. RA(8) 1.5-in. NPT Other BR(8) Bracket mounting, 316L / EN 1.4404 SST XX Customer specific Options M1 Integral digital display ★ T1 Transient protection terminal block (standard with FISCO options) ★ GC Transparent meter glass protection cover made of PTFE/FEP Factory configuration C1 Factory configuration (Configuration Data Sheet required with order, available at www.rosemount.com) ★ Alarm limit configuration C4 (9) C8 NAMUR alarm and saturation levels, high alarm ★ Low alarm (standard Rosemount alarm and saturation levels) ★ WHG Overfill approval ★ Overfill U1(10) Special certifications Calibration Data Certificate ★ Q8 Material Traceability Certification per EN 10204 3.1 ★ N2(11) Certificate of compliance with guidelines in NACE MR0175/ISO 15156 and NACE MR0103 QG GOST Primary Verification Certificate Q4 (10) Safety certifications QS(12) Prior use certificate of FMEDA data Shipboard approvals(13) SBS American Bureau of Shipping Type Approval (consult factory for details) SDN Det Norske Veritas (DNV) Type Approval (consult factory for details) SLL Lloyd's Register Type Approval (consult factory for details) SBV Bureau Veritas Type Approval (consult factory for details) SRS Russian Maritime Register of Shipping Type Approval (consult factory for details) SGL Germanischer Lloyd Type Approval (consult factory for details) Special procedures P1(8) ★ Hydrostatic testing Antenna extension S3(14) 214 Extended Cone Antenna in 316 / 316L / EN 1.4404 SST. Maximum recommended nozzle height is 20 in. (500 mm). Reference Data Reference Manual Appendix A: Reference data 00809-0100-4026, Rev HA November 2014 Table A-11. 5401 Low Frequency Radar Level Transmitter Ordering Information The starred options (★) represent the most common options and should be selected for best delivery. The non-starred offerings are subject to additional delivery lead time. Diagnostics functionality (see page 186 for more information) D01 FOUNDATION fieldbus Diagnostics Suite (includes Signal Quality Metrics diagnostics) (consult factory for details) DA1 HART Diagnostics Suite (includes Signal Quality Metrics diagnostics) (consult factory for details) Engineered solutions (see page 196) Rxxxx Engineered Solutions beyond standard model codes (consult factory for details) Typical model number: 5401 A H 1 NA 4S PV CA - M1 C1 (1) (2) (3) (4) (5) (6) (7) (8) (9) (10) (11) (12) (13) Options E (eurofast) and M (minifast) are not available with explosion-proof, flameproof, or type n approvals. Requires FOUNDATION fieldbus signal output (Ui parameter listed in “Product Certifications” on page 217). G ½ in. SST cable gland is included in delivery. PFA is a fluoropolymer with properties similar to PTFE. All-PFA Rod Antennas (1R or 2R) require all-PFA tank seal (PD). See “Process connections” on page 205 for Face style. Only available with Rod Antenna (3R and 4R). Certain process connections are not available with hydrostatic testing (P1). The standard alarm setting is high. Certificate includes all pressure retaining wetted parts. Requires Protective Plate Cone Antennas (3H-8H, 3M-8M, 3N-8N) or Rod Antennas (1R-4R). Only available with 4-20 mA HART signal output. Only for stainless steel housing material (code S). Not available with Modbus signal output (code M). Contact an Emerson Process Management representative for additional information. (14) Requires a SST Cone Antenna (4S-8S). Table A-12. Accessories The starred options (★) represent the most common options and should be selected for best delivery. The non-starred offerings are subject to additional delivery lead time. HART modem and cables 03300-7004-0001 MACTek Viator HART modem and cables (RS232 connection) ★ 03300-7004-0002 MACTek Viator HART modem and cables (USB connection) ★ Reference Data 215 Appendix A: Reference data November 2014 216 Reference Manual 00809-0100-4026, Rev HA Reference Data Reference Manual Appendix B: Product certifications 00809-0100-4026, Rev HA November 2014 Appendix B Product Certifications Safety messages . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . European Directive information . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . FCC and ICC . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Safety Instrumented Systems (SIS) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Hazardous locations certifications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Approval drawings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . B.1 page 217 page 219 page 219 page 219 page 220 page 230 Safety messages Procedures and instructions in this section may require special precautions to ensure the safety of the personnel performing the operations. Information that raises potential safety issues is indicated by a warning symbol ( ). Refer to the following safety messages before performing an operation preceded by this symbol. Explosions could result in death or serious injury. Verify that the operating environment of the transmitter is consistent with the appropriate hazardous locations specifications. To prevent ignition of flammable or combustible atmospheres, disconnect power before servicing. Before connecting a HART®-, FOUNDATION™ fieldbus-, or Modbus®-based communicator in an explosive atmosphere, make sure the instruments in the loop are installed in accordance with intrinsically safe or non-incendive field wiring practices. To avoid process leaks, only use O-rings designed to seal with the corresponding flange adapter. Electrical shock can result in death or serious injury. Avoid contact with the leads and terminals. High voltage that may be present on leads can cause electrical shock. Make sure the main power to the Rosemount 5400 Series transmitter is off and the lines to any other external power source are disconnected or not powered while wiring the transmitter. Antennas with non-conducting surfaces. Product Certifications Antennas with non-conducting surfaces (e.g. rod antenna and process seal antenna) may generate an ignition-capable level of electrostatic charge under extreme conditions. Therefore, when the antenna is used in a potentially explosive atmosphere, appropriate measures must be taken to prevent electrostatic discharge. 217 Appendix B: Product certifications Reference Manual 00809-0100-4026, Rev HA November 2014 Failure to follow safe installation and service guidelines could result in death or serious injury. Make sure the transmitter is installed by qualified personnel and in accordance with applicable code of practice. Use the equipment only as specified in this manual. Failure to do so may impair the protection provided by the equipment. Do not perform any services other than those contained in this manual unless you are qualified. Any substitution of non-recognized spare parts may jeopardize safety. Unauthorized changes to the product are strictly prohibited as they may unintentionally and unpredictably alter performance and jeopardize safety. Unauthorized changes that interfere with the integrity of the welds or flanges, such as making additional perforations, compromise product integrity and safety. Equipment ratings and certifications are no longer valid on any products that have been damaged or modified without the prior written permission of Emerson Process Management. Any continued use of product that has been damaged or modified without prior written authorization is at the customer's sole risk and expense. 218 Product Certifications Reference Manual Appendix B: Product certifications 00809-0100-4026, Rev HA B.2 November 2014 European Directive information The EC declaration of conformity for all applicable European directives for this product can be found on the Rosemount website at www.rosemount.com. A hard copy may be obtained by contacting our local sales representative. B.3 FCC and ICC This device complies with Part 15 of the FCC Rules and with Industry Canada license-exempt RSS standard(s). Operation is subject to the following two conditions: (1) This device may not cause interference, and (2) this device must accept any interference received, including interference that may cause undesired operation. Changes or modifications to this equipment not expressly approved by Rosemount Inc. may void the FCC authorization to operate this equipment. Le présent appareil est conforme aux CNR d'Industrie Canada applicables aux appareils radio exempts de licence. L'exploitation est autorisée aux deux conditions suivantes: (1) l'appareil ne doit pas produire de brouillage, et (2) l'utilisateur de l'appareil doit accepter tout brouillage radioélectrique subi, même si le brouillage est susceptible d'en compromettre le fonctionnement. Les changements ou les modifications apportés à l'équipement qui n'est pas expressément approuvé par Rosemount Inc pourraient annuler l'autorité de l'utilisateur à utiliser cet équipement. B.4 Safety Instrumented Systems (SIS)(1) The Rosemount 5400 Series has been evaluated by a third party, the SP (Technical Research Institute of Sweden), against hardware requirements according to IEC 61508. With a FMEDA (Failure Modes, Effects and Diagnostics Analysis) report with a Safe Failure Fraction (SFF) above 80%, 5400 is suitable in SIS according to the Prior Use methodology. For more information, go to: http://www.rosemount.com/safety. To order the certificate of FMEDA data, use option code QS. (1) Not available for solids applications. Product Certifications 219 Appendix B: Product certifications B.5 Reference Manual 00809-0100-4026, Rev HA November 2014 Hazardous locations certifications Other temperature restrictions may apply beside the ones mentioned in the following sections. For more information, see “Reference Data” on page 177. B.5.1 North-American certifications Factory Mutual (FM) approvals The Rosemount 5400 Series Non-Contacting Radar Level Transmitter that has the following labels attached has been certified to comply with the requirements of the approval agencies noted. Project ID: 3020497 Specific Conditions of Use: 1. WARNING – Potential Electrostatic Charging Hazard – The enclosure is constructed from a non-metallic material. To prevent the risk of electrostatic sparking the plastic surface should only be cleaned with a damp cloth. 2. WARNING – The apparatus enclosure contains aluminum and is considered to constitute a potential risk of ignition by impact or friction. Care must be taken into account during installation and use to prevent impact or friction. E5 Explosion-proof for Class I, Div. 1, Groups B, C, and D; Dust ignition proof for Class II/III, Div. 1, Groups E, F, and G; with intrinsically safe connections to Class I, II, III, Div. 1, Groups B, C, D, E, F, and G. Temp. Code T4 Ambient temperature limits: -50 °C to +70 °C(1). Seal not required. Approval valid for HART, FOUNDATION fieldbus, and Modbus options. I5, IE Intrinsically Safe for Class I, II, III, Div. 1, Groups A, B, C, D, E, F, and G, Class I, Zone 0, AEx ia IIC T4 when installed per control drawing: 9150079-905. Non-incendive for Class I, II, Div.2, Groups A, B, C, D, E, F, and G suitable for Class II, III. 4-20 mA/HART model: Ui = 30 Vdc, Ii = 130 mA, Pi = 1.0 W, Ci = 7.26 nF, Li = 0 PH FOUNDATION fieldbus model: Ui = 30 Vdc, Ii = 300 mA, Pi = 1.3 W, Ci = 0 nF, Li = 0 H FISCO model: Ui = 17.5 Vdc, Ii = 380 mA, Pi = 5.32 W, Ci = Li = 0 Temp. Code T4 Ambient temperature limits: -50 °C to +70 °C(1) Approval valid for HART, FOUNDATION fieldbus, and FISCO options. (1) 220 +60 °C with FOUNDATION fieldbus or FISCO option. Product Certifications Reference Manual Appendix B: Product certifications 00809-0100-4026, Rev HA B.5.2 November 2014 Canadian Standards Association (CSA) Approvals When bearing the “Dual Seal” marking, this product meets the Dual Seal Requirements of ANSI/ISA 12.27.01-2003. Cert. No.: 1514653 E6 Explosion-proof with internal Intrinsically safe circuits [Exia] Class I, Div. 1, Groups B, C, and D; Temp. Code T4. Class II, Div. 1 and 2, Groups E, F, and G; Class III, Div. 1 Ambient temperature limits -50 °C to +70 °C(1). Approval valid for HART, FOUNDATION fieldbus, and Modbus options. I6, IF Intrinsically safe Exia. Class I, Div. 1, Groups A, B, C, and D. Temp. Code T4. 4-20 mA/HART model: Ui = 30 Vdc, Ii = 130 mA, Pi = 1.0 W, Ci = 7.26 nF, Li = 0 H. FOUNDATION fieldbus model: Ui = 30 Vdc, Ii = 300 mA, Pi = 1.3 W, Ci = 0 nF, Li = 0 H. FISCO model: Ui = 17.5 Vdc, Ii = 380 mA, Pi = 5.32 W, Ci = Li = 0. Installation drawing: 9150079-906. Ambient temperature limits: -50 °C to +70 °C(1). Approval valid for HART, FOUNDATION fieldbus, and FISCO options. (1) +60 °C with FOUNDATION fieldbus or FISCO option. Product Certifications 221 Reference Manual Appendix B: Product certifications 00809-0100-4026, Rev HA November 2014 B.5.3 European certifications ATEX Approvals 0575 Nemko 04ATEX1073X Specific Conditions for Safe Use (X): 1. The intrinsically safe circuits do not withstand the 500V AC test as specified in EN 60079-11clause 6.4.13. 2. “Potential ignition hazards by impact or friction need to be considered according to EN 60079-0:2012 clause 8.3 (for EPL Ga and EPL Gb) and clause 8.4 (for EPL Da and EPL Db), when the transmitter enclosure and antennas exposed to the exterior atmosphere of the tank, is made with light metals containing aluminum or titanium, The end user shall determine the suitability with regard to avoid hazards from impact and friction.” 3. The antennas for type 5400, are non-conducting and the area of the non-conducting part exceeds the maximum permissible areas for Group IIC and according to EN 60079-0:2012 clause 7.4: 20 cm2 for EPL Gb and 4 cm2 for EPL Ga. Therefore, when the antenna is used in a potentially explosive atmosphere, appropriate measures must be taken to prevent electrostatic discharge. 4. The Ex ia version of model 5400 may be supplied by an Ex ib certified safety barrier. The whole circuit shall then be regarded type Ex ib. The preferred type Ex ia or Ex ib shall be indicated on the marking label as specified in the instructions for the transmitter. The antenna part, located in the process vessel, is classified EPL Ga and electrically separated from the Ex ia or ib circuit. 5. ½” NPT threads need to be sealed for dust and water ingress protection, IP 66, IP 67 or ‘Ex t’, EPL Da or Db is required. E1 Flameproof: II 1/2 G Ex d ia IIC T4 Ga/Gb (-50 °C dTa d+70 °C(1)) II 1D Ex ta IIIC T79°C(2) Da (-40 °C dTa d+70 °C(1)) Um = 250 V Approval valid for HART, FOUNDATION fieldbus, and Modbus options. I1, IA Intrinsically safe: II 1 G Ex ia IIC T4 Ga or II 1/2 G Ex ib IIC T4 Ga/Gb (-40 °C dTa d+70 °C(1)) II 1 D Ex ta IIIC T79°C(2) Da (-50 °C dTa d+70 °C(1)) 4-20 mA / HART model: Ui=30 Vdc, Ii=130 mA, Pi=1.0 W, Ci=7.26 nF, Li=0 H. FOUNDATION fieldbus model: Ui=30 Vdc, Ii=300 mA, Pi=1.5 W, Ci=4.95 nF, Li=0 H. FISCO model: Ui=17.5 Vdc, Ii=380 mA, Pi=5.32 W, Ci=4.95 nF, Li<1 ì H. Installation drawing: 9150079-907. Approval valid for HART, FOUNDATION fieldbus, and FISCO options. (1) (2) 222 +60 °C with FOUNDATION fieldbus or FISCO option. +69 °C with FOUNDATION fieldbus or FISCO option. Product Certifications Reference Manual Appendix B: Product certifications 00809-0100-4026, Rev HA November 2014 Nemko 10ATEX1072 N1 Type n: II 3G Ex nA IIC T4 Gc (-50 °C dTa d+70 °C(1)) II 3G Ex nL IIC T4 Gc (-50 °C dTa d+70 °C(1)) HART 4-20 mA(2) Maximum input voltage Ui: 42.4 V, Maximum input current Ii: 23 mA Maximum input power Pi: 1.0 W, Maximum internal capacitance Ci: 7.25 nF Maximum internal inductance Li: 0 H FOUNDATION fieldbus(2) Maximum input voltage Ui: 32 V, Maximum input current Ii: 21 mA Maximum input power Pi: 0.7 W, Maximum internal capacitance Ci: 4.95 nF Maximum internal inductance Li: 0 H Approval valid for HART and FOUNDATION fieldbus options. Installation drawing: 9240031-958 (1) (2) +60 °C with FOUNDATION fieldbus or FISCO option. Valid for Ex nL. Product Certifications 223 Appendix B: Product certifications B.5.4 Reference Manual 00809-0100-4026, Rev HA November 2014 IECEx Approval IECEx NEM 06.0001X Specific Conditions for Safe Use (X): 1. The intrinsically safe circuits do not withstand the 500V AC test as specified in IEC 60079-11 clause 6.4.13. 2. “Potential ignition hazards by impact or friction need to be considered according to IEC 60079-0:2011 clause 8.3 (for EPL Ga and EPL Gb) and clause 8.4 (for EPL Da and EPL Db), when the transmitter enclosure and antennas exposed to the exterior atmosphere of the tank, is made with light metals containing aluminum or titanium, The end user shall determine the suitability with regard to avoid hazards from impact and friction.” 3. The antennas for type 5400, are non-conducting and the area of the non-conducting part exceeds the maximum permissible areas for Group IIC and according to IEC 60079-0 .2011 clause 7.4: 20 cm2 for EPL Gb and 4 cm2 for EPL Ga. Therefore, when the antenna is used in a potentially explosive atmosphere, appropriate measures must be taken to prevent electrostatic discharge. 4. The Ex ia version of model 5400 may be supplied by an Ex ib certified safety barrier. The whole circuit shall then be regarded type Ex ib. The preferred type Ex ia or Ex ib shall be indicated on the marking label as specified in the instructions for the transmitter. The antenna part, located in the process vessel, is classified EPL Ga and electrically separated from the Ex ia or ib circuit. 5. ½” NPT threads need to be sealed for dust and water ingress protection, IP 66, IP 67 or ‘Ex t’, EPL Da or Db is required. E7 Flameproof: Ex d ia IIC T4 Ga/Gb (-40 °C d Ta d+70 °C(1)) Ex ta IIIC T79°C(2) Da (-40 °C d Ta d +70 °C(1)) Um = 250 V Approval valid for HART, FOUNDATION fieldbus, and Modbus options. I7, IG Intrinsically safe: Ex ia IIC T4 Ga or Ex ib IIC T4 Ga/Gb (-50 °C dTa d+70 °C). Ex ta IIIC T79°C(2) Da (-50 °C dTa d+70 °C). 4-20 mA / HART model: Ui=30 Vdc, Ii=130 mA, Pi=1.0 W, Ci=7.26 nF, Li=0 H. FOUNDATION fieldbus model: Ui=30 Vdc, Ii=300 mA, Pi=1.5 W, Ci=4.95 nF, Li=0 H. FISCO model: Ui=17.5 Vdc, Ii=380 mA, Pi=5.32 W, Ci=4.95 nF, Li<1 ì H. Installation drawing: 9150079-907. Approval valid for HART, FOUNDATION fieldbus, and FISCO options. (1) (2) 224 +60 °C with FOUNDATION fieldbus or FISCO option. +69 °C with FOUNDATION fieldbus or FISCO option. Product Certifications Reference Manual Appendix B: Product certifications 00809-0100-4026, Rev HA November 2014 IECEx NEM 10.0005 N7 Type n: Ex nA IIC T4 Gc (-50 °C dTa d+70 °C(1)) Ex nL IIC T4 Gc (-50 °C dTa d+70 °C (1)) HART® 4-20 mA(2) Maximum input voltage Ui: 42.4 V, Maximum input current Ii: 23 mA Maximum input power Pi: 1.0 W, Maximum internal capacitance Ci: 7.25 nF Maximum internal inductance Li: 0 H FOUNDATION fieldbus(2) Maximum input voltage Ui: 32 V, Maximum input current Ii: 21 mA Maximum input power Pi: 0.7 W, Maximum internal capacitance Ci: 4.95 nF Maximum internal inductance Li: 0 H Approval valid for HART and Foundation fieldbus options installation drawing 9240031-958 B.5.5 EAC certifications Technical Regulations Customs Union (EAC) EM, IM: Contact an Emerson Process Management representative for additional information. (1) (2) +60 °C with FOUNDATION fieldbus or FISCO option. Valid for Ex nL. Product Certifications 225 Appendix B: Product certifications B.5.6 Reference Manual 00809-0100-4026, Rev HA November 2014 Brazilian certifications NCC/INMETRO Approvals Special Condition for Safe Use (X): Refer to Certificate NCC 14.2256X Standards ABNT NBR IEC 60079-0:2013, ABNT NBR IEC 60079-1:2009, ABNT NBR IEC 60079-11:2009; ABNT NBR IEC 60079-26:2008, ABNT NBR IEC 60079-27:2010, ABNT NBR IEC 60079-31:2011 E2 Flameproof: Ex ia/db ia IIC T4 Ga/Gb(-40 °C dTa d+70 °C(1)) Ex ta IIIC T79 °C(2) IP66/67 I2, IB Intrinsically safe: Ex ia IIC T4 Ga/Gb (-50 °C dTa d+70 °C(1)) Ex ta IIIC T79 °C(2) (-50 °C dTa d+70 °C(1)) IP66/67 4-20mA / HART model: Ui=30 Vdc, Ii=130 mA, Pi=1.0 W, Ci=7.26 nF, Li=0 H. FOUNDATION™ fieldbus model: Ui=30 Vdc, Ii=300 mA, Pi=1.5 W, Ci=4.95 nF, Li=0 H. FISCO model: Ui=17.5 Vdc, Ii=380 mA, Pi=5.32 W, Ci=4.95 nF, Li<1 ì H. B.5.7 Chinese certifications National Supervision and Inspection Center for Explosion Protection and Safety of Instrumentation (NEPSI) approvals Special Condition for Safe Use (X): Refer to Certificate GYJ111229X E3 Flameproof: Ex d ia IIC T4 (-40 °C < Ta < +70 °C(1)) Um=250 V I3 Intrinsically safe: Ex ia IIC T4 (-50 °C < Ta < +70 °C(1)) DIP A20 Ta 79°C(2) (-50 °C < Ta < +70 °C(1)) 4-20 mA / HART model: Ui=30 Vdc, Ii=130 mA, Pi=1.0 W, Ci=7.26 nF, Li=0 H. FOUNDATION fieldbus model: Ui=30 Vdc, Ii=300 mA, Pi=1.5 W, Ci=4.95 nF, Li=0 H. FISCO model: Ui=17.5 Vdc, Ii=380 mA, Pi=5.32 W, Ci=4.95 nF, Li<1 ì H. (1) (2) 226 +60 °C with FOUNDATION fieldbus option or FISCO option. +69 °C with FOUNDATION fieldbus option or FISCO option. Product Certifications Reference Manual Appendix B: Product certifications 00809-0100-4026, Rev HA B.5.8 November 2014 Japanese certifications Technology Institution of Industrial Safety (TIIS) Approval Special Condition for Safe Use (X): Refer to certificate TC20109-TC20111 (4-20 mA HART) and TC20244-TC20246 FOUNDATION fieldbus) E4(1) Flameproof: 4-20 mA HART model: Transmitter: Ex d [ia] IIC T4x -20 ~ +60 °C DC 20 - 42.4 V Um = 250 V Uo = 22.2 V Io = 177 mA Po = 0.985 W Antennas: Ex ia IIC T4X FOUNDATION fieldbus model: Transmitter: Ex d [ia] IIC T4x -20 ~ +60 °C DC 16 - 32 V Um = 250 V Uo = 22.2 V Io = 177.5 mA Po = 0.985 W Antennas: Ex ia IIC T4X Installation drawing: 05400-00375. Approval valid for HART and FOUNDATION fieldbus options. (1) Not available for solids applications. Product Certifications 227 Reference Manual Appendix B: Product certifications 00809-0100-4026, Rev HA November 2014 B.5.9 Other certifications Overfill protection Cert. No: Z-65.16-475 U1 TÜV-tested and approved by DIBt for overfill protection according to the German WHG regulations. Approval valid for HART options. Suitability for Intended Use Compliant with NAMUR NE 95, version 07.07.2006 “Basic Principles of Homologation”. Type Approval Certifications (Marine/shipboard approvals) SBS(1) American Bureau of Shipping (ABS) Product Type Approval Certificate Number: 10-LD530607-PDA Intended Service: For monitoring, process-control and hi/lo-alarming in continuous or batch like operation for the marine applications on Oil, Product, Chemical and Gas tankers as well as on Offshore mobile units. ABS Rules: 2010 Steel Vessels Rules 1-1-4/7.7, 4-8-4/27.5 and 4-9-7, 5C-1-7/21.15.1; 5C-8-13/2; 5C-9-13/1 Approval valid for HART and FOUNDATION fieldbus options. (1) SDN Det Norske Veritas (DNV) Type Approval Certificate Certificate Number: A-11731 Intended Service: The Rosemount 5400 is found to comply with Det Norske Veritas' Rules for Classification of Ships, High Speed & Light Craft and Det Norske Veritas' Offshore Standards. Location classes Temperature Humidity Vibration EMC Enclosure Approval valid for HART and FOUNDATION fieldbus options. (1) 228 Not available for solids applications. Product Certifications Reference Manual Appendix B: Product certifications 00809-0100-4026, Rev HA November 2014 SLL(1) Lloyd's Register Type Approval Certificate Certificate Number: 09/00034 Application: For use in environmental categories ENV1, ENV2, ENV3 and ENV5 as defined in Lloyd's Register Test Specification No. 1: 2002. Approval valid for HART and FOUNDATION fieldbus options. SBV(1) Bureau Veritas Type Approval Certificate Certificate Number: 22379/A0 BV Requirements: BUREAU VERITAS Rules for the Classification of Steel Ships Application: Approval valid for ships intended to be granted with the following additional class notations: AUT-UMS, AUT-CCS, AUT-PORT and AUT-IMS. Approval valid for HART and FOUNDATION fieldbus options. (1) SRS Russian Maritime Register of Shipping Type Approval Certificate Certificate Number: 08.00159.120 Application and limitations: Rosemount 5400 Series Twin-Lead Radar Level Transmitter (models: 5401, 5402) are intended for using on sea-going ships, floating constructions and fixed offshore platforms. Approval valid for HART and FOUNDATION fieldbus options. SGL (1) Germanischer Lloyd Type Approval Certificate Certificate Number: 86 883 - 10 HH Approval valid for HART and FOUNDATION fieldbus options. B.5.10 Canadian Registration Number (CRN) Cert No: 0F06878.2 The product design has been accepted and registered for use in Canada. (1) Not available for solids applications. Product Certifications 229 Appendix B: Product certifications B.6 Reference Manual 00809-0100-4026, Rev HA November 2014 Approval drawings This section contains a FM Approvals system control drawing and Canadian Standards Association and IECEx/ATEX/TIIS installation drawings. You must follow the installation guidelines presented in order to maintain certified ratings for installed transmitters. This section contains the following drawings: 230 Rosemount drawing 9150 079-905: System control drawing for hazardous location installation of intrinsically safe FM approved apparatus. Rosemount drawing 9150 079-906: System control drawing for hazardous location installation of CSA approved apparatus. Rosemount drawing 9150 079-907: Installation drawing for hazardous location installation of ATEX and IECEx approved apparatus. Rosemount drawing 9240031-958: Installation drawing Ex n Rosemount 5400 Series TIIS drawing TIIS-R-IS 05400-00375: Installation drawing for hazardous location installation of TIIS approved apparatus. Product Certifications Product Certifications Potential Electrostatic Charging Hazard – The enclosure is a non-metallic construction. To prevent the risk of electrostatic sparking the plastic surface should only be cleaned with a damp cloth. The apparatus enclosure contains aluminum and is considered to constitute a potential risk of ignition by impact or friction. Care must be taken into account during installation and use to prevent impact or friction. WARNING: WARNING: ISSUE 0346 1144 WEEK SME-3446 SME-7120 CH. ORDER No ISSUE SME-5513 SME-7655 CH. ORDER No ISSUE ALL DIMENSIONS ARE IN MILLIMETRES. 0346 6 GU-PO PDF FILE 1:1 SCALE 0751 WEEK ISSUE Rosemount Tank Radar AB, Sweden The copyright/ownership of this document is and will remain ours. The document must not be used without our authorization or brought to the knowledge of a third party. Contravention will be prosecuted. 9150 079-905 DWG NO. 1/1 SHEET for hazardous location installation of Intrinsically Safe FM approved apparatus SYSTEM CONTROL DRAWING TITLE -50 <= Ta <= 60 deg C -50 <= Ta <= 60 deg C Ambient Temperature Limits -50 <= Ta <= 70 deg C SME-5879 CH. ORDER No 00809-0100-4026, Rev HA 1 ST ANGLE FINISH, UNLESS OTHERWISE STATED: DOC. TYPE 0346 5400 WEEK WEEK ISSUED BY GU-LN APPROVED BY PRODUCT CODE Entity Parameters Vmax(Ui) <= 30V, Imax(Ii) <= 130 mA Pi <= 1W, Ci = 7.26 nF, Li = 0 uH Vmax(Ui) <= 30V, Imax(Ii) <= 300 mA Pi <= 1.3W, Ci = 0, Li = 0 uH Vmax(Ui) <= 17.5V, Imax(Ii) <= 380 mA Pi <= 5.32W, Ci = 0, Li = 0 uH Model Fieldbus IS Model ISSUE ROSEMOUNT 5400 SERIES 4-20 mA/HART IS Model Fieldbus FISCO IS Model 1409 0644 WEEK HAZARDOUS LOCATION 0526 1242 WEEK SME-5134 SME-7473 CH. ORDER No Intrinsically Safe Apparatus for use in Class I,II,III, Division 1, Groups A,B,C,D,E,F,G, Class I, Zone 0, AEx ia IIC T4, Temperature Class T4 : BARRIER ASSOCIATED APPARATUS NON-HAZARDOUS LOCATION FM Approved Product No revisions to this drawing without prior Factory Mutual Approval. Substitution of components may impair Intrinsic Safety. WARNING: Connect supply wires to the appropriate terminals as indicated on the terminal block and in the installation documents. 8. To prevent ignition of flammable or combustible atmospheres, read , understand and adhere to the manufacturer's live maintenance procedures. The associated apparatus must be Factory Mutual Approved. 7. WARNING : Resistance between Intrinsically Safe Ground and Earth Ground must be less than 1.0 ohm. 4. Installations should be in accordance with ANSI/ISA-RP12.6 "Installation of Intrinsically Safe Systems for Hazardous Locations" and the National Electric Code (ANSI/NFPA 70). Control equipment connected to the barrier must not use or generate more than 250 Vrms or Vdc. 3. 6. Dust-Tight seal must be used when installed in Class II and Class III environments. 2. POWER SUPPLY 5. No revision to this drawing without prior Factory Mutual approval. Associated apparatus manufacturer's installation drawing must be followed when installing this product. 1. Notes: The Entity concept allows interconnection of intrinsically safe apparatus to associated apparatus not specifically examined in combination as a system. The approved values of max. open circuit voltage (Voc or Vt) and max. short circuit current (Isc or It) and max. power (Voc x Isc / 4) or (Vt x It / 4), for the associated apparatus must be less than or equal to the maximum safe input voltage (Vmax), maximum safe input current (Imax), and maximum safe input power (Pmax) of the intrinsically safe apparatus. In addition, the approved max. allowable connected capacitance (Ca or Co) of the associated apparatus must be greater than the sum of the interconnecting cable capacitance and the unprotected internal capacitance (Ci) of the intrinsically safe apparatus, and the the approved max. allowable connected inductance (La or Lo) of the associated apparatus must be greater than the sum of the interconnecting cable inductance and the unprotected internal inductance (Li) of the intrinsically safe apparatus. ENTITY CONCEPT APPROVAL ORIGINAL SIZE A3 9150 079-905 03-21 Electronic Master - PRINTED COPIES ARE UNCONTROLLED - Rosemount Propriety Reference Manual Appendix B: Product certifications November 2014 Figure B-1. System Control Drawing for Hazardous Location Installation of Intrinsically Safe FM Approved Apparatus 231 232 POWER SUPPLY 0840 Product options bearing the DUAL SEAL marking on the label meets the Dual Seal requirements of ANSI/ISA 12.27.01. No additional process sealing is required. For the in-service limits applicable to a specific model, see Process Pressure/Temperature range in Appendix A of the Reference manual. 5. Connect supply wires to the appropriate terminals as indicated on the terminal block and in the installation documents. 3. Installations should be in accordance with ANSI/ISA-RP12.6 "Installations of Intrinsically Safe Systems for Hazardous Locations" and the Canadian Electric Code. Control equipment connected to the barrier must not use or generate more than 250 Vrms or Vdc. 2. SME-7063 SME-5134 CH. ORDER No ISSUE SME-5514 CH. ORDER No Model ALL DIMENSIONS ARE IN MILLIMETRES. 0346 6 Entity Parameters PDF FILE 1 ST ANGLE 1:1 SCALE FINISH, UNLESS OTHERWISE STATED: DOC. TYPE GU-PO PRODUCT CODE 0346 5400 WEEK WEEK APPROVED BY ISSUE ISSUE The copyright/ownership of this document is and will remain ours. The document must not be used without our authorization or brought to the knowledge of a third party. Contravention will be prosecuted. Rosemount Tank Radar AB, Sweden 9150 079-906 DWG NO. 1/1 0751 WEEK SHEET for hazardous location installation of CSA approved apparatus INSTALLATION DRAWING TITLE -50 <= Ta <= 60 deg C -50 <= Ta <= 60 deg C Ambient Temperature Limits -50 <= Ta <= 70 deg C SME-5880 CH. ORDER No ROSEMOUNT 5400 SERIES Vmax <= 30V, Imax <= 130 mA Pi <= 1W, Ci = 7.3 nF , Li = 0 uH Vmax <= 30V, Imax <= 300 mA Pi <= 1.3W, Ci = 0, Li = 0 uH Vmax <= 17.5V, Imax <= 380 mA Pi <= 5.32W, Ci = 0, Li = 0 uH GU-LN ISSUED BY Fieldbus FISCO IS Model Fieldbus IS Model 4-20 mA/HART IS Model 0644 WEEK HAZARDOUS LOCATION 1123 0526 WEEK Intrinsically Safe Ex ia Class I, Division 1, Groups A,B,C and D, Temperature Code T4 : BARRIER ASSOCIATED APPARATUS ISSUE November 2014 4. Entity parameters listed (for HART/Fieldbus Model) apply only to associated apparatus with linear output. 1. Notes : The Entity concept allows interconnection of intrinsically safe apparatus to associated apparatus not specifically examined in combination as a system. The approved values of maximum open circuit voltage (Voc) and maximum short circuit current (Isc) and maximum output power (or Voc x Isc / 4), for the associated apparatus must be less than or equal to the maximum safe input voltage (Ui), maximum safe input current (Ii), and maximum safe input power (Pi) of the intrinsically safe apparatus. In addition, the approved maximum allowable connected capacitance (Ca) of the associated apparatus must be greater than the sum of the interconnecting cable capacitance and the unprotected internal capacitance (Ci) of the intrinsically safe apparatus, and the approved maximum allowable connected inductance (La) of the associated apparatus must be greater than the sum of the interconnecting cable inductance and the unprotected internal inductance (Li) of the intrinsically safe apparatus. ENTITY CONCEPT APPROVAL EX-CERTIFIED PRODUCT. No modifications permitted without reference to the Ex-certifying Authorities. 0346 WEEK SME-3445 SME-6019 CH. ORDER No NON-HAZARDOUS LOCATION ISSUE 9150 079-906 ORIGINAL SIZE A3 Appendix B: Product certifications 00809-0100-4026, Rev HA Reference Manual Figure B-2. System Control Drawing for Hazardous Location Installation of CSA Approved Apparatus Product Certifications Product Certifications BARRIER ROSEMOUNT 5400 SERIES HAZARDOUS LOCATION Control equipment connected to the barrier must not use or generate more than 250 Vrms or Vdc. Connect supply wires to the appropriate terminals as indicated on the terminal block table and in the installation documents. 2. 3. EX-CERTIFIED PRODUCT. No modifications permitted without reference to the Ex-certifying Authorities. Safety parameters listed (for HART/Fieldbus Model) apply only to associated apparatus with linear output. 1. Notes : The approved values of maximum open circuit voltage (Uo) and maximum short circuit current (Io) and maximum output power (or Uo x Io / 4), for the associated apparatus must be less than or equal to the maximum safe input voltage (Ui), maximum safe input current (Ii), and maximum safe input power (Pi) of the intrinsically safe apparatus. In addition, the approved maximum allowable connected capacitance (Co) of the associated apparatus must be greater than the sum of the interconnecting cable capacitance and the unprotected internal capacitance (Ci) of the intrinsically safe apparatus, and the approved maximum allowable connected inductance (Lo) of the associated apparatus must be greater than the sum of the interconnecting cable inductance and the unprotected internal inductance (Li) of the intrinsically safe apparatus. INTRINSICALLY SAFE INSTALLATIONS POWER SUPPLY ACCOCIATED APPARATUS NON-HAZARDOUS LOCATION ORIGINAL SIZE A3 1048 ISSUE 0346 WEEK SME-3444 SME-6440 CH. ORDER No SME-7230 SME-6440 CH. ORDER No 1217 ISSUE 0511 WEEK ISSUE WEEK 0548 1409 SME-5236 SME-7653 CH. ORDER No SME-5515 CH. ORDER No 0644 WEEK ALL DIMENSIONS ARE IN MILLIMETRES. 0346 6 PDF FILE 1 ST ANGLE ISSUE The copyright/ownership of this document is and will remain ours. The document must not be used without our authorization or brought to the knowledge of a third party. Contravention will be prosecuted. Rosemount Tank Radar AB, Sweden 9150 079-907 DWG NO. 1/1 SHEET for hazardous location installation of ATEX and IECEx approved apparatus INSTALLATION DRAWING TITLE -50 <= Ta <= 60 deg C -50 <= Ta <= 60 deg C AmEient Temperature Limits -50 <= Ta <= 70 deg C 00809-0100-4026, Rev HA 1:1 SCALE FINISH, UNLESS OTHERWISE STATED: DOC. TYPE GU-PO PRODUCT CODE 0346 5400 WEEK APPROVED BY WEEK Parameters Ui <= 30V, Ii <= 130 mA Pi <= 1W, Ci = 7.26 nF, Li = 0 Ui <= 30V, Ii <= 300 mA Pi <= 1.5W, Ci = 4.95nF, Li = 0 Ui <= 17.5V, Ii <= 380 mA Pi <= 5.32W, Ci = 4.95nF, Li = 0 GU-LN ISSUED BY Fieldbus FISCO IS Model Fieldbus IS Model 4-20 mA/HART IS Model Model Intrinsic Safety Parameters : Ƒ,,*([LD,,&7*DRUƑ,,*([LE,,&7*D*E,,'([WD,,,&'D 5. ½” NPT threads need to be sealed for dust and water ingress protection, IP 66, IP 67 or ‘Ex t’, EPL Da or Db is required. 4. The Ex ia version of model 5400 may be supplied by an Ex ib certified safety barrier. The whole circuit shall then be regarded type Ex ib. The preferred type Ex ia or Ex ib shall be indicated on the marking label as specified in the instructions for the transmitter. The antenna part, located in the process vessel, is classified EPL Ga and electrically separated from the Ex ia or ib circuit. 3. The antennas for type 5400, are non-conducting and the area of the non-conducting part exceeds the maximum permissible areas for Group IIC and according to IEC 60079-0 .2011 clause 7.4: 20 cm2 for EPL Gb and 4 cm2 for EPL Ga. Therefore, when the antenna is used in a potentially explosive atmosphere, appropriate measures must be taken to prevent electrostatic discharge. 2. “Potential ignition hazards by impact or friction need to be considered according to IEC 60079-0:2011 clause 8.3 (for EPL Ga and EPL Gb) and clause 8.4 (for EPL Da and EPL Db) , when the transmitter enclosure and antennas exposed to the exterior atmosphere of the tank, is made with light metals containing aluminium or titanium. The end used shall determine the suitability with regard to avoid hazards from impact and friction.” 1. The intrinsically safe circuits do not withstand the 500V AC test as specified in IEC 60079-11 clause 6.4.13. SPECIFIC CONDITIONS FOR SAFE USE (X) : ISSUE 9150 079-907 Reference Manual Appendix B: Product certifications November 2014 Figure B-3. Installation Drawing for Hazardous Location Installation of ATEX and IECEx Approved Apparatus 233 234 POWER SUPPLY POWER SUPPLY Barrier Uo: 42.4 V Io: 23 mA Po: 1 W Lo > 0 Co > 7.25 nF Ui: 42.4 V Ii: 23 mA Pi: 1 W Li: Negligible Ci: 7.25 nF HART: 42.4 VDC , 23 mA FOUNDATION FIELDBUS: 32 VDC, 21 mA Note 1 Note 1 HAZARDOUS LOCATION 2011-06-28 14:34 9240031-958_I02_P01_A3.DOCX SME-5859 WEEK 1041 WEEK EAP APPROVED BY EE-VM ISSUED BY FILE DOC. TYPE 5400 PRODUCT CODE Rosemount Tank Radar AB, Sweden The copyright/ownership of this document is and will remain ours. The document must not be used without our authorization or brought to the knowledge of a third party. Contravention will be prosecuted. 1041 Word WEEK 1041 WEEK No modifications permitted without reference to the Ex-certifying Authorities. 9240031-958 DOC NO. ISSUE 1/1 PAGE INSTALLATION DRAWING Exn ROSEMOUNT 5400 SERIES TITLE –50 ≤ Ta ≤ 60 °C Ui = 32 V, Ii = 21 mA, Pi = 0.7 W Ci = 4.95 nF, Li: Negligible FOUNDATION FIELDBUS WEEK EX-CERTIFIED PRODUCT –50 ≤ Ta ≤ 70 °C Ambient Temperature Limits Ui = 42.4 V, Ii = 23 mA, Pi = 1.0 W Ci = 7.25 nF, Li: Negligible Parameters CURRENT LOOP / HART Model Input parameters for Energy Limited –50 ≤ Ta ≤ 60 °C 32 VDC, 21 mA FOUNDATION FIELDBUS MODIF. ORDER NO. –50 ≤ Ta ≤ 70 °C ISSUE 42.4 VDC, 23 mA, 1126 CURRENT LOOP / HART SME-6864 MODIF. ORDER NO. Ambient Temperature Limits ISSUE Parameters Model Input parameters for Non-sparking MODIF. ORDER NO. ISSUE November 2014 Notes: Connect supply wires to the appropriate terminals as indicated on the terminal block label and in the installation documents. nL nA NON-HAZARDOUS LOCATION ORIGINAL SIZE A3 Appendix B: Product certifications 00809-0100-4026, Rev HA Reference Manual Figure B-4. Installation drawing Ex n Rosemount 5400 Series Product Certifications Reference Manual Appendix B: Product certifications 00809-0100-4026, Rev HA November 2014 Figure B-5. Installation Drawing for Hazardous Location Installation of TIIS Approved Apparatus ᅜෆ(TIIS)㜵⇿ᵝ 1) ᑐ㇟ᶵჾ 㜵⇿グྕ ᐃ ᱁ 㸺5401/5402㸼 ධຊ㒊 Ex d [ia] IIC T4 X, ᮏᏳᅇ㊰ Uo = 22.2V ಙྕኚ㒊ཬࡧࣥࢸࢼ Ex ia IIC T4 X Io = 177mA Po = 0.985W 㠀ᮏᏳᅇ㊰ 㟁※ DC 20~42.4V/4-20mA, DC 16~32V/ Fieldbus チᐜ㟁ᅽ AC 250V 50/60Hz, DC250V ࿘ᅖ ᗘ -20Υ㹼60Υ ࢩࢫࢸ࣒ᵓᡂᅗ 2) 1) ὀ㸸ᨵ㐀⚗Ṇࠋ 㟼㟁Ẽ㜵Ṇࡢࡓࡵࣥࢸࢼ㒊ࡢᣔࡁ⚗Ṇࠋ Ⓨⅆ㜵Ṇࡢࡓࡵ㔠ᒓ㒊ࡢ⾪ᧁࡲࡓࡣᦶ᧿⚗Ṇࠋ ᥋ᆅ➃Ꮚࡣ㠀༴㝤ሙᡤ࠾࠸࡚ࠊ༢⊂࡛ A ✀᥋ᆅᕤ‽ࡌ࡚᥋ᆅࡍࡿࡇࠋ ⇿Ⓨᛶ࢞ࢫࡲࡓࡣẼࡀᏑᅾࡍࡿሙᡤ࡛ࡣ࢝ࣂ࣮㛤ᨺ⚗Ṇࠋ እ㒊ᑟ⥺ࡣ⪏⇕ ᗘ 70Υ௨ୖࡢࢣ࣮ࣈࣝࢆ⏝ࡍࡿࡇࠋ 05400-00375B 2) ୍⯡ᅇ㊰(㟁※ཬࡧධฟຊ)ࡣࡑࡢධຊ㟁※,ᶵჾෆ㒊ࡢ㟁ᅽ➼ࡀṇᖖ≧ែ࠾ࡼࡧ␗ᖖ≧ែ࠾࠸࡚ࡶ AC/DC250V 50/60Hz ࢆ㉸࠼࡞࠸ࡶࡢࡍࡿࠋ ᮏᏳ⏝᥋ᆅ➃Ꮚࡣ㠀༴㝤ሙᡤ࠾࠸࡚༢⊂࡛ $ ✀᥋ᆅࡍࡿࠋ Product Certifications 235 Appendix B: Product certifications Reference Manual November 2014 00809-0100-4026, Rev HA 236 Product Certifications Appendix C: Advanced configuration Reference Manual November 2014 00809-0100-4026, Rev HA Appendix C Advanced Configuration Tank geometry . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . page 237 Advanced analog output settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . page 239 Advanced transmitter settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . page 239 Advanced functions in RRM . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . page 243 The advanced transmitter configuration includes settings which can be used to fine tune the transmitter for special applications. Normally, the standard settings are sufficient. C.1 Tank geometry Figure C-1. Advanced Tank Geometry Tank reference point Distance offset (G) Upper reference point Hold off distance Tank height (R) Product level Min level offset (C) C.1.1 Lower reference point (Level = 0) Distance offset (G) The Distance Offset is used when hand-dipping is done at a separate nozzle. By setting the Distance Offset the measured level by the gauge can be adjusted to correspond with the level value obtained by hand-dipping. The Distance Offset (G) is the distance between the upper reference point and the flange. (The flange is referred to as the Transmitter’s Reference Point). The Distance Offset can be used to specify a reference point at the top of the tank. Set the Distance Offset to zero to identify the lower side of the device flange as the upper reference point. The Distance Offset is defined as positive if an upper reference point above the Upper Reference Point is used. Advanced Configuration 237 Appendix C: Advanced configuration C.1.2 Reference Manual 00809-0100-4026, Rev HA November 2014 Minimum level offset (C) The Minimum Level Offset (C) defines a lower null zone which extends the measurement range beyond the Lower Reference Point to the tank bottom. The Minimum Level Offset is the distance between the Lower Reference Point (Level = 0) and the minimum accepted level at the tank bottom. Set the Minimum Level Offset to zero to use the tank bottom as the Lower Reference Point. This case corresponds to the standard tank geometry configuration. Note that the tank height must be measured to the Lower Reference Point regardless if it is located at the tank bottom, or at an elevated point. C.1.3 Hold off distance This parameter should only be changed if there are disturbing objects close to the antenna. No valid measurements are possible above the Hold Off Distance. By increasing the Hold Off Distance, the measuring range is reduced. See “Hold off setting” on page 250 for more information. C.1.4 Calibration distance The Calibration Distance is defaulted to zero. It is used to adjust the transmitter so measured levels match hand-dipped or otherwise known product levels. Normally, a minor adjustment is necessary. There may, for example, be a deviation between the actual tank height and the value from tank drawings, which are usually stored in the transmitter database. Non-metallic (for example, plastic) vessels and installation geometry may introduce an offset for the zero reference point. This offset may be up to ± 10 mm. The offset can be compensated for using Calibration Distance. 238 Advanced Configuration Appendix C: Advanced configuration Reference Manual November 2014 00809-0100-4026, Rev HA C.2 Advanced analog output settings The 20 mA Upper Range Value should be outside the Hold Off Distance (see “Hold off distance” on page 238) in order to utilize the full range of the analog output. Figure C-2. Advanced Range Value Settings Upper reference point Hold off distance Product level Range 0-100 % 20 mA Upper Range Value (URV) 4 mA Lower Range Value (LRV) Min level offset (C) Lower reference point (Level = 0) C.3 Advanced transmitter settings C.3.1 Antenna type The transmitter is designed to optimize measurement performance for each available antenna type. This parameter is pre-configured at factory but may need to be set if a non-standard antenna is used. C.3.2 Empty tank handling The Empty Tank Handling functions handle situations when the surface echo is close to the tank bottom: Tracking of weak product echoes Handling lost echoes If the surface echo is lost, this function has the transmitter present a zero-level measurement. An alarm is activated unless the alarm has been blocked. Advanced Configuration 239 Appendix C: Advanced configuration Reference Manual 00809-0100-4026, Rev HA November 2014 Empty tank detection area The Empty Tank Detection Area is the range within a lower limit of 16 in. (400 mm) and a higher limit of 39 in. (1000 mm) above the tank bottom. If the surface echo is lost in this region, the tank is considered empty (the device enters Empty Tank State) and the transmitter presents a zero level reading. If the tank is empty, the transmitter searches double the Empty Tank Detection Area for the product surface. When a new echo is found, it is considered to be the product surface. It is important that there are no disturbances in this area, but if there are, they may need to be filtered out. This function requires the Bottom Echo Visible function to be disabled. The current Empty Tank Detection Area value is shown in Advanced Setup in RRM and can be adjusted manually, if required. See “Empty tank detection area” on page 244. Bottom echo visible Only set this parameter if the bottom echo is visible. Setting this parameter will use the bottom echo as a disturbance echo to facilitate tracking of weak surface echoes close to the tank bottom. Check that the gauge detects the tank bottom when the tank is empty before activating this function. See “Bottom echo visible” on page 243. Tank bottom projection This function handles situations close to the tank bottom and may enhance measurement performance in the tank bottom region. In this region, the signal from the actual tank bottom may be significantly stronger than the measurement signal from the product surface, in some situations. Extra echo Extra Echo Detection is used for tanks with domed or conical bottom types and when there is no strong echo from the tank bottom when the tank is empty and an echo beneath the actual tank bottom can sometimes be seen. See “Extra echo function” on page 245. Level alarm is not set when tank is empty If the echo from the product is lost in the area close to the tank bottom (Empty Tank Detection Area), the device enters Empty Tank State and triggers an alarm. Two types of alarms are triggered: 240 Invalid Level (can be seen in the Diagnostics window) The Analog Output enters Alarm Mode Advanced Configuration Reference Manual Appendix C: Advanced configuration 00809-0100-4026, Rev HA C.3.3 November 2014 Full tank handling Full tank detection area This parameter defines a range where the surface echo can be lost. If the echo is lost in this range, the tank is considered full (the device enters Full Tank State) and the device presents maximum level indication. When the tank is full, the device searches double the Full Tank Detection Area for the product surface. When a new echo is found in this range, it is identified as the product surface. It is important to filter out any disturbances in this area. Level above hold off distance possible This function should be enabled if the level can rise above the Hold Off Distance/UNZ and it is necessary to display the tank as full in that case. Normally, the device will be able to track the surface and the product level will never rise to that height. If the function is not enabled and the surface is lost at the top of the tank, the device searches the whole tank for a surface echo. Note Measurements are not performed within the Hold Off Distance/UNZ region. Level alarm is not set when tank is full If the surface echo is lost, close to the top of the tank. The level value will normally be displayed as “invalid.” This parameter should be set to suppress the “invalid” display. Note Setting this parameter disables the analog output so it does not enter alarm mode for invalid levels close to the antenna. See “Full tank handling” on page 247 for more information. C.3.4 Double bounce Some radar waves are reflected at the surface and then reflected against the tank roof and back to the surface before being detected by the transmitter. Normally, these signals have a low amplitude and are ignored by the transmitter. For spherical and horizontal cylinder tanks however, the amplitude may be strong enough for the transmitter to interpret the double bounce as the surface echo. Setting the Double Bounce Possible parameter can solve this type of measurement situation. This function should only be used if double bounces cannot be corrected by changing the mechanical installation. See “Double bounce” on page 248 for more information. Advanced Configuration 241 Appendix C: Advanced configuration C.3.5 Reference Manual 00809-0100-4026, Rev HA November 2014 Surface echo tracking Slow search This variable controls how to search for the surface when a surface echo is lost. With this parameter set, the transmitter starts searching for the surface at the last known level and gradually increases the search region until the surface is found. If this variable is not set, the transmitter searches the whole tank. This parameter is typically used for tanks with turbulent conditions. Slow search speed This parameter indicates the speed the search region (Slow Search window) is expanded when the Slow Search function is active. Double surface Indicates that there are two liquids or foam in the tank resulting in two reflecting surfaces. The upper liquid or foam layer must be partially transparent to the radar signal. The Select Lower Surface parameter specifies the surface layer selected as the surface. Upper product dielectric constant This is the dielectric constant for the upper product if there is a double surface situation. A more precise value results in better accuracy for the lower surface level. Select lower surface This function should only be used if Double Surface is set. If Select Lower Surface is set, the lower surface is identified as the product surface. If not, the upper surface is used. Echo timeout Echo Timeout defines the time, in seconds, after the echo has been lost, before the transmitter starts searching for a surface echo. The transmitter will not start searching, or trigger any alarms, until this time has elapsed. Close distance window This parameter defines a window centered at the current surface position where new surface echo candidates can be selected. The size of the window is ±CloseDist. Echoes outside this window will not be considered surface echoes and the transmitter will jump to the strongest echo inside this window. If there are rapid level changes in the tank, the value of the Close Distance Window can be increased to prevent the transmitter from missing level changes. On the other hand, a large value may cause the transmitter to select an invalid echo as the surface echo. 242 Advanced Configuration Appendix C: Advanced configuration Reference Manual November 2014 00809-0100-4026, Rev HA C.3.6 Filter settings Damping value The Damping Value parameter determines how quickly the transmitter responds to level changes and how robust the measurement signal is against noise. A damping value of 10 indicates that in 10 seconds the output from the transmitter is approximately 63 % of the new level value. Consequently, when there are rapid level changes in the tank, it may be necessary to decrease the Damping Value for the transmitter to track the surface. In noisy environments, with low level rates, it may be best to increase the damping value for a stable output signal. Activate jump filter The Jump Filter is typically used for turbulent surface applications where it smooths the echo tracking as the level passes, for example, an agitator. If the surface echo is lost and a new surface echo is found, the Jump Filter has the transmitter wait before jumping to the new echo so it can be validated. During that time the new echo has to be considered a valid echo. C.4 Advanced functions in RRM C.4.1 Empty tank handling Bottom echo visible The Bottom Echo Visible... parameter allows the transmitter to separate the product surface from the tank bottom by identifying the bottom echo as a disturbance echo. This is useful for products relatively transparent for microwaves, such as oil. For non-transparent products, such as water, there is no visible bottom echo until the tank is empty. To enable this function: 1. Disable the Use Automatic Empty Tank Handling Settings option. 2. Select the Bottom Echo Visible if Tank is Empty check-box. Only use this function for tanks with a Flat bottom type where the radar echo from the tank bottom is clearly visible. If there is no distinct bottom echo, even if the tank is empty, this parameter should be disabled. Otherwise, if the surface echo is temporarily lost, the transmitter starts searching for the product surface in the tank and may incorrectly interpret any object as the surface. The spectrum function in the RRM program can be used to check if the gauge detects the tank bottom in an empty tank. Advanced Configuration 243 Reference Manual Appendix C: Advanced configuration 00809-0100-4026, Rev HA November 2014 Amplitude Distance Surface echo Echo from tank bottom Empty tank detection area If the signal from the product surface is lost within the region given by the parameter Empty Tank Detection Area, the tank is considered empty and the product level is presented as zero. If the surface is lost above the Empty Tank Detection Area, the transmitter starts searching the entire tank for the surface. The Empty Tank Detection Area can be increased if the surface is lost outside the Empty Tank Detection Area in a non-critical region of the tank. 244 1. Disable Use Automatic Empty Tank Handling Settings. 2. Type the desired value in the Empty Tank Detection Area input field. Advanced Configuration Appendix C: Advanced configuration Reference Manual November 2014 00809-0100-4026, Rev HA Amplitude Distance If the product surface is lost in this region, the tank is considered empty. See “Empty tank detection area” on page 240 for further information. Extra echo function The Extra Echo Detection function makes for more robust measurements in the bottom region for conical or domed bottom shape tanks. In this case, there is no strong echo from the tank bottom when the tank is empty, and a virtual echo beneath the actual tank bottom can sometimes be seen. If the transmitter is unable to detect the tank bottom, this function can ensure that the transmitter stays in Empty Tank state as long as an extra echo is present. When the tank is empty, use the spectrum function in RRM to verify if such an echo exists or not by entering a distance that exceeds the tank bottom. The suitable values for Extra Echo Min Distance, Extra Echo Max Distance and Extra Echo Min Amplitude can also be viewed in the spectrum. The tank is considered empty when an echo is within the minimum and maximum distance and the amplitude is above the specified limit. Advanced Configuration 245 Reference Manual Appendix C: Advanced configuration 00809-0100-4026, Rev HA November 2014 Amplitude Distance Extra echo min. distance Extra echo max. distance 246 Advanced Configuration Appendix C: Advanced configuration Reference Manual November 2014 00809-0100-4026, Rev HA C.4.2 Full tank handling With the Full Tank Handling function product levels close to the antenna can be reported as a Full Tank. Normally, measurements are not allowed closer to the antenna than specified by the Hold Off Distance parameter. If the product level enters the Hold Off Distance region, the transmitter reports Measurement Error and starts searching for the surface. By setting the Level above Hold Off Distance possible parameter, the transmitter reports Full Tank when the product level enters the Hold Off Distance region. Note that: The region where the tank is considered full is specified by the Full Tank Detection Area The level alarm for Full Tank is normally disabled If the product surface is lost in this region, the transmitter presents full tank. Hold off distance Amplitude Full tank detection area Distance Advanced Configuration 247 Reference Manual Appendix C: Advanced configuration 00809-0100-4026, Rev HA November 2014 C.4.3 Double bounce A double bounce echo is an echo that has been reflected against the tank roof then down to the surface before being detected by the transmitter. Double bounces are commonly present in spherical or horizontal cylinder tanks. In this case, the tank roof can sometimes amplify the double bounce echo amplitude. Normally, double bounce echoes appear when the tank is 60-70 % full. In these cases, the double bounce echo can cause the transmitter to lock onto the wrong echo. The Double Bounce function is used for managing problems with echoes appearing in the tank because of the tank shape stronger than the surface echo itself. The Double Bounce Offset is given by the following formula: Double Bounce Offset = B - 2*A, where A is the distance from the Tank Reference Point to the product surface, and B is the distance from the Tank Reference Point to the Double Bounce echo. In many cases, the Double Bounce Offset is given by the height of the nozzle. Note that the surface echo is required to suppress the double bounce. If the surface echo enters the hold off distance region, there is no product surface reference and the double bounce might be interpreted as the surface echo. Amplitude Distance Double bounce offset=B - 2*A 248 Advanced Configuration Appendix C: Advanced configuration Reference Manual November 2014 00809-0100-4026, Rev HA C.4.4 Surface echo tracking The Surface Echo Tracking function can eliminate ghost echo problems below the product surface. This may occur in Still-pipes because of multiple reflections between the pipe wall, flange, and antenna. In the tank spectrum, these echoes appear as amplitude peaks at various distances below the product surface. To activate this function, select the Always Track First Echo check-box making sure there are no disturbing echoes above the product surface when this function is activated. First echo corresponding to the product surface Amplitude Surface Distance Advanced Configuration 249 Appendix C: Advanced configuration C.4.5 Reference Manual 00809-0100-4026, Rev HA November 2014 Hold off setting The Hold Off parameter is set to a default value that rarely needs any adjustment (see “Hold off distance” on page 238 for definition of Hold Off distance). The Process Seal antenna is slightly more affected by disturbances in the nozzle than the cone and rod antennas. If necessary, a small Hold Off adjustment may be sufficient to solve the problem. In a typical situation, a small object, such as a weld joint, may give rise to a disturbing echo. If this disturbance is strong enough, the transmitter may misinterpret this echo as the product surface. By setting the Hold Off large enough to avoid a measurement within and close to the nozzle, the problem is solved, as illustrated below. The Spectrum Plot function in RRM allows for adjustment to the Hold Off distance: SPECTRUM ANALYZER 1. In RRM, click the Spectrum Plot icon to open the Spectrum Analyzer window. 2. Select the Configuration Mode tab. 3. Click the Read button and view the amplitude versus distance graph. If there is a disturbance caused by an object in the nozzle, the transmitter may misinterpret the position of the surface, as shown to the left. In this example, the true surface position is at amplitude peak P3. 4. Move the Hold Off distance line away from the transmitter i.e. to a position below the nozzle. Hold Off Hold off 5. Click the Store button. 6. The transmitter will now disregard any disturbing echoes in the nozzle and find the product surface. 250 Advanced Configuration Appendix D: Performing proof test Reference Manual November 2014 00809-0100-4026, Rev HA Appendix D Performing Proof Test Performing proof test . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . page 251 Field communicator . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . page 251 RRM . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . page 253 AMS Suite . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . page 255 D.1 Performing proof test This test detects approximately 95 % of the possible Dangerously Undetected (DU) failures of the transmitter including the sensor element. Here is a description of how to perform the test using a Field Communicator, RRM, or AMS® Suite. Note that the transmitter is not safety-rated during proof tests. Alternative means should be used to ensure process safety during such activities. Required tools: HART® host/communicator and a mA meter. D.2 Field communicator Prior to this test, inspect the echo curve to ensure that no disturbing echoes affecting the measurement performance are present. HART Sequence: [2, 6, 1] 1. Bypass the safety PLC or take other appropriate actions to avoid false trip. 2. Disable write protection if the function is enabled. HART Sequence: [3, 2, 1, 2, 1]. Type the password. 3. Using loop test, enter the mA value representing the high alarm current. Verify that the analog output current is correct using the reference meter. This step tests for compliance voltage problems, such as low power supply voltage or increased wiring resistance. HART Sequence: [2, 4, 1, 7]. Select 3 Other. Enter the analog output level representing the high alarm current. Press Enter and click OK. Verify that the analog output current is correct. Click Abort to end loop test. 4. Using loop test, enter the mA value representing the low alarm current. Verify that the analog output current is correct using the reference meter. This step tests for possible quiescent current related failures. HART Sequence: [2, 4, 1, 7]. Select 3 Other. Enter the analog output level representing the low alarm current. Press Enter and click OK. Verify that the analog output current is correct. Click Abort to end loop test. Verify that the Current output is restored to the original mode. Performing Proof Test 251 Reference Manual Appendix D: Performing proof test 00809-0100-4026, Rev HA November 2014 Figure D-1. Range Values Upper Reference Point Hold Off Distance Product Level Range 0-100 % 20 mA Upper Range Value (URV) 4 mA Lower Range Value (LRV) Min Level Offset (C) 5. Lower Reference Point (Level=0) Perform a two-point calibration check of the transmitter by applying level at two points within the measuring range. Verify that the current output corresponds to the level input values using a known reference measurement. This step verifies that the analog output is correct in the operating range and that the Primary Variable is properly configured. Note that the applied level has to be between the Upper and Lower Range values, otherwise the transmitter enters alarm mode. If the applied level is outside the Maximum Measuring Range, the level reading accuracy may be reduced. For best performance, use the 4-20 mA range points as calibration points. See Figure 1. 6. Enable write protection. HART Sequence: [3, 2, 1, 2, 1]. 252 7. Restore the loop to full operation. 8. Remove the bypass from the safety PLC or otherwise restore normal operation. 9. Document the test results for future reference. Performing Proof Test Appendix D: Performing proof test Reference Manual November 2014 00809-0100-4026, Rev HA D.3 RRM Prior to this test, inspect the echo curve to ensure that no disturbing echoes affecting the measurement performance are present. RRM: Tools / Echo Curve 1. Bypass the safety PLC or take other appropriate actions to avoid false trip. 2. Disable write protection if the function is enabled. RRM: Select Tools, Lock / Unlock Configuration Area from the menu. Type the password being used for this device and click OK. 3. Set Alarm mode to High Current. Using loop test, enter the mA value representing the high alarm current. Verify that the analog output current is correct using the reference meter. This step tests for compliance voltage problems, such as low power supply voltage or increased wiring resistance. RRM: Select Setup, Output from the menu. Alarm Mode AOut 1 Loop test... Make sure Alarm Mode AOut 1 is set to High Current. Click Store to save changes. Click Loop test... and enter the Current AOut 1 value representing the high alarm current. Click Start and verify that the output current is correct. Click Stop to end loop test. 4. Set Alarm mode to Low Current. Using loop test, enter the mA value representing the low alarm current. Verify that the analog output current is correct using the reference meter. This step tests for possible quiescent current related failures. RRM: Set Alarm Mode AOut 1 to Low Current. Click Store to save changes. Click Loop test... and enter the Current AOut 1 value representing the low alarm current. Click Start and verify that the output current is correct. Click Stop to end loop test. Performing Proof Test 253 Appendix D: Performing proof test Reference Manual 00809-0100-4026, Rev HA November 2014 5. Restore the Alarm mode to the original mode used in the loop. Verify that the analog output current is correct. RRM: Set Alarm Mode AOut 1 to original mode. Click Store to save changes. Verify that the output current is correct. 6. Perform a two-point calibration check of the transmitter by applying level at two points within the measuring range. Verify that the current output corresponds to the level input values using a known reference measurement. This step verifies that the analog output is correct in the operating range and that the Primary Variable is properly configured. Note that the applied level has to be between the Upper and Lower Range values, otherwise the transmitter enters alarm mode. If the applied level is outside the Maximum Measuring Range, the level reading accuracy may be reduced. For best performance, use the 4-20 mA range points as calibration points. See Figure 1 on page 252. 7. Enable write protection. RRM: Select Tools, Lock / Unlock Configuration Area from the menu. 254 8. Restore the loop to full operation. 9. Remove the bypass from the safety PLC or otherwise restore normal operation. 10. Document the test results for future reference. Performing Proof Test Appendix D: Performing proof test Reference Manual November 2014 00809-0100-4026, Rev HA D.4 AMS Suite Prior to this test, inspect the echo curve to ensure that no disturbing echoes affecting the measurement performance are present. AMS: Click Configure / Setup / Echo Curve 1. Bypass the safety PLC or take other appropriate actions to avoid false trip. 2. Disable write protection if the function is enabled. AMS: Select Device Diagnostics/ Tools from the left menu, and choose the General tab. Write Protect... Click Write Protect... and follow the instructions. (Note that the password cannot be written with letters.) 3. Using loop test, enter the mA value representing the high alarm current. Verify that the analog output current is correct using the reference meter. This step tests for compliance voltage problems, such as low power supply voltage or increased wiring resistance. AMS: Select Configure / Setup, Analog Output from the menu. Loop Test... Performing Proof Test 255 Appendix D: Performing proof test Reference Manual 00809-0100-4026, Rev HA November 2014 Click Loop Test... Select Other and enter the mA value representing the high Analog Output Level and follow the instructions. Verify that the output current is correct. 4. Using loop test, enter the mA value representing the low alarm mode. Verify that the analog output current is correct using the reference meter. This step tests for possible quiescent current related failures. AMS: Select Configure / Setup, Analog Output from the menu. Click Loop Test... Select Other and enter the mA value representing the low Analog Output Level and follow the instructions. Click OK to save changes. Verify that the output current is correct. Select End to stop loop test. Verify that the Current output is restored to the original mode. 5. Perform a two-point calibration check of the transmitter by applying level at two points within the measuring range. Verify that the current output corresponds to the level input values using a known reference measurement. This step verifies that the analog output is correct in the operating range and that the Primary Variable is properly configured. Note that the applied level has to be between the Upper and Lower Range values, otherwise the transmitter enters alarm mode. If the applied level is outside the Maximum Measuring Range, the level reading accuracy may be reduced. For best performance, use the 4-20 mA range points as calibration points. See Figure 1 on page 252. 6. Enable write protection. AMS: Select Configure / Manual Setup from the menu, choose the Device tab, check Write Protected, and follow the instructions. (Note that the password cannot be written with letters.) 256 7. Restore the loop to full operation. 8. Remove the bypass from the safety PLC or otherwise restore normal operation. 9. Document the test results for future reference. Performing Proof Test Appendix E: Level transducer block Reference Manual November 2014 00809-0100-4026, Rev HA Appendix E Level Transducer Block Overview . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . page 257 Parameters and descriptions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . page 258 Supported units . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . page 263 Diagnostics device errors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . page 264 E.1 Overview This section contains information on the Rosemount 5400 Series Transducer Block (TB). Descriptions of all Transducer Block parameters, errors, and diagnostics are listed. E.1.1 Definition The transducer block contains the actual measurement data, including a level and distance reading. Channels 1–6 are assigned to these measurements. The transducer block includes information about sensor type, engineering units, and all parameters needed to configure the radar gauge. E.1.2 Channel definitions Each input has an assigned channel which can be linked to the AI block. The channels for the Rosemount 5400 Series are the following: Table E-1. Channel Assignments Channel name Level Ullage Level Rate Signal Strength Volume Internal Temperature Level Transducer Block Channel number Process variable RADAR_LEVEL RADAR_ULLAGE RADAR_LEVELRATE RADAR_LEVEL_SIGNAL_STRENGTH RADAR_VOLUME RADAR_INTERNAL_TEMPERATURE 257 Reference Manual Appendix E: Level transducer block 00809-0100-4026, Rev HA November 2014 E.2 Parameters and descriptions Table E-2. Level Transducer Block Parameters and Descriptions Parameter Index number ST_REV TAG_DESC STRATEGY ALERT_KEY MODE_BLK Default value The revision level of the static data associated with the function block. The revision value increments each time a static parameter value in the block is changed. The user description of the intended application of the block. The strategy field can be used to identify grouping of blocks. This data is not checked or processed by the block. The identification number of the plant unit. This information may be used in the host for sorting alarms, etc. The actual, target, permitted, and normal modes of the block. 0x08(Auto) 0x08(Auto) 0x88(Auto | OOS) 0x08(Auto) BLOCK_ERR UPDATE_EVT BLOCK_ALM TRANSDUCER_DIRECTORY TRANSDUCER_TYPE XD_ERROR 10 11 0x8180(0x8180) 0x00(No error) COLLECTION_DIRECTORY 12 TRANSDUCER_TYPE_VER RADAR_LEVEL 13 14 258 Description 0x0000(0x0000) 769 • Target: The mode to “go to” • Actual: The mode the “block is currently in” • Permitted: Allowed modes that target may take on • Normal: Most common mode for target This parameter reflects the error status associated with the hardware or software components associated with a block. It is a bit string, so that multiple errors may be shown. This alert is generated by any change to the static data. The block alarm is used for all configuration, hardware, connection failure, or system problems in the block. The cause of the alert is entered in the subcode field. The first alert to become active will set the Active status in the Status parameter. As soon as the Unreported status is cleared by the alert reporting task, another block alert may be reported without clearing the Active status, if the subcode has changed. Directory that specifies the number and starting indices of the transducers in the transducer block. Identifies the transducer. A transducer block alarm subcode. A directory that specifies the number, starting indices, and DD Item ID’s of the data collections in each transducer within a transducer block. Transducer type version = 0x0301 Level Level Transducer Block Appendix E: Level transducer block Reference Manual November 2014 00809-0100-4026, Rev HA Parameter Index number RADAR_LEVEL_RANGE 15 RADAR_ULLAGE RADAR_LEVELRATE 16 17 RADAR_LEVELRATE_RANGE 18 RADAR_LEVEL_SIGNAL_STRENGTH 19 RADAR_LEVEL_SIGNAL_STRENGTH_RANGE 20 RADAR_VOLUME 21 RADAR_VOLUME_RANGE 22 RADAR_INTERNAL_TEMPERATURE 23 RADAR_INTERNAL_TEMPERATURE_ RANGE 24 ANTENNA_TYPE ANTENNA_TCL ANTENNA_PIPE_DIAM DAMP_VALUE SIGN_PROC_CONFIG ANTENNA_EXTENSION 25 26 27 28 29 30 LCD_PARAMETERS 31 LCD_LANGUAGE LCD_LENGTH_UNIT LCD_VOLUME_UNIT LCD_TEMPERATURE_UNIT LCD_VELOCITY_UNIT GEOM_DIST_OFFSET GEOM_TANK_HEIGHT GEOM_MIN_LEVEL_OFFSET GEOM_HOLD_OFF GEOM_CAL_DISTANCE GEOM_TANK_TYPE GEOM_TANK_BOTTOM_TYPE 32 33 34 35 36 37 38 39 40 41 42 43 Level Transducer Block Default value 100 0X03f2(m) 100 0X0425(m/s) 100 0x04db(mV) 100 0x040a(m) 100 0x03e9 0x00000000 0.1 0x00010000 0x00000000(None) 0x00000000(0x000000 00) 0x00000000(English) 0x00000000 0x00000000 0x00000000 0x00000000 20 0x00000000(Unknown) 0x00000000(Unknown) Description The following sub-elements are available: • EU_100 • EU_0 • UNITS_INDEX • DECIMAL Distance (Ullage) Level Rate The following sub-elements are available: • EU_100 • EU_0 • UNITS_INDEX • DECIMAL Signal strength The following sub-elements are available: • EU_100 • EU_0 • UNITS_INDEX • DECIMAL Volume The following sub-elements are available: • EU_100 • EU_0 • UNITS_INDEX • DECIMAL Internal Temperature The following sub-elements are available: • EU_100 • EU_0 • UNITS_INDEX • DECIMAL Antenna Type TCL (Tank Connection Length) Pipe Inner Diameter Damping value Enable pipe inner diameter Extended antenna Parameters to show Language on display Length unit on display Volume unit on display Temperature unit on display Velocity unit on display Distance Offset Tank Height (R) Minimum distance offset (C) Hold off distance Calibration Distance Tank type Tank bottom type 259 Reference Manual Appendix E: Level transducer block 00809-0100-4026, Rev HA November 2014 Parameter Index number ENV_ENVIRONMENT 44 ENV_PRESENTATION 45 ENV_DEVICE_MODE 46 ENV_DIELECTR_CONST ENV_WRITE_PROTECT DIAGN_DEV_ALERT DIAGN_VERSION DIAGN_REVISION DIAGN_DEVICE_ID DIAGN_DEVICE_MODEL DIAGN_COMPL_TANK STATS_ATTEMPTS STATS_FAILURES STATS_TIMEOUTS SENSOR_DIAGNOSTICS P1451_SLAVE_STATS P1451_HOST_STATS FF_SUPPORT_INFO HEART_BEAT_COUNT RADAR_LEVEL_TYPE 47 48 49 50 51 52 53 54 55 56 57 58 59 60 61 62 63 260 Default value 0x00000000(0x000000 00) 0x0c431000(Tank contains double bounces | Slow Search | Show negative level as zero | Don’t set invalid level when empty | Don’t set invalid level when full | Use jump filter) 0x00000000(Normal operation) 0x00000000(Unknown) 1D0 Description Process Condition Tank Presentation Service mode Dielectric constant Write protect Errors, Warnings, Status Gauge SW version P1451 revision Device ID for the gauge. Type of 5400. LF or HF The degree of complexity in the tank 0x0000006e(Level) Level Transducer Block Appendix E: Level transducer block Reference Manual November 2014 00809-0100-4026, Rev HA Table E-3. Antenna Type VALUE ANTENNA_TYPE 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 20 21 22 23 24 30 31 32 33 34 40 41 42 43 44 User defined Cone 2” Cone 3” Cone 4” Cone 6” Cone 8” Process Seal 2” Process Seal 3” Process Seal 4” Antenna A0 Antenna A1 Antenna A2 Antenna A3 Rod 4” / 100 mm Rod 10” / 250 mm Antenna B3 Antenna B4 Antenna B5 Cone 2” Exotic Cone 3” Exotic Cone 4” Exotic Cone 6” Exotic Cone 8” Exotic Antenna D1 Antenna D2 Antenna D3 Antenna D4 Antenna D5 Table E-4. Device Mode VALUE ENV_DEVICE_MODE Normal operation Spare Restart device Set to factory default database Table E-5. Tank Environment Bit Number Value of ENV_ENVIRONMENT DESCRIPTION 0x00000001 0x00000002 0x00000004 0x00000008 0x00000010 0x00000020 Reserved Rapid Level Changes (> 40 mm/s, > 1.5 in/s) Reserved Turbulent Surface Foam Solid Product Level Transducer Block 261 Reference Manual Appendix E: Level transducer block 00809-0100-4026, Rev HA November 2014 Table E-6. Presentation Bit Number Value of ENV_PRESENTATION DESCRIPTION 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31 0x00000001 0x00000002 0x00000004 0x00000008 0x00000010 0x00000020 0x00000040 0x00000080 0x00000100 0x00000200 0x00000400 0x00000800 0x00001000 0x00002000 0x00004000 0x00008000 0x00010000 0x00020000 0x00040000 0x00080000 0x00100000 0x00200000 0x00400000 0x00800000 0x01000000 0x02000000 0x04000000 0x08000000 0x10000000 0x20000000 0x40000000 0x80000000 Reserved Level above min distance possible Predicting_Allowed Bottom echo always visible if tank is empty Tank contains double bounces Slow Search Enable double surface Select lower surface Bit 7, Reserved Show negative level as zero Bit 9, Reserved Bottom Projection Bit 11, Reserved Don't set invalid level in antenna zone Don't set invalid level when full Don't set invalid level when full Bit 15, Reserved Bit 16, Reserved Bit 17, Reserved Use jump filter Bit 19, Reserved Use Extra echo detection Always track first echo Bit 22, Reserved Bit 23, Reserved Calculate signal quality metrics Infinite alarm delay Bit 26, Reserved Bit 27, Reserved Bit 28, Reserved Bit 29, Reserved Bit 30, Reserved Table E-7. LCD Parameters 262 Bit Number Value of ENV_PRESENTATION DESCRIPTION 0x00000001 0x00000002 0x00000004 0x00000008 0x000000010 0x000000020 0x000000040 0x000000080 0x000000100 Reserved Level Distance Level Rate Signal Strength Volume Internal Temperature Bit 6, reserved Bit 7, reserved Level Transducer Block Appendix E: Level transducer block Reference Manual November 2014 00809-0100-4026, Rev HA Bit Number Value of ENV_PRESENTATION DESCRIPTION 10 11 0x000000200 0x000000400 0x000000800 Bit 8, reserved Bit 9, reserved Bit 10, reserved Table E-8. Tank Type VALUE GEOM_TANK_TYPE Unknown Vertical Cylinder Horisontal Cylinder Spherical Cubical Table E-9. Tank Bottom Type VALUE GEOM_TANK_BOTTOM_TYPE Unknown Flat Dome Cone Flat Inclined Table E-10. Dielectrical Constant DEVICE VALUE ENV_DIELECTR_CONST Unknown 1.9 - 2.5 (e.g. oil based) 2.5 - 4.0 (e.g. oil based) 4.0 - 10 (e.g. alcohols, acids) > 10 (e.g. water based) E.3 Supported units E.3.1 Unit codes Table E-11. Length Value Display Description 0(1) Default 1010 1012 1013 1018 1019 cm mm ft in Unit for LCD is the same as set in the value window meter centimeter millimeter feet inch (1) Default only for parameter LCD_LENGTH_UNIT. Level Transducer Block 263 Reference Manual Appendix E: Level transducer block 00809-0100-4026, Rev HA November 2014 Table E-12. Level Rate Value Display Description 0(1) Default 1061 1063 1067 1069 M/s M/h Ft/s In/m Unit for LCD is the same as set in the value window Meter per second Meter per hour Feet per second Inch per minute (1) Default only for parameter LCD_VELOCITY_UNIT. Table E-13. Temperature Value Display Description 0(1) Default 1001 1002 °C °F Unit for LCD is the same as set in the value window Degree Celsius Degree Fahrenheit (1) Default only for parameter LCD_TEMPERATURE_UNIT. Table E-14. Signal Strength Value Display Description 1243 mV millivolt Value Display Description 0(1) Default 1034 1038 1042 1043 1044 1048 1049 1051 M3 In3 Ft3 Yd3 Gallon ImpGall Bbl Table E-15. Volume Unit for LCD is the same as set in the value window Cubic meter Liter Cubic Inch Cubic feet Cubic yard US gallon Imperial gallon Barrel (oil) (1) Default only for parameter LCD_VOLUME_UNIT. E.4 Diagnostics device errors In addition to the BLOCK_ERR and XD_ERROR parameters, more detailed information on the measurement status can be obtained via SENSOR_DIAGNOSTICS. Table H-1 on page 282 lists the potential errors and the possible corrective actions for the given values. The corrective actions are in order of increasing system level compromises. The first step should always be to reset the gauge and then if the error persists, try the steps in Table H-1. Start with the first corrective action and then try the second. 264 Level Transducer Block Appendix F: Register transducer block Reference Manual November 2014 00809-0100-4026, Rev HA Appendix F Register Transducer Block Overview . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . page 265 F.1 Overview The Register Transducer Block allows access to Database registers and Input registers of the Rosemount 5400 transmitter. This makes it possible to read a selected set of registers directly by accessing the memory location. The Register Transducer Block is only available with advanced service. Since this Register Transducer Block allows access to most registers in the transmitter, which includes the registers set by the Methods and Configuration screens, in the Level Transducer Block (see Appendix E: Level Transducer Block) it should be handled with care and ONLY to be changed by trained and certified service personnel, or as guided by Emerson Process Management, Rosemount Business Unit support personnel. F.1.1 Register access transducer block parameters Table F-1. Register Access Transducer Block Parameters Parameter Index number Default value Description ST_REV The revision level of the static data associated with the function block. The revision value increments each time a static parameter value in the block is changed. TAG_DESC The user description of the intended application of the block. STRATEGY The strategy field can be used to identify grouping of blocks. This data is not checked or processed by the block. ALERT_KEY The identification number of the plant unit. This information may be used in the host for sorting alarms, etc. MODE_BLK BLOCK_ERR Register Transducer Block 0x08(Auto) 0x08(Auto) 0x88(Auto | OOS) 0x08(Auto) The actual, target, permitted, and normal modes of the block. Target: The mode to “go to” Actual: The mode the “block is currently in” Permitted: Allowed modes that target may take on Normal: Most common mode for target This parameter reflects the error status associated with the hardware or software components associated with a block. It is a bit string, so that multiple errors may be shown. 265 Reference Manual Appendix F: Register transducer block 00809-0100-4026, Rev HA November 2014 Parameter Index number UPDATE_EVT This alert is generated by any change to the static data. BLOCK_ALM The block alarm is used for all configuration, hardware, connection failure, or system problems in the block. The cause of the alert is entered in the subcode field. The first alert to become active will set the Active status in the Status parameter. As soon as the Unreported status is cleared by the alert reporting task, another block alert may be reported without clearing the Active status, if the subcode has changed. TRANSDUCER_DIRECTORY TRANSDUCER_TYPE 10 0x8080(0x8080) XD_ERROR 11 COLLECTION_DIRECTORY 12 TRANSDUCER_TYPE_VER 13 769 RB_PARAMETER 14 INP_REG_1_TYPE 15 Register type INP_REG_1_FLOAT 16 If the register contains a float value, it shall be displayed here INP_REG_1_INT_DEC 17 If the register contains a DWORD value and dec is chosen, it shall be displayed here INP_REG_2_TYPE 18 Register type INP_REG_2_FLOAT 19 If the register contains a float value, it shall be displayed here INP_REG_2_INT_DEC 20 If the register contains a DWORD value and dec is chosen, it shall be displayed here INP_REG_3_TYPE 21 Register type INP_REG_3_FLOAT 22 If the register contains a float value, it shall be displayed here INP_REG_3_INT_DEC 23 If the register contains a DWORD value and dec is chosen, it shall be displayed here INP_REG_4_TYPE 24 Register type INP_REG_4_FLOAT 25 If the register contains a float value, it shall be displayed here INP_REG_4_INT_DEC 26 If the register contains a DWORD value and dec is chosen, it shall be displayed here INP_REG_5_TYPE 27 Register type INP_REG_5_FLOAT 28 If the register contains a float value, it shall be displayed here INP_REG_5_INT_DEC 29 If the register contains a DWORD value and dec is chosen, it shall be displayed here INP_REG_6_TYPE 30 Register type INP_REG_6_FLOAT 31 If the register contains a float value, it shall be displayed here INP_REG_6_INT_DEC 32 If the register contains a DWORD value and dec is chosen, it shall be displayed here INP_REG_7_TYPE 33 Register type INP_REG_7_FLOAT 34 If the register contains a float value, it shall be displayed here 266 Default value Description Directory that specifies the number and starting indices of the transducers in the transducer block. Identifies the transducer. A transducer block alarm subcode. A directory that specifies the number, starting indices, and DD Item IDs of the data collections in each transducer within a transducer block. Transducer type version = 0x0301 Reserved. RB parameter Register Transducer Block Appendix F: Register transducer block Reference Manual November 2014 00809-0100-4026, Rev HA Parameter Index number Default value Description INP_REG_7_INT_DEC 35 If the register contains a DWORD value and dec is chosen, it shall be displayed here INP_REG_8_TYPE 36 Register type INP_REG_8_FLOAT 37 If the register contains a float value, it shall be displayed here INP_REG_8_INT_DEC 38 If the register contains a DWORD value and dec is chosen, it shall be displayed here INP_REG_9_TYPE 39 Register type INP_REG_9_FLOAT 40 If the register contains a float value, it shall be displayed here INP_REG_9_INT_DEC 41 If the register contains a DWORD value and dec is chosen, it shall be displayed here INP_REG_10_TYPE 42 Register type INP_REG_10_FLOAT 43 If the register contains a float value, it shall be displayed here INP_REG_10_INT_DEC 44 If the register contains a DWORD value and dec is chosen, it shall be displayed here DB_REG_1_TYPE 45 Register type DB_REG_1_FLOAT 46 If the register contains a float value, it shall be displayed here DB_REG_1_INT_DEC 47 If the register contains a DWORD value and dec is chosen, it shall be displayed here DB_REG_2_TYPE 48 Register type DB_REG_2_FLOAT 49 If the register contains a float value, it shall be displayed here DB_REG_2_INT_DEC 50 If the register contains a DWORD value and dec is chosen, it shall be displayed here DB_REG_3_TYPE 51 Register type DB_REG_3_FLOAT 52 If the register contains a float value, it shall be displayed here DB_REG_3_INT_DEC 53 If the register contains a DWORD value and dec is chosen, it shall be displayed here DB_REG_4_TYPE 54 Register type DB_REG_4_FLOAT 55 If the register contains a float value, it shall be displayed here DB_REG_4_INT_DEC 56 If the register contains a DWORD value and dec is chosen, it shall be displayed here DB_REG_5_TYPE 57 Register type DB_REG_5_FLOAT 58 If the register contains a float value, it shall be displayed here DB_REG_5_INT_DEC 59 If the register contains a DWORD value and dec is chosen, it shall be displayed here DB_REG_6_TYPE 60 Register type DB_REG_6_FLOAT 61 If the register contains a float value, it shall be displayed here DB_REG_6_INT_DEC 62 If the register contains a DWORD value and dec is chosen, it shall be displayed here DB_REG_7_TYPE 63 Register type 64 If the register contains a float value, it shall be displayed here DB_REG_7_FLOAT Register Transducer Block 267 Reference Manual Appendix F: Register transducer block 00809-0100-4026, Rev HA November 2014 Parameter Index number Default value Description DB_REG_7_INT_DEC 65 If the register contains a DWORD value and dec is chosen, it shall be displayed here DB_REG_8_TYPE 66 Register type DB_REG_8_FLOAT 67 If the register contains a float value, it shall be displayed here DB_REG_8_INT_DEC 68 If the register contains a DWORD value and dec is chosen, it shall be displayed here DB_REG_9_TYPE 69 Register type DB_REG_9_FLOAT 70 If the register contains a float value, it shall be displayed here DB_REG_9_INT_DEC 71 If the register contains a DWORD value and dec is chosen, it shall be displayed here DB_REG_10_TYPE 72 Register type DB_REG_10_FLOAT 73 If the register contains a float value, it shall be displayed here DB_REG_10_INT_DEC 74 If the register contains a DWORD value and dec is chosen, it shall be displayed here RM_COMMAND 75 Used to set what will be read or write from a secondary master. RM_DATA 76 Data read/write from secondary master. RM_STATUS 77 Status read by a secondary master. INP_SEARCH_START_NBR 78 Search start number for input registers. DB_SEARCH_START_NBR 79 Search start number for holding registers. 268 Register Transducer Block Appendix G: Advanced configuration transducer block Reference Manual November 2014 00809-0100-4026, Rev HA Appendix G Advanced Configuration Transducer Block Overview . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . page 269 G.1 Overview The Advanced Configuration Transducer Block contains functions for advanced configuration of the Rosemount 5400 Series transmitter. It includes functions such as amplitude threshold settings for filtering of disturbing echoes and noise, simulation of measurement values, and strapping table for volume measurements. G.1.1 Advanced configuration transducer block parameters Table G-1. Advanced Configuration Transducer Block Parameters Index number Default value ST_REV N/A The revision level of the static data associated with the function block. The revision value increments each time a static parameter value in the block is changed. TAG_DESC N/A The user description of the intended application of the block. STRATEGY The strategy field can be used to identify grouping of blocks. This data is not checked or processed by the block. ALERT_KEY The identification number of the plant unit. This information may be used in the host for sorting alarms, etc. Parameter Description The actual, target, permitted, and normal modes of the block. MODE_BLK 0x88(Auto | OOS) 0x08(Auto) BLOCK_ERR N/A UPDATE_EVT N/A BLOCK_ALM N/A TRANSDUCER_DIRECTORY TRANSDUCER_TYPE 10 0x8121(0x8121) Advanced Configuration Transducer Block • Target: The mode to “go to” • Actual: The mode the “block is currently in” • Permitted: Allowed modes that target may take on • Normal: Most common mode for target This parameter reflects the error status associated with the hardware or software components associated with a block. It is a bit string, so that multiple errors may be shown. Identifies the transducer. 269 Reference Manual Appendix G: Advanced configuration transducer block 00809-0100-4026, Rev HA November 2014 Index number Default value XD_ERROR 11 N/A COLLECTION_DIRECTORY 12 TRANSDUCER_TYPE_VER 13 769 AMPLITUDE_THRESHOLD_CURVE 14 0x00000000(Undefined) SIMULATION_MODE 15 0x00000000 (0x00000000) SURFACE_SEARCH 16 SET_EMPTY_TANK 17 0x00000000(No Action) SET_CONSTANT_THRESHOLD 18 ECHO_UPDATE 19 0x00000000 (Uninitialized) ECHO_FOUND_DISTANCE 20 Parameter Description A transducer block alarm subcode. Command. The following sub-elements are available: • ACTION • VALUE Simulation of measurement values. The following sub-elements are available: • ACTION • VALUE If the device has locked on a false echo, you can use this function to force the device to search for the product surface echo within the whole tank. Command. A constant amplitude threshold can be used to filter out noise. ECHO_FOUND_AMPLITUDE 21 ECHO_FOUND_CLASS 22 0x00(Unknown) ECHO_COMMAND 23 0x00000000 (Uninitialized) ECHO_FALSE 24 VOL_VOLUME_CALC_METHOD 25 0x000000fb(None) VOL_IDEAL_DIAMETER 26 20 Tank diameter VOL_IDEAL_LENGTH 27 20 Tank length The following sub-elements are available: • ACTION • VALUE VOL_VOLUME_OFFSET 28 Volume offset VOL_STRAP_TABLE_LENGTH 29 Number of strap points VOL_STRAP_LEV_1 30 Strap value level VOL_STRAP_VOL_1 31 Strap value volume VOL_STRAP_LEV_2 32 10 Strap value level VOL_STRAP_VOL_2 33 10 Strap value volume VOL_STRAP_LEV_3 34 Strap value level VOL_STRAP_VOL_3 35 Strap value volume VOL_STRAP_LEV_4 36 Strap value level VOL_STRAP_VOL_4 37 Strap value volume VOL_STRAP_LEV_5 38 Strap value level VOL_STRAP_VOL_5 39 Strap value volume VOL_STRAP_LEV_6 40 Strap value level VOL_STRAP_VOL_6 41 Strap value volume VOL_STRAP_LEV_7 42 Strap value level VOL_STRAP_VOL_7 43 Strap value volume VOL_STRAP_LEV_8 44 Strap value level 270 Advanced Configuration Transducer Block Appendix G: Advanced configuration transducer block Reference Manual November 2014 00809-0100-4026, Rev HA Parameter Index number Default value Description VOL_STRAP_VOL_8 45 Strap value volume VOL_STRAP_LEV_9 46 Strap value level VOL_STRAP_VOL_9 47 Strap value volume VOL_STRAP_LEV_10 48 Strap value level VOL_STRAP_VOL_10 49 Strap value volume VOL_STRAP_LEV_11 50 Strap value level VOL_STRAP_VOL_11 51 Strap value volume VOL_STRAP_LEV_12 52 Strap value level VOL_STRAP_VOL_12 53 Strap value volume VOL_STRAP_LEV_13 54 Strap value level VOL_STRAP_VOL_13 55 Strap value volume VOL_STRAP_LEV_14 56 Strap value level VOL_STRAP_VOL_14 57 Strap value volume VOL_STRAP_LEV_15 58 Strap value level VOL_STRAP_VOL_15 59 Strap value volume VOL_STRAP_LEV_16 60 Strap value level VOL_STRAP_VOL_16 61 Strap value volume VOL_STRAP_LEV_17 62 Strap value level VOL_STRAP_VOL_17 63 Strap value volume VOL_STRAP_LEV_18 64 Strap value level VOL_STRAP_VOL_18 65 Strap value volume VOL_STRAP_LEV_19 66 Strap value level VOL_STRAP_VOL_19 67 Strap value volume VOL_STRAP_LEV_20 68 Strap value level Strap value volume VOL_STRAP_VOL_20 69 LENGTH_UNIT 70 0x000003f2(m) VOLUME_UNIT 71 0x0000040a(m) SIGNAL_STRENGTH_UNIT 72 0x000004db(mV) Advanced Configuration Transducer Block 271 Appendix G: Advanced configuration transducer block November 2014 272 Reference Manual 00809-0100-4026, Rev HA Advanced Configuration Transducer Block Appendix H: Resource block Reference Manual November 2014 00809-0100-4026, Rev HA Appendix H Resource Block Overview . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . page 273 Parameters and descriptions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . page 273 H.1 Overview This section contains information on the Rosemount 5400 Series Radar Level Transmitter Resource Block. Descriptions of all Resource Block Parameters, errors, and diagnostics are included. Also the modes, alarm detection, status handling, and troubleshooting are discussed. Definition The resource block defines the physical resources of the device. The resource block also handles functionality that is common across multiple blocks. The block has no linkable inputs or outputs. H.2 Parameters and descriptions The table below lists all of the configurable parameters of the resource block, including the descriptions and index numbers for each. Index number Default value ST_REV 01 TAG_DESC 02 STRATEGY 03 The strategy field can be used to identify grouping of blocks. ALERT_KEY 04 The identification number of the plant unit. MODE_BLK 05 Parameter The revision level of the static data associated with the function block. The user description of the intended application of the block. 0x08(Auto) 0x08(Auto) 0x88(Auto | OOS) 0x08(Auto) BLOCK_ERR Description The actual, target, permitted, and normal modes of the block: Target: The mode to “go to” Actual: The mode the “block is currently in” Permitted: Allowed modes that target may take on Normal: Most common mode for actual 06 0x0000(0x0000) RS_STATE 07 0x04(Online) TEST_RW 08 Read/write test parameter - used only for conformance testing. DD_RESOURCE 09 String identifying the tag of the resource which contains the Device Description for this resource. Resource Block This parameter reflects the error status associated with the hardware or software components associated with a block. It is a bit string, so that multiple errors may be shown. State of the function block application state machine. 273 Reference Manual Appendix H: Resource block 00809-0100-4026, Rev HA November 2014 Parameter Index number Default value MANUFAC_ID 10 0x00001151 Manufacturer identification number – used by an interface device to locate the DD file for the resource. DEV_TYPE 11 5400 Manufacturer’s model number associated with the resource - used by interface devices to locate the DD file for the resource. DEV_REV 12 Manufacturer revision number associated with the resource - used by an interface device to locate the DD file for the resource. DD_REV 13 Revision of the DD associated with the resource - used by an interface device to locate the DD file for the resource. GRANT_DENY 14 0x00(0x00) Options for controlling access of host computers and local control panels to operating, tuning, and alarm parameters of the block. Not used by device. HARD_TYPES 15 0x0001(Scalar Input) RESTART 16 0x01(Run) FEATURES 17 0x0c1b(Unicode | Reports | Soft W Lock | Hard W Lock | Multi-bit Alarm (Bit-Alarm) Support | Restart/Relink after FB_Action) FEATURES_SEL 18 0x0000(0x0000) CYCLE_TYPE 19 0x0003(Scheduled | Block Execution) CYCLE_SEL 20 0x0000(0x0000) MIN_CYCLE_T 21 8000 MEMORY_SIZE 22 16 NV_CYCLE_T 23 960000 Minimum time interval specified by the manufacturer for writing copies of NV parameters to non-volatile memory. Zero means it will never be automatically copied. At the end of NV_CYCLE_T, only those parameters which have changed need to be updated in NVRAM. FREE_SPACE 24 23.8095 Percent of memory available for further configuration. Zero in a preconfigured device. FREE_TIME 25 SHED_RCAS 26 640000 274 Description The types of hardware available as channel numbers. Allows a manual restart to be initiated. Several degrees of restart are possible. They are the following: 1 Run – nominal state when not restarting 2 Restart resource – not used 3 Restart with defaults – set parameters to default values. See START_WITH_DEFAULTS below for which parameters are set. 4 Restart processor – does a warm start of CPU. Used to show supported resource block options. See Error! Reference source not found. The supported features are: SOFT_WRITE_LOCK_SUPPORT, HARD_WRITE_LOCK_SUPPORT, REPORTS, and UNICODE Used to select resource block options. Identifies the block execution methods available for this resource. Used to select the block execution method for this resource. The Rosemount 5600 supports the following: Scheduled: Blocks are only executed based on the function block schedule. Block Execution: A block may be executed by linking to another blocks completion. Time duration of the shortest cycle interval of which the resource is capable. Available configuration memory in the empty resource. To be checked before attempting a download. Percent of the block processing time that is free to process additional blocks. Time duration at which to give up on computer writes to function block RCas locations. Shed from RCas shall never happen when SHED_ROUT = 0 Resource Block Appendix H: Resource block Reference Manual November 2014 00809-0100-4026, Rev HA Parameter Index number Default value SHED_ROUT 27 640000 Time duration at which to give up on computer writes to function block ROut locations. Shed from ROut shall never happen when SHED_ROUT = 0 FAULT_STATE 28 0x01(Clear) Condition set by loss of communication to an output block, fault promoted to an output block or physical contact. When FAIL_SAFE condition is set, then output function blocks will perform their FAIL_SAFE actions. SET_FSTATE 29 0x01(OFF) Allows the FAIL_SAFE condition to be manually initiated by selecting Set. CLR_FSTATE 30 0x01(Off) Writing a Clear to this parameter will clear the device FAIL_SAFE if the field condition has cleared. MAX_NOTIFY 31 Maximum number of unconfirmed notify messages possible. LIM_NOTIFY 32 Maximum number of unconfirmed alert notify messages allowed. CONFIRM_TIME 33 640000 WRITE_LOCK 34 0x01(Not Locked) UPDATE_EVT 35 This alert is generated by any change to the static data. BLOCK_ALM 36 The block alarm is used for all configuration, hardware, connection failure, or system problems in the block. The cause of the alert is entered in the subcode field. The first alert to become active will set the Active status in the Status parameter. As soon as the Unreported status is cleared by the alert reporting task, another block alert may be reported without clearing the Active status, if the subcode has changed. ALARM_SUM 37 The current alert status, unacknowledged states, unreported states, and disabled states of the alarms associated with the function block. ACK_OPTION 38 0x0000(0x0000) Selection of whether alarms associated with the function block will be automatically acknowledged. WRITE_PRI 39 Priority of the alarm generated by clearing the write lock. WRITE_ALM 40 0X00(Uninitialized) 0x00(Uninitialized) 01/01/72 00:00:00 0x0000(Other) 0x00(State 0) Description The time the resource will wait for confirmation of receipt of a report before trying again. Retry will not happen when CONFIRM_TIME=0. If set, no writes from anywhere are allowed, except to clear WRITE_LOCK. Block inputs will continue to be updated. This alert is generated if the write lock parameter is cleared. Five sub-elements available: - UNACKNOWLEDGED - ALARM_STATE - TIME_STAMP - SUB_CODE - VALUE ITK_VER 41 distributor 42 0x00001151 (Rosemount) DEV_STRING 43 This is used to load new licensing into the device. The value can be written but will always read back with a value of 0. XD_OPTIONS 44 0x00000000 (0x00000000) Indicates which transducer block licensing options are enabled. Resource Block Major revision number of the inter operability test case used in certifying this device as interoperable. The format and range are controlled by the Fieldbus Foundation. Reserved for use as distributor ID. No FOUNDATION enumerations defined at this time. 275 Reference Manual Appendix H: Resource block 00809-0100-4026, Rev HA November 2014 Parameter Index number FB_OPTIONS Default value Description 45 0x00000000 (0x00000000) Indicates which function block licensing options are enabled. DIAG_OPTIONS 46 0x00000000 (0x00000000) Indicates which diagnostics licensing options are enabled. MISC_OPTIONS 47 0x00000000 (0x00000000) Indicates which miscellaneous licensing options are enabled. RB_SFTWR_REV_MAJOR 48 Major revision of software that the resource block was created with. RB_SFTWR_REV_MINOR 49 Minor revision of software that the resource block was created with. RB_SFTWR_REV_BUILD 50 33 Build of software that the resource block was created with. RB_SFTWR_REV_ALL 51 3-00-033 - Mon Apr 18 16:47:05 2011 by chadwar The string will contain the following fields: Major rev: 1-3 characters, decimal number 0-255 Minor rev: 1-3 characters, decimal number 0-255 Build rev: 1-5 characters, decimal number 0-255 Time of build: 8 characters, xx:xx:xx, military time Day of week of build: 3 characters, Sun, Mon,... Month of build: 3 characters, Jan, Feb. Day of month of build: 1-2 characters, decimal number 1-31 Year of build: 4 characters, decimal Builder: 7 characters, login name of builder hardware_rev 52 output_board_sn 53 FINAL_ASSY_NUM 54 The same final assembly number placed on the neck label. detailed_status 55 0x00000000 (0x00000000) Indicates the state of the transmitter. See Resource Block detailed status codes. summary_status 56 0x01(No repair needed) message_date 57 01/01/84 00:00:00 message_text 58 SELF_TEST 59 0x01(No self test) Instructs resource block to perform self-test. Tests are device specific. define_write_lock 60 0x01(Everything locked) Allows the operator to select how WRITE_LOCK behaves. The initial value is “lock everything”. If the value is set to “lock only physical device”, then the resource and transducer blocks of the device will be locked but changes to function blocks will be allowed. save_config_now 61 0x01(No save) save_config_blocks 62 Number of EEPROM blocks that have been modified since last burn. This value will count down to zero when the configuration is saved. start_with_defaults 63 0x01(No NV defaults) 0 = Uninitialized 1 = do not power-up with NV defaults 2 = power-up with default node address 3 = power-up with default pd_tag and node address 4 = power-up with default data for the entire communications stack (no application data) simulate_IO 64 0x01(Jumper off) Status of simulate switch. security_IO 65 0x01(Jumper off) Status of security switch. 276 Hardware revision of the hardware that has the resource block in it. Output board serial number. An enumerated value of repair analysis. Date associated with the MESSAGE_TEXT parameter. Used to indicate changes made by the user to the device's installation, configuration, or calibration. Allows the user to optionally save all non-volatile information immediately. Resource Block Appendix H: Resource block Reference Manual November 2014 00809-0100-4026, Rev HA Parameter Index number Default value Description SIMULATE_STATE 66 0x01(Jumper off* no simulation) The state of the simulate switch: 0 = Uninitialized 1 = Switch off, simulation not allowed 2 = Switch on, simulation not allowed (need to cycle jumper/switch) 3 = Switch on, simulation allowed download_mode 67 0x01(Run Mode) Gives access to the boot block code for over-the-wire downloads. 0 = Uninitialized 1 = Run mode 2 = Download mode RECOMMENDED_ACTION 68 0x0001 (No action required.) Enumerated list of recommended actions displayed with a device alert. FAILED_PRI 69 Designates the alarming priority of the FAILED_ALM. FAILED_ENABLE 70 0x00007760 (Software Error | Sensor Database Error | Internal Temperature Critical | Electronics Failure - Main Board | Software Incompatibility Error | Memory Failure - Output Board | Internal Communication Failure | Electronics Failure Output Board) Enabled FAILED_ALM alarm conditions. Corresponds bit for bit to the FAILED_ACTIVE. A bit on means that the corresponding alarm condition is enabled and will be detected. A bit off means the corresponding alarm condition is disabled and will not be detected. FAILED_MASK 71 0x00000000 (0x00000000) Mask of FAILED_ALM. Corresponds bit of bit to FAILED_ACTIVE. A bit on means that the condition is masked out from alarming. FAILED_ACTIVE 72 0x00000000 (0x00000000) Enumerated list of failure conditions within a device. FAILED_ALM 73 Alarm indicating a failure within a device which makes the device non-operational. MAINT_PRI 74 MAINT_ENABLE 75 0x08608000 (Device Simulation Active | Configuration Warning | Internal Temperature Out of Limits | Configuration Error MAINT_MASK 76 0x00000000 (0x00000000) Mask of MAINT_ALM. Corresponds bit of bit to MAINT_ACTIVE. A bit on means that the condition is masked out from alarming. MAINT_ACTIVE 77 0x00000000 (0x00000000) Enumerated list of maintenance conditions within a device. MAINT_ALM 78 ADVISE_PRI 79 Designates the alarming priority of the ADVISE_ALM ADVISE_ENABLE 80 0x10000000 (PlantWeb® Alerts Simulation Active) Enabled ADVISE_ALM alarm conditions. Corresponds bit for bit to the ADVISE_ACTIVE. A bit on means that the corresponding alarm condition is enabled and will be detected. A bit off means the corresponding alarm condition is disabled and will not be detected. Resource Block Designates the alarming priority of the MAINT_ALM Enabled MAINT_ALM alarm conditions. Corresponds bit for bit to the MAINT_ACTIVE. A bit on means that the corresponding alarm condition is enabled and will be detected. A bit off means the corresponding alarm condition is disabled and will not be detected. Alarm indicating the device needs maintenance soon. If the condition is ignored, the device will eventually fail. 277 Reference Manual Appendix H: Resource block 00809-0100-4026, Rev HA November 2014 Index number Parameter Default value Description ADVISE_MASK 81 0x00000000 (0x00000000) Mask of ADVISE_ALM. Corresponds bit of bit to ADVISE_ACTIVE. A bit on means that the condition is masked out from alarming. ADVISE_ACTIVE 82 0x00000000 (0x00000000) Enumerated list of advisory conditions within a device. ADVISE_ALM 83 HEALTH_INDEX 84 100 PWA_SIMULATE 85 0x00(Simulation off) H.2.1 Alarm indicating advisory alarms. These conditions do not have a direct impact on the process or device integrity. Parameter representing the overall health of the device, 100 being perfect and 10 being non-functioning. The value is based on the active PWA alarms. Parameter allowing simulation of PWA alarms. PlantWeb® alerts The Resource Block will act as a coordinator for PlantWeb alerts. There will be three alarm parameters (FAILED_ALARM, MAINT_ALARM, and ADVISE_ALARM) which will contain information regarding some of the device errors which are detected by the transmitter software. There will be a RECOMMENDED_ACTION parameter which will be used to display the recommended action text for the highest priority alarm and a HEALTH_INDEX parameters (0 100) indicating the overall health of the transmitter. FAILED_ALARM will have the highest priority followed by MAINT_ALARM and ADVISE_ALARM will be the lowest priority. FAILED_ALARMS A failure alarm indicates a failure within a device that will make the device or some part of the device non-operational. This implies that the device is in need of repair and must be fixed immediately. There are five parameters associated with FAILED_ALARMS specifically, they are described below. FAILED_ENABLED This parameter contains a list of failures in the device which makes the device non-operational that will cause an alert to be sent. Below is a list of the failures: Electronics Failure - Output Board Internal Communication Failure Memory Failure - Output Board Software Incompatibility Error Electronics Failure - Main Board Internal Temperature Critical Sensor Database Error Software Error FAILED_MASK This parameter will mask any of the failed conditions listed in FAILED_ENABLED. A bit on means that the condition is masked out from alarming and will not be reported. 278 Resource Block Appendix H: Resource block Reference Manual November 2014 00809-0100-4026, Rev HA FAILED_PRI Designates the alerting priority of the FAILED_ALM, see “Alarm priority” on page 281. The default is 0 and the recommended values are between 8 and 15. FAILED_ACTIVE This parameter displays which of the alarms is active. Only the alarm with the highest priority will be displayed. This priority is not the same as the FAILED_PRI parameter described above. This priority is hard coded within the device and is not user configurable. FAILED_ALM Alarm indicating a failure within a device which makes the device non-operational. MAINT_ALARMS A maintenance alarm indicates the device or some part of the device needs maintenance soon. If the condition is ignored, the device will eventually fail. There are five parameters associated with MAINT_ALARMS, they are described below. MAINT_ENABLED The MAINT_ENABLED parameter contains a list of conditions indicating the device or some part of the device needs maintenance soon. Below is a list of the conditions: Configuration Error Level Measurement Failure Volume Measurement Failure Internal Temperature Out of Limits Configuration Warning Volume Measurement Warning Device Simulation Active MAINT_MASK The MAINT_MASK parameter will mask any of the failed conditions listed in MAINT_ENABLED. A bit on means that the condition is masked out from alarming and will not be reported. MAINT_PRI MAINT_PRI designates the alarming priority of the MAINT_ALM, see “Recommended actions for PlantWeb alerts” on page 282. The default is 0 and the recommended values is 3 to 7. MAINT_ACTIVE The MAINT_ACTIVE parameter displays which of the alarms is active. Only the condition with the highest priority will be displayed. This priority is not the same as the MAINT_PRI parameter described above. This priority is hard coded within the device and is not user configurable. Resource Block 279 Appendix H: Resource block Reference Manual 00809-0100-4026, Rev HA November 2014 MAINT_ALM An alarm indicating the device needs maintenance soon. If the condition is ignored, the device will eventually fail. Advisory alarms An advisory alarm indicates informative conditions that do not have a direct impact on the device's primary functions. There are five parameters associated with ADVISE_ALARMS, they are described below. ADVISE_ENABLED The ADVISE_ENABLED parameter contains a list of informative conditions that do not have a direct impact on the device's primary functions. The following advisory alarm may be displayed: PlantWeb Alerts Simulation Active ADVISE_MASK The ADVISE_MASK parameter will mask any of the failed conditions listed in ADVISE_ENABLED. A bit on means the condition is masked out from alarming and will not be reported. ADVISE_PRI ADVISE_PRI designates the alarming priority of the ADVISE_ALM, see “Recommended actions for PlantWeb alerts” on page 282. The default is 0 and the recommended values are 1 or 2. ADVISE_ACTIVE The ADVISE_ACTIVE parameter displays which of the advisories is active. Only the advisory with the highest priority will be displayed. This priority is not the same as the ADVISE_PRI parameter described above. This priority is hard coded within the device and is not user configurable. ADVISE_ALM ADVISE_ALM is an alarm indicating advisory alarms. These conditions do not have a direct impact on the process or device integrity. 280 Resource Block Appendix H: Resource block Reference Manual November 2014 00809-0100-4026, Rev HA H.2.2 Alarm priority Alarms are grouped into five levels of priority: Priority number 3-7 8-15 Resource Block Priority description The alarm condition is not used. An alarm condition with a priority of 1 is recognized by the system, but is not reported to the operator. An alarm condition with a priority of 2 is reported to the operator. Alarm conditions of priority 3 to 7 are advisory alarms of increasing priority. Alarm conditions of priority 8 to 15 are critical alarms of increasing priority. 281 Reference Manual Appendix H: Resource block 00809-0100-4026, Rev HA November 2014 H.2.3 Recommended actions for PlantWeb alerts RECOMMENDED_ACTION The RECOMMENDED_ACTION parameter displays a text string that will give a recommended course of action to take based on which type and which specific event of the PlantWeb alerts are active. Table H-1. Recommended Actions Alarm type Failed/maint/advise/ Description active event Advisory PlantWeb alerts simulation active Device simulation active Volume measurement warning Configuration warning Internal temperature out of limits Maintenance Alerts are currently being simulated. Real alerts active in the device are blocked (except for this alert). The measurement output from the device is currently being simulated. Simulation disables normal measurement except for Internal Temperature. Variables are GOOD if the simulated level is GOOD and the device is in service. The level measurement is outside the configured volume range. The configuration of at least one parameter is outside specifications. Refer to the device manual for details. Disregard this alert if the device is working properly. Internal temperature is outside its limits (-40 °F/-40 °C to 176 °F/+80 °C). Reasons may be multiple: Volume measurement failure • Incorrect volume configuration • Level measurement invalid Volume status is set to BAD. No valid level reading. Reasons may be multiple: Level measurement failure • No valid surface echo peak in the measuring range. • Incorrect transmitter configuration Level status is set to BAD. Configuration error 282 At least one of the configuration parameters is outside its allowed minimum-maximum range. The default value for applicable parameters is being used. Recommended action Use the switch on the fieldbus electronics board to turn simulation on or off. Use "Start/Stop Device Simulation" to enable or disable simulation. Check volume configuration. Check device configuration. Check ambient temperature at installation site. 2. If Level Measurement Failure is active, clear that alert first. 3. Check volume configuration. 4. Load default database to the device and reconfigure it. 5. If the error persists, it might indicate a hardware error. Replace the transmitter head. 1. Analyze echo curve for reason and check device configuration. 2. Check device physical installation (for instance, antenna contamination). 3. Load default database to the device and reconfigure it. 4. If the error persists, it might indicate a hardware error. Replace the transmitter head. Load default database to the device and reconfigure it. Resource Block Appendix H: Resource block Reference Manual November 2014 00809-0100-4026, Rev HA Alarm type Failed/maint/advise/ Description active event Software error The device software has encountered an error. Reasons may be multiple, including too low supplied voltage, or an error being simulated. The status for all variables is BAD, and the device is out of service. Sensor database error The device has found an error in the configuration database. Status for all variables is BAD. Device recovery is possible. Internal temperature critical Failed Electronics failure – main board Software incompatibility error Memory failure output board Internal communication failure Electronics failure output board Resource Block The internal temperature of the device has reached critical levels and the integrity of the device electronics has been compromised. Ambient temperature should not exceed device specifications (-40 °F/-40 °C to 176 °F/+80 °C). The device is not in service (OOS) and status for all variables is BAD. The device has detected a fault with an electrical component on the main board electronics module assembly. The status for all variables is BAD, and the device is out of service. Fieldbus software and main firmware versions are incompatible. The device is not in service (OOS). Configuration data has been corrupted or pending configuration changes has been lost due to loss of power before storage could complete. Default values are loaded into the faulty block. Potential errors in stored data may cause unwanted behavior. The device is not in service (OOS) and status for all variables is BAD. Device recovery is possible. The communication between the main transmitter board and the fieldbus electronics board has been lost. The device holds the last known measurement values with status BAD. The device has detected a fault with an electrical component on the output board electronics module assembly. The device is not in service (OOS). Recommended action 1. Make sure that enough voltage is supplied to the device. 2. Restart the device. 3. Turn off simulation of device failure. 4. If the alert persists, replace the transmitter head. 1. Load default database to the device to clear the error. 2. Reconfigure the device. 3. If the alert persists, replace the transmitter head. Replace the transmitter head. Replace the transmitter head. Replace the transmitter head. 1. Load default database to the device to clear the error. 2. Download a device configuration. 3. If the error persists, it may indicate a faulty memory chip. Replace the transmitter head. Replace the transmitter head. Replace the transmitter head. 283 Appendix H: Resource block November 2014 284 Reference Manual 00809-0100-4026, Rev HA Resource Block Appendix I: Analog-Input block Reference Manual November 2014 00809-0100-4026, Rev HA Appendix I Analog-Input Block Simulation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . page 288 Damping . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . page 289 Signal conversion . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . page 289 Block errors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . page 290 Modes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . page 290 Alarm detection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . page 291 Configure the AI block . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . page 293 Figure I-1. Analog-Input Block OUT_D AI OUT OUT=The block output value and status OUT_D=Discrete output that signals a selected alarm condition The Analog-Input (AI) function block processes field device measurements and makes them available to other function blocks. The output value from the AI block is in engineering units and contains a status indicating the quality of the measurement. The measuring device may have several measurements or derived values available in different channels. Use the channel number to define the variable that the AI block processes. The AI block supports alarming, signal scaling, signal filtering, signal status calculation, mode control, and simulation. In Automatic mode, the block’s output parameter (OUT) reflects the process variable (PV) value and status. In Manual mode, OUT may be set manually. The Manual mode is reflected on the output status. A discrete output (OUT_D) is provided to indicate whether a selected alarm condition is active. Alarm detection is based on the OUT value and user specified alarm limits. Figure 2 on page 288 illustrates the internal components of the AI function block, and Table 1 lists the AI block parameters and their units of measure, descriptions, and index numbers. Table I-1. Definitions of Analog-Input Function Block System Parameters Index number Units Description ST_REV 01 None The revision level of the static data associated with the function block. The revision value will be incremented each time a static parameter value in the block is changed. TAG_DESC 02 None The user description of the intended application of the block. None The strategy field can be used to identify grouping of blocks. This data is not checked or processed by the block. Parameter STRATEGY Analog-Input Block 03 285 Reference Manual Appendix I: Analog-Input block 00809-0100-4026, Rev HA November 2014 Parameter Index number Units Description ALERT_KEY 04 None The identification number of the plant unit. This information may be used in the host for sorting alarms, etc. MODE_BLK 05 None The actual, target, permitted, and normal modes of the block. Target: The mode to “go to” Actual: The mode the “block is currently in” Permitted: Allowed modes that target may take on Normal: Most common mode for target BLOCK_ERR 06 None This parameter reflects the error status associated with the hardware or software components associated with a block. It is a bit string, so that multiple errors may be shown. PV 07 EU of XD_SCALE OUT 08 EU of OUT_SCALE SIMULATE 09 None A group of data that contains the current transducer value and status, the simulated transducer value and status, and the enable/disable bit. XD_SCALE 10 None The high and low scale values, engineering units code, and number of digits to the right of the decimal point associated with the channel input value. OUT_SCALE 11 None The high and low scale values, engineering units code, and number of digits to the right of the decimal point associated with OUT. GRANT_DENY 12 None Options for controlling access of host computers and local control panels to operating, tuning, and alarm parameters of the block. Not used by device. IO_OPTS 13 None Allows the selection of input/output options used to alter the PV. Low cutoff enabled is the only selectable option. CHANNEL 15 None The CHANNEL value is used to select the measurement value. You must configure the CHANNEL parameter before you can configure the XD_SCALE parameter. L_TYPE 16 None Linearization type. Determines whether the field value is used directly (Direct) or is converted linearly (Indirect). LOW_CUT 17 PV_FTIME 18 Seconds The time constant of the first-order PV filter. It is the time required for a 63 % change in the IN value. FIELD_VAL 19 Percent The value and status from the transducer block or from the simulated input when simulation is enabled. UPDATE_EVT 20 None This alert is generated by any change to the static data. None The block alarm is used for all configuration, hardware, connection failure or system problems in the block. The cause of the alert is entered in the subcode field. The first alert to become active will set the Active status in the Status parameter. As soon as the Unreported status is cleared by the alert reporting task, another block alert may be reported without clearing the Active status, if the subcode has changed. The summary alarm is used for all process alarms in the block. The cause of the alert is entered in the subcode field. The first alert to become active will set the Active status in the Status parameter. As soon as the Unreported status is cleared by the alert reporting task, another block alert may be reported without clearing the Active status, if the subcode has changed. BLOCK_ALM 21 ALARM_SUM 22 None ACK_OPTION 23 None ALARM_HYS 24 Percent HI_HI_PRI 25 None HI_HI_LIM 26 EU of PV_SCALE HI_PRI 27 None HI_LIM 28 EU of PV_SCALE 286 The process variable used in block execution. The block output value and status. If percentage value of transducer input fails below this, PV = 0. Used to set auto acknowledgment of alarms. The amount the alarm value must return within the alarm limit before the associated active alarm condition clears. The priority of the HI HI alarm. The setting for the alarm limit used to detect the HI HI alarm condition. The priority of the HI alarm. The setting for the alarm limit used to detect the HI alarm condition. Analog-Input Block Appendix I: Analog-Input block Reference Manual November 2014 00809-0100-4026, Rev HA Parameter Index number Units Description The priority of the LO alarm. LO_PRI 29 None LO_LIM 30 EU of PV_SCALE LO_LO_PRI 31 None LO_LO_LIM 32 EU of PV_SCALE The setting for the alarm limit used to detect the LO alarm condition. The priority of the LO LO alarm. The setting for the alarm limit used to detect the LO LO alarm condition. HI_HI_ALM 33 None The HI HI alarm data, which includes a value of the alarm, a timestamp of occurrence and the state of the alarm. HI_ALM 34 None The HI alarm data, which includes a value of the alarm, a timestamp of occurrence and the state of the alarm. LO_ALM 35 None The LO alarm data, which includes a value of the alarm, a timestamp of occurrence and the state of the alarm. LO_LO_ALM 36 None The LO LO alarm data, which includes a value of the alarm, a timestamp of occurrence and the state of the alarm. OUT_D 37 None Discrete output to indicate a selected alarm condition. ALM_SEL 38 None Used to select the process alarm conditions that will cause the OUT_D parameter to be set. VAR_INDEX 39 % of OUT Range VAR_SCAN 40 Seconds Analog-Input Block The average absolute error between the PV and its previous mean value over that evaluation time defined by VAR_SCAN. The time over which the VAR_INDEX is evaluated. 287 Reference Manual Appendix I: Analog-Input block 00809-0100-4026, Rev HA November 2014 I.1 Simulation To support testing, you can either change the mode of the block to manual and adjust the output value, or you can enable simulation through the configuration tool and manually enter a value for the measurement value and its status. With simulation enabled, the actual measurement value has no impact on the OUT value or the status. Figure I-2. Analog-Input Function Block Schematic Analog measurement ALARM_TYPE Access analog meas. CHANNEL HI_HI_LIM HI_LIM LO_LO_LIM LO_LIM ALARM_HYS Alarm detection OUT_D LOW_CUT Cutoff Convert SIMULATE L_TYPE FIELD_VAL Filter PV PV_FTIME MODE IO_OPTS Status Calc. OUT STATUS_OPTS OUT_SCALE XD_SCALE NOTES: OUT = block output value and status. OUT_D = discrete output that signals a selected alarm condition. Figure I-3. Analog-Input Function Block Timing diagram OUT (mode in man) OUT (mode in auto) PV 63 % of Change FIELD_VAL Time (seconds) PV_FTIME 288 Analog-Input Block Appendix I: Analog-Input block Reference Manual November 2014 00809-0100-4026, Rev HA I.2 Damping The filtering feature changes the response time of the device to smooth variations in output readings caused by rapid changes in input. You can adjust the filter time constant (in seconds) using the PV_FTIME parameter. Set the filter time constant to zero to disable the filter feature. I.3 Signal conversion You can set the signal conversion type with the Linearization Type (L_TYPE) parameter. You can view the converted signal (in percent of XD_SCALE) through the FIELD_VAL parameter. 100 u Channel Value – EU*@0% FIELD_VAL = -------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------EU*@100% – EU*@0% * XD_SCALE values You can choose from direct or indirect signal conversion with the L_TYPE parameter. Direct Direct signal conversion allows the signal to pass through the accessed channel input value (or the simulated value when simulation is enabled). PV = Channel Value Indirect Indirect signal conversion converts the signal linearly to the accessed channel input value (or the simulated value when simulation is enabled) from its specified range (XD_SCALE) to the range and units of the PV and OUT parameters (OUT_SCALE). FIELD_VAL PV = § -------------------------------· u EU**@100% – EU**@0% + EU**@0% © ¹ 100 ** OUT_SCALE values Indirect square root Indirect square root signal conversion takes the square root of the value computed with the indirect signal conversion and scales it to the range and units of the PV and OUT parameters. PV = § FIELD_VAL -------------------------------· u EU**@100% – EU**@0% + EU**@0% © ¹ 100 ** OUT_SCALE values When the converted input value is below the limit specified by the LOW_CUT parameter, and the Low Cutoff I/O option (IO_OPTS) is enabled (True), a value of zero is used for the converted value (PV). Note Low Cutoff is the only I/O option supported by the AI block. You can set the I/O option in Manual or Out of Service mode only. Analog-Input Block 289 Reference Manual Appendix I: Analog-Input block 00809-0100-4026, Rev HA November 2014 I.4 Block errors Table 2 lists conditions reported in the BLOCK_ERR parameter. Table I-2. BLOCK_ERR Conditions Condition number I.5 Condition name and description Other Block configuration error: the selected channel carries a measurement that is incompatible with the engineering units selected in XD_SCALE, the L_TYPE parameter is not configured, or CHANNEL = zero. Link configuration error Simulate active: Simulation is enabled and the block is using a simulated value in its execution. Local override Device fault state set Device needs maintenance soon Input failure/process variable has bad status: The hardware is bad, or a bad status is being simulated. Output failure: The output is bad based primarily upon a bad input. Memory failure 10 Lost static data 11 Lost NV data 12 Readback check failed 13 Device needs maintenance now 14 Power up 15 Out of service: The actual mode is out of service. Modes The AI Function Block supports three modes of operation as defined by the MODE_BLK parameter: 290 Manual (Man) The block output (OUT) may be set manually Automatic (Auto) OUT reflects the analog input measurement or the simulated value when simulation is enabled. Out of Service (O/S) The block is not processed. FIELD_VAL and PV are not updated and the OUT status is set to Bad: Out of Service. The BLOCK_ERR parameter shows Out of Service. In this mode, you can make changes to all configurable parameters. The target mode of a block may be restricted to one or more of the supported modes. Analog-Input Block Appendix I: Analog-Input block Reference Manual November 2014 00809-0100-4026, Rev HA I.6 Alarm detection A block alarm will be generated whenever the BLOCK_ERR has an error bit set. The types of block error for the AI block are defined above. Process Alarm detection is based on the OUT value. You can configure the alarm limits of the following standard alarms: High (HI_LIM) High high (HI_HI_LIM) Low (LO_LIM) Low low (LO_LO_LIM) In order to avoid alarm chattering when the variable is oscillating around the alarm limit, an alarm hysteresis in percent of the PV span can be set using the ALARM_HYS parameter. The priority of each alarm is set in the following parameters: HI_PRI HI_HI_PRI LO_PRI LO_LO_PRI Alarms are grouped into five levels of priority: Table I-3. Alarm Level Priority Priority number Analog-Input Block Priority description The priority of an alarm condition changes to 0 after the condition that caused the alarm is corrected. An alarm condition with a priority of 1 is recognized by the system, but is not reported to the operator. An alarm condition with a priority of 2 is reported to the operator, but does not require operator attention (such as diagnostics and system alerts). 3-7 Alarm conditions of priority 3 to 7 are advisory alarms of increasing priority. 8-15 Alarm conditions of priority 8 to 15 are critical alarms of increasing priority. 291 Appendix I: Analog-Input block I.6.1 Reference Manual 00809-0100-4026, Rev HA November 2014 Status handling Normally, the status of the PV reflects the status of the measurement value, the operating condition of the I/O card, and any active alarm condition. In Auto mode, OUT reflects the value and status quality of the PV. In Man mode, the OUT status constant limit is set to indicate that the value is a constant and the OUT status is Good. The Uncertain - EU range violation status is always set, and the PV status is set high- or low-limited if the sensor limits for conversion are exceeded. In the STATUS_OPTS parameter, you can select from the following options to control the status handling: BAD if limited – sets the OUT status quality to Bad when the value is higher or lower than the sensor limits. Uncertain if limited – sets the OUT status quality to Uncertain when the value is higher or lower than the sensor limits. Uncertain if in manual mode – The status of the Output is set to Uncertain when the mode is set to Manual. Note The instrument must be in Manual or Out of service mode to set the status option. The AI block only supports the BAD if limited option. Unsupported options are not grayed out; they appear on the screen in the same manner as supported options. 292 Analog-Input Block Appendix I: Analog-Input block Reference Manual November 2014 00809-0100-4026, Rev HA I.7 Configure the AI block A minimum of four parameters are required to configure the AI Block. The parameters are described below with example configurations shown at the end of this section. CHANNEL Select the channel that corresponds to the desired sensor measurement. The Rosemount 5400 measures Level (channel 1), Distance (channel 2), Level Rate (channel 3), Signal Strength (channel 4), Volume (channel 5), and Internal Temperature (channel 6). AI block TB channel value Process variable Level RADAR_LEVEL Distance RADAR_ULLAGE Level Rate RADAR_LEVELRATE Signal Strength RADAR_LEVEL_SIGNAL_STRENGTH Volume RADAR_VOLUME Internal Temperature RADAR_INTERNAL_TEMPERATURE L_TYPE The L_TYPE parameter defines the relationship of the transmitter measurement (Level, Distance, Level Rate, Signal Strength, Volume, and Internal Temperature) to the desired output of the AI Block. The relationship can be direct or indirect root. Direct Select direct when the desired output will be the same as the transmitter measurement (Level, Distance, Level Rate, Signal Strength, Volume, and Internal Temperature). Indirect Select indirect when the desired output is a calculated measurement based on the transmitter measurement (Level, Distance, Level Rate, Signal Strength, Volume, and Internal Temperature). The relationship between the transmitter measurement and the calculated measurement will be linear. Indirect square root Select indirect square root when the desired output is an inferred measurement based on the transmitter measurement and the relationship between the sensor measurement and the inferred measurement is square root (for example, level). Analog-Input Block 293 Reference Manual Appendix I: Analog-Input block 00809-0100-4026, Rev HA November 2014 XD_SCALE and OUT_SCALE The XD_SCALE and OUT_SCALE each include three parameters: 0 %, 100 %, and, engineering units. Set these based on the L_TYPE: L_TYPE is direct When the desired output is the measured variable, set the XD_SCALE to represent the operating range of the process. Set OUT_SCALE to match XD_SCALE. L_TYPE is indirect When an inferred measurement is made based on the sensor measurement, set the XD_SCALE to represent the operating range that the sensor will see in the process. Determine the inferred measurement values that correspond to the XD_SCALE 0 and 100 % points and set these for the OUT_SCALE. L_TYPE is indirect square root When an inferred measurement is made based on the transmitter measurement and the relationship between the inferred measurement and sensor measurement is square root, set the XD_SCALE to represent the operating range that the sensor will see in the process. Determine the inferred measurement values that correspond to the XD_SCALE 0 and 100 % points and set these for the OUT_SCALE. Engineering units Note To avoid configuration errors, only select Engineering Units for XD_SCALE and OUT_SCALE that are supported by the device. The supported units are: Table I-4. Length Display Description meter cm centimeter mm millimeter ft feet in inch Table I-5. Level Rate 294 Display Description m/s meter per second m/h meter per hour ft/s feet per second in/m inch per minute Analog-Input Block Appendix I: Analog-Input block Reference Manual November 2014 00809-0100-4026, Rev HA Table I-6. Temperature Display Description °C Degree Celsius °F Degree Fahrenheit Table I-7. Signal Strength Display Description mV millivolt Table I-8. Volume Display Cubic meter Liter in3 Cubic inch ft3 Cubic feet Yd Analog-Input Block Description Cubic yard Gallon US gallon ImpGall Imperial gallon bbl barrel 295 Appendix I: Analog-Input block November 2014 296 Reference Manual 00809-0100-4026, Rev HA Analog-Input Block Reference Manual Index 00809-0100-4026, Rev HA November 2014 Index Address Temporary Node . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 113 Advanced Configuration. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 111 Advanced ConfigurationTransducer Block . . . . . . . . . . 113 AI Block Configuration . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 114 Parameters BLOCK_ERR . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 290 IO_OPTS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 289 L_TYPE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 289 LOW_CUT . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 289 OUT_SCALE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 289 PV_FTIME . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 289 XD_SCALE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 289 Status . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 292 Air purging . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 199 Alarm Detection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 291 Alarm Priority . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 281 Alarms Priorety . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 281 Always Track First Echo . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 249 AMS Suit . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10 Analog Input (AI) Block . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 165, 285 BLOCK_ERR . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 165 Troubleshooting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 165 Analog Input (AI) Function Block . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 165 Analog Output alarm values . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 82 saturation values . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 82 Analog Output Calibration . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 142 Analog Output Status . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 158 Antenna alignment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 31 size . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 31 Application Errors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 159 Application Examples . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 115 Approval Drawings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 230 ATC . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 83 Ball-valve Installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 29 Basic Configuration Parameters . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 74 Beam angle . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 34 Beamwidth . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .33, 34 Block Configuration AI Block . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 114 Block Errors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 165, 290 BLOCK_ERR AI Block . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 165, 290 Resource Block . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 164 Bracket Mounting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 41 Index Burst mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 117 Burst option . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 118 Cable Selection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 46 Cable/conduit entries . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 45 Calculation Method . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 110 Calibration . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 82 Calibration Distance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 238 Canadian Standards Association approval . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 221 system control drawing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 232 Channel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .257, 293 Channel Definitions Level Transducer Block . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 257 Close Distance Window . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 242 COM Port . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 87 Cone Antenna Flange Connection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 36 Configuration Analog Input (AI) Function Block OUT_SCALE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 294 XD_SCALE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 294 Channel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 293 Direct . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 294 Indirect . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 294 L_TYPE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 293 Direct. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 293 Indirect . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .293, 294 Configuration Tools . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 74 Configuration Using DeltaV . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 106 Damping. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 243 DeltaV . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 106 Density and Vapor . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 12 Device ID . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 106 Device Revision . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 112 Device Status . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 153 Device Tag . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 113 Diagnostic Messages . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 153 Diagnostics . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 145 Dielectric Chart . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 95 Product Dielectric Range . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 95 Dielectric constant . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 199 Direct . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .293, 294 Direct Signal Conversion . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 289 Display presentation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 120 variables . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 120 Display Panel Variables. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 120 Distance calibration . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 83 Distance Offset . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 237 Index-1 Reference Manual Index 00809-0100-4026, Rev HA November 2014 Disturbing objects . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 35 Double Bounce . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 241 Double Surface . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 242 Draft Range . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4 Echo Curve Analyzer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 140 Echo Timeout . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 242 Echo Tuning . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 83 Electrical installation connecting the transmitter. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 51 Intrinsically Safe Output . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .52, 58 Non-Intrinsically Safe Output . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 51 Tri-Loop . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .69, 70 Empty Tank Detection Area . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 240 Empty Tank Handling . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 239 Error messages . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 154 Errors. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 154 Extended Cone Antenna . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 30 External circuit breaker . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 47 External HART Devices . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 65 Factory Mutual approval . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 220 system control drawing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 231 False Echo . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 132 False Echo Area . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 133 False Echo Registration . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 111 False echoes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 35 Features . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4 Field Communicator . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .10, 101 Filtering AI Block . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 289 Full Tank Detection Area . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 241 Full Tank Handling . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 247 Function blocks . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 113 Grounding. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 46 HART Multidrop Configuration. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 118 HART to Modbus Converter (HMC) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 60 Hazardous Areas . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 47 Hazardous Locations Certifications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 220 Hold Off Distance . . . . . . . . . . . 133, 238, 239, 241, 247 Hold Off distance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 132 Inclination . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 32 Indirect . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 293, 294 Indirect Signal Conversion . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 289 Index-2 Installation cable selection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 46 cable/conduit entries . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 45 grounding . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 46 power requirements . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 49 Service Space . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 32 Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1 IO_OPTS AI Block . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 289 L_TYPE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 293 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .293, 294 AI Block . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 289 LCD . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .100, 120 Parameters . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 123 LCD Error Messages . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 126 LCD Parameters . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 123 LCD variables . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 91 LED Error Messages . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 127 Level . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7 Level calibration . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 83 Level Transducer Block . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 113 Channel Definitions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 257 Level Transducer Block Parameters . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 258 Logging Measurement Data . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 143 Loop-powered . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10 LOW_CUT . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 289 AI Block . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 289 Lower Reference Point . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 75 Manual Models covered . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4 Maximum load resistance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 52 Measure and Learn function . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 83 Measurement Status . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 155 Measurement Units . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 75 Measuring Range . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .15, 199 minifast . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 45 Minimum Level Offset . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 238 Mounting Bracket Mounting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 41, 42 Process Seal . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 37 Rod . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 39 Standard Cone . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 36 Mounting requirements . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 22 Multidrop connection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 118 Multidrop Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 118 NAMUR-Compliant Alarm . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 82 Node Address . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 113 Nozzle recommendation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 30 Index Reference Manual Index 00809-0100-4026, Rev HA November 2014 Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 112 Optional Devices. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 69 OSHA . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3 OUT_SCALE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 294 AI Block . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 289 L_TYPE Direct . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 294 Indirect . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 294 Saturation Mode. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 81 Select Lower Surface . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 242 Service space recommendations . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 32 Service Support . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3 Signal Conversion Direct . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 289 Indirect . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 289 Simulation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 288 Slaves . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 65 Slow Search . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 242 Slow Search Speed . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 242 Smart Wireless THUM Adapter . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 71 Solid product . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 77 Solids applications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 12, 13, 24, 199 Standard Tank Shapes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 79 Status AI Block . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 292 Still-pipes in Metallic Materials . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 28 Strapping Table . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .80, 110 Support. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3 Supported Units . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 294 Surface Echo Tracking . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 249 Surface Threshold . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 132 Parameter BLOCK_ERR . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 164, 165 CHANNEL . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 293 L_TYPE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 293, 294 OUT_SCALE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 294 Resource Block . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 273 XD_SCALE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 294 Performing Proof Test . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 251 Poll address . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 118 Power Requirements . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 49 Pressure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 12 Process Conditions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 77 Process Seal Antenna . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 37 Product Certifcates . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 217 Product Dielectric Range . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 95 Product Level . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 75 Product surface . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 132 PV_FTIME AI Block . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 289 Reference pulse . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 132 Register Transducer Block . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 113 Resource Block . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 114, 164, 273 Block Errors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 164 Detailed Status . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 164 Parameters . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 273 BLOCK_ERR . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 164 PlantWeb Alerts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 278 Recommended Actions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 282 PlantWeb™ Alerts advisory alarms . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 280 failed_alarms . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 278 maint_alarms . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 279 Summary Status . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 164 Resource block . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 113 Rod Antenna Flanged Connection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 39 Rod Antenna Threaded Connection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 38 Rosemount 751 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10 RRM. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 84 COM Port . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 87 Setup . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .91, 100 RS-485 Bus . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 63 Index Tag Device . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 113 Tank Bottom. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 133 Tank Bottom Type . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 76 Tank Geometry. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .75, 237 Tank height . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7 Tank Seal . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 14 Tank Type . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 76 Tightening torque for Process Seal flanges . . . . . . . . . . 38 Transducer block . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 113 Transition Zone . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .75, 199 Transmitter head . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 14 Tri-Clamp Tank Connection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 40 Tri-Loop . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .69, 117 Troubleshooting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .153, 163 Analog Input (AI) Block . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 165 Resource Block . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 164 Troubleshooting chart . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 131 Upper Null Zone . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .132, 133 Upper Product Dielectric Constant . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 242 Upper Reference Point . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 75, 76 Valves . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 35 Vessel Characteristics. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 35 Volume Calculation Status . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 157 Index-3 Index November 2014 Reference Manual 00809-0100-4026, Rev HA Volume Configuration . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 78 Strapping Table . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 80 Volume Offset . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 78 Volume Offset. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 110 Warnings. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 155 XD_SCALE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 294 AI Block . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 289 L_TYPE Direct . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 294 Indirect . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 294 Index-4 Index Reference Manual 00809-0100-4026, Rev HA 2014 Emerson Process Management Rosemount Measurement 8200 Market Boulevard Chanhassen, MN 55317 USA Tel (USA) 1 800 999 9307 Tel (International) +1 952 906 8888 Fax +1 952 906 8889 Emerson Process Management Blegistrasse 23 P.O. Box 1046 CH 6341 Baar Switzerland Tel +41 (0) 41 768 6111 Fax +41 (0) 41 768 6300 Emerson FZE P.O. Box 17033 Jebel Ali Free Zone Dubai UAE Tel +971 4 811 8100 Fax +971 4 886 5465 Emerson Process Management Asia Pacific Pte Ltd 1 Pandan Crescent Singapore 128461 Tel +65 6777 8211 Fax +65 6777 0947 Service Support Hotline: +65 6770 8711 Email: Enquiries@AP.EmersonProcess.com Emerson Process Management Latin America 1300 Concord Terrace, Suite 400 Sunrise, Florida 33323 USA Tel +1 954 846 5030 Emerson Beijing Instrument Co No.6 North Street, Hepingli Dongcheng District, Beijing 100013 China Tel +8610 64282233 Fax +8610 642 87640 Standard Terms and Conditions of Sale can be found at www.rosemount.com/terms_of_sale. The Emerson logo is a trademark and service mark of Emerson Electric Co. AMS, PlantWeb, Rosemount, and the Rosemount logotype are registered trademarks of Rosemount Inc. DeltaV, THUM, Tri-Clamp, and Tri-Loop are trademarks of Rosemount Inc. HART and WirelessHART are registered trademarks of the HART Communication Foundation. Modbus is a registered trademark of Modicon, Inc. Viton and Kalrez are registered trademarks of DuPont Performance Elastomers. eurofast and minifast are registered trademarks of TURCK. FOUNDATION fieldbus is a trademark of the Fieldbus Foundation. Microsoft is a registered trademark of Microsoft Corporation in the United States and other countries. Windows is a trademark of Microsoft Corporation in the United States and other countries. FDT is a registered trademark of the FDT group. DTM is a trademark of the FDT group. PACTware is a trademark of PACTware Consortium. NACE is a registered trademark of NACE International. E+H FieldCare is a trademark of Endress + Hauser AG. All other marks are the property of their respective owners. © 2014 Rosemount, Inc. All rights reserved.
Source Exif Data:
File Type : PDF File Type Extension : pdf MIME Type : application/pdf PDF Version : 1.5 Linearized : Yes Author : lgn Create Date : 2014:11:19 10:19:10+01:00 Modify Date : 2014:11:19 10:19:10+01:00 XMP Toolkit : Adobe XMP Core 4.2.1-c043 52.372728, 2009/01/18-15:08:04 Format : application/pdf Title : Book_5400_RevHA.book Creator : lgn Creator Tool : FrameMaker 11.0 Metadata Date : 2014:11:10 09:03:09+01:00 Producer : Acrobat Distiller 9.5.5 (Windows) Document ID : uuid:16b462dd-44fc-4549-9ff2-425c24d0c6d2 Instance ID : uuid:6da584db-b2a5-44dd-b0a4-72e56e7eb579 Page Count : 314EXIF Metadata provided by EXIF.tools